1.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-SA-2.0-UK 2 3****************** 4Variables Glossary 5****************** 6 7This chapter lists common variables used in the OpenEmbedded build 8system and gives an overview of their function and contents. 9 10:term:`A <ABIEXTENSION>` :term:`B` :term:`C <CACHE>` 11:term:`D` :term:`E <EFI_PROVIDER>` :term:`F <FEATURE_PACKAGES>` 12:term:`G <GCCPIE>` :term:`H <HOMEPAGE>` :term:`I <ICECC_DISABLED>` 13:term:`K <KARCH>` :term:`L <LABELS>` :term:`M <MACHINE>` 14:term:`N <NATIVELSBSTRING>` :term:`O <OBJCOPY>` :term:`P` 15:term:`R <RANLIB>` :term:`S` :term:`T` 16:term:`U <UBOOT_CONFIG>` :term:`V <VOLATILE_LOG_DIR>` 17:term:`W <WARN_QA>` :term:`X <XSERVER>` 18 19.. glossary:: 20 :sorted: 21 22 :term:`ABIEXTENSION` 23 Extension to the Application Binary Interface (ABI) field of the GNU 24 canonical architecture name (e.g. "eabi"). 25 26 ABI extensions are set in the machine include files. For example, the 27 ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/arch-arm.inc`` file sets the 28 following extension:: 29 30 ABIEXTENSION = "eabi" 31 32 :term:`ALLOW_EMPTY` 33 Specifies whether to produce an output package even if it is empty. 34 By default, BitBake does not produce empty packages. This default 35 behavior can cause issues when there is an 36 :term:`RDEPENDS` or some other hard runtime 37 requirement on the existence of the package. 38 39 Like all package-controlling variables, you must always use them in 40 conjunction with a package name override, as in:: 41 42 ALLOW_EMPTY:${PN} = "1" 43 ALLOW_EMPTY:${PN}-dev = "1" 44 ALLOW_EMPTY:${PN}-staticdev = "1" 45 46 :term:`ALTERNATIVE` 47 Lists commands in a package that need an alternative binary naming 48 scheme. Sometimes the same command is provided in multiple packages. 49 When this occurs, the OpenEmbedded build system needs to use the 50 alternatives system to create a different binary naming scheme so the 51 commands can co-exist. 52 53 To use the variable, list out the package's commands that are also 54 provided by another package. For example, if the ``busybox`` package 55 has four such commands, you identify them as follows:: 56 57 ALTERNATIVE:busybox = "sh sed test bracket" 58 59 For more information on the alternatives system, see the 60 ":ref:`ref-classes-update-alternatives`" 61 section. 62 63 :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME` 64 Used by the alternatives system to map duplicated commands to actual 65 locations. For example, if the ``bracket`` command provided by the 66 ``busybox`` package is duplicated through another package, you must 67 use the :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME` variable to specify the actual 68 location:: 69 70 ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME[bracket] = "/usr/bin/[" 71 72 In this example, the binary for the ``bracket`` command (i.e. ``[``) 73 from the ``busybox`` package resides in ``/usr/bin/``. 74 75 .. note:: 76 77 If :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME` is not defined, it defaults to ``${bindir}/name``. 78 79 For more information on the alternatives system, see the 80 ":ref:`ref-classes-update-alternatives`" 81 section. 82 83 :term:`ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY` 84 Used by the alternatives system to create default priorities for 85 duplicated commands. You can use the variable to create a single 86 default regardless of the command name or package, a default for 87 specific duplicated commands regardless of the package, or a default 88 for specific commands tied to particular packages. Here are the 89 available syntax forms:: 90 91 ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY = "priority" 92 ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY[name] = "priority" 93 ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY_pkg[name] = "priority" 94 95 For more information on the alternatives system, see the 96 ":ref:`ref-classes-update-alternatives`" 97 section. 98 99 :term:`ALTERNATIVE_TARGET` 100 Used by the alternatives system to create default link locations for 101 duplicated commands. You can use the variable to create a single 102 default location for all duplicated commands regardless of the 103 command name or package, a default for specific duplicated commands 104 regardless of the package, or a default for specific commands tied to 105 particular packages. Here are the available syntax forms:: 106 107 ALTERNATIVE_TARGET = "target" 108 ALTERNATIVE_TARGET[name] = "target" 109 ALTERNATIVE_TARGET_pkg[name] = "target" 110 111 .. note:: 112 113 If :term:`ALTERNATIVE_TARGET` is not defined, it inherits the value 114 from the :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME` variable. 115 116 If :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME` and :term:`ALTERNATIVE_TARGET` are the 117 same, the target for :term:`ALTERNATIVE_TARGET` has "``.{BPN}``" 118 appended to it. 119 120 Finally, if the file referenced has not been renamed, the 121 alternatives system will rename it to avoid the need to rename 122 alternative files in the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` 123 task while retaining support for the command if necessary. 124 125 For more information on the alternatives system, see the 126 ":ref:`ref-classes-update-alternatives`" section. 127 128 :term:`ANY_OF_DISTRO_FEATURES` 129 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-features_check` 130 class, this variable identifies a list of distribution features where 131 at least one must be enabled in the current configuration in order 132 for the OpenEmbedded build system to build the recipe. In other words, 133 if none of the features listed in :term:`ANY_OF_DISTRO_FEATURES` 134 appear in :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` within the current configuration, then 135 the recipe will be skipped, and if the build system attempts to build 136 the recipe then an error will be triggered. 137 138 :term:`APPEND` 139 An override list of append strings for each target specified with 140 :term:`LABELS`. 141 142 See the :ref:`ref-classes-grub-efi` class for more 143 information on how this variable is used. 144 145 :term:`AR` 146 The minimal command and arguments used to run ``ar``. 147 148 :term:`ARCHIVER_MODE` 149 When used with the :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class, 150 determines the type of information used to create a released archive. 151 You can use this variable to create archives of patched source, 152 original source, configured source, and so forth by employing the 153 following variable flags (varflags):: 154 155 ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "original" # Uses original (unpacked) source files. 156 ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "patched" # Uses patched source files. This is the default. 157 ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "configured" # Uses configured source files. 158 ARCHIVER_MODE[diff] = "1" # Uses patches between do_unpack and do_patch. 159 ARCHIVER_MODE[diff-exclude] ?= "file file ..." # Lists files and directories to exclude from diff. 160 ARCHIVER_MODE[dumpdata] = "1" # Uses environment data. 161 ARCHIVER_MODE[recipe] = "1" # Uses recipe and include files. 162 ARCHIVER_MODE[srpm] = "1" # Uses RPM package files. 163 164 For information on how the variable works, see the 165 ``meta/classes/archiver.bbclass`` file in the :term:`Source Directory`. 166 167 :term:`AS` 168 Minimal command and arguments needed to run the assembler. 169 170 :term:`ASSUME_PROVIDED` 171 Lists recipe names (:term:`PN` values) BitBake does not 172 attempt to build. Instead, BitBake assumes these recipes have already 173 been built. 174 175 In OpenEmbedded-Core, :term:`ASSUME_PROVIDED` mostly specifies native 176 tools that should not be built. An example is ``git-native``, which 177 when specified, allows for the Git binary from the host to be used 178 rather than building ``git-native``. 179 180 :term:`ASSUME_SHLIBS` 181 Provides additional ``shlibs`` provider mapping information, which 182 adds to or overwrites the information provided automatically by the 183 system. Separate multiple entries using spaces. 184 185 As an example, use the following form to add an ``shlib`` provider of 186 shlibname in packagename with the optional version:: 187 188 shlibname:packagename[_version] 189 190 Here is an example that adds a shared library named ``libEGL.so.1`` 191 as being provided by the ``libegl-implementation`` package:: 192 193 ASSUME_SHLIBS = "libEGL.so.1:libegl-implementation" 194 195 :term:`AUTO_LIBNAME_PKGS` 196 When the :ref:`ref-classes-debian` class is inherited, 197 which is the default behavior, :term:`AUTO_LIBNAME_PKGS` specifies which 198 packages should be checked for libraries and renamed according to 199 Debian library package naming. 200 201 The default value is "${PACKAGES}", which causes the 202 :ref:`ref-classes-debian` class to act on all packages that are 203 explicitly generated by the recipe. 204 205 :term:`AUTOREV` 206 When :term:`SRCREV` is set to the value of this variable, it specifies to 207 use the latest source revision in the repository. Here is an example:: 208 209 SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}" 210 211 If you use the previous statement to retrieve the latest version of 212 software, you need to be sure :term:`PV` contains 213 ``${``\ :term:`SRCPV`\ ``}``. For example, suppose you have a kernel 214 recipe that inherits the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class and you 215 use the previous statement. In this example, ``${SRCPV}`` does not 216 automatically get into :term:`PV`. Consequently, you need to change 217 :term:`PV` in your recipe so that it does contain ``${SRCPV}``. 218 219 For more information see the 220 ":ref:`dev-manual/packages:automatically incrementing a package version number`" 221 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 222 223 :term:`AUTO_SYSLINUXMENU` 224 Enables creating an automatic menu for the syslinux bootloader. You 225 must set this variable in your recipe. The 226 :ref:`ref-classes-syslinux` class checks this variable. 227 228 :term:`AVAILTUNES` 229 The list of defined CPU and Application Binary Interface (ABI) 230 tunings (i.e. "tunes") available for use by the OpenEmbedded build 231 system. 232 233 The list simply presents the tunes that are available. Not all tunes 234 may be compatible with a particular machine configuration, or with 235 each other in a 236 :ref:`Multilib <dev-manual/libraries:combining multiple versions of library files into one image>` 237 configuration. 238 239 To add a tune to the list, be sure to append it with spaces using the 240 "+=" BitBake operator. Do not simply replace the list by using the 241 "=" operator. See the 242 ":ref:`bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:basic syntax`" section in the BitBake 243 User Manual for more information. 244 245 :term:`AZ_SAS` 246 Azure Storage Shared Access Signature, when using the 247 :ref:`Azure Storage fetcher (az://) <bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-fetching:fetchers>` 248 This variable can be defined to be used by the fetcher to authenticate 249 and gain access to non-public artifacts:: 250 251 AZ_SAS = ""se=2021-01-01&sp=r&sv=2018-11-09&sr=c&skoid=<skoid>&sig=<signature>"" 252 253 For more information see Microsoft's Azure Storage documentation at 254 https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/storage/common/storage-sas-overview 255 256 :term:`B` 257 The directory within the :term:`Build Directory` in which the 258 OpenEmbedded build system places generated objects during a recipe's 259 build process. By default, this directory is the same as the 260 :term:`S` directory, which is defined as:: 261 262 S = "${WORKDIR}/${BP}" 263 264 You can separate the (:term:`S`) directory and the directory pointed to 265 by the :term:`B` variable. Most Autotools-based recipes support 266 separating these directories. The build system defaults to using 267 separate directories for ``gcc`` and some kernel recipes. 268 269 :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` 270 Lists "recommended-only" packages to not install. Recommended-only 271 packages are packages installed only through the 272 :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable. You can prevent any 273 of these "recommended" packages from being installed by listing them 274 with the :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` variable:: 275 276 BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS = "package_name package_name package_name ..." 277 278 You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you 279 can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name 280 override:: 281 282 BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS:pn-target_image = "package_name" 283 284 It is important to realize that if you choose to not install packages 285 using this variable and some other packages are dependent on them 286 (i.e. listed in a recipe's :term:`RDEPENDS` 287 variable), the OpenEmbedded build system ignores your request and 288 will install the packages to avoid dependency errors. 289 290 This variable is supported only when using the IPK and RPM 291 packaging backends. DEB is not supported. 292 293 See the :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` and the 294 :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables for related 295 information. 296 297 :term:`BASE_LIB` 298 The library directory name for the CPU or Application Binary 299 Interface (ABI) tune. The :term:`BASE_LIB` applies only in the Multilib 300 context. See the ":ref:`dev-manual/libraries:combining multiple versions of library files into one image`" 301 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for information 302 on Multilib. 303 304 The :term:`BASE_LIB` variable is defined in the machine include files in 305 the :term:`Source Directory`. If Multilib is not 306 being used, the value defaults to "lib". 307 308 :term:`BASE_WORKDIR` 309 Points to the base of the work directory for all recipes. The default 310 value is "${TMPDIR}/work". 311 312 :term:`BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS` 313 Specifies a space-delimited list of hosts that the fetcher is allowed 314 to use to obtain the required source code. Here are 315 considerations surrounding this variable: 316 317 - This host list is only used if :term:`BB_NO_NETWORK` is either not set 318 or set to "0". 319 320 - There is limited support for wildcard matching against the beginning of 321 host names. For example, the following setting matches 322 ``git.gnu.org``, ``ftp.gnu.org``, and ``foo.git.gnu.org``:: 323 324 BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS = "*.gnu.org" 325 326 .. note:: 327 328 The use of the "``*``" character only works at the beginning of 329 a host name and it must be isolated from the remainder of the 330 host name. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other 331 location of the name or combined with the front part of the 332 name. 333 334 For example, ``*.foo.bar`` is supported, while ``*aa.foo.bar`` 335 is not. 336 337 - Mirrors not in the host list are skipped and logged in debug. 338 339 - Attempts to access networks not in the host list cause a failure. 340 341 Using :term:`BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS` in conjunction with 342 :term:`PREMIRRORS` is very useful. Adding the host 343 you want to use to :term:`PREMIRRORS` results in the source code being 344 fetched from an allowed location and avoids raising an error when a 345 host that is not allowed is in a :term:`SRC_URI` 346 statement. This is because the fetcher does not attempt to use the 347 host listed in :term:`SRC_URI` after a successful fetch from the 348 :term:`PREMIRRORS` occurs. 349 350 :term:`BB_BASEHASH_IGNORE_VARS` 351 See :term:`bitbake:BB_BASEHASH_IGNORE_VARS` in the BitBake manual. 352 353 :term:`BB_CACHEDIR` 354 See :term:`bitbake:BB_CACHEDIR` in the BitBake manual. 355 356 :term:`BB_CHECK_SSL_CERTS` 357 See :term:`bitbake:BB_CHECK_SSL_CERTS` in the BitBake manual. 358 359 :term:`BB_CONSOLELOG` 360 See :term:`bitbake:BB_CONSOLELOG` in the BitBake manual. 361 362 :term:`BB_CURRENTTASK` 363 See :term:`bitbake:BB_CURRENTTASK` in the BitBake manual. 364 365 :term:`BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY` 366 Defines how BitBake handles situations where an append file 367 (``.bbappend``) has no corresponding recipe file (``.bb``). This 368 condition often occurs when layers get out of sync (e.g. ``oe-core`` 369 bumps a recipe version and the old recipe no longer exists and the 370 other layer has not been updated to the new version of the recipe 371 yet). 372 373 The default fatal behavior is safest because it is the sane reaction 374 given something is out of sync. It is important to realize when your 375 changes are no longer being applied. 376 377 You can change the default behavior by setting this variable to "1", 378 "yes", or "true" in your ``local.conf`` file, which is located in the 379 :term:`Build Directory`: Here is an example:: 380 381 BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY = "1" 382 383 :term:`BB_DEFAULT_TASK` 384 See :term:`bitbake:BB_DEFAULT_TASK` in the BitBake manual. 385 386 :term:`BB_DEFAULT_UMASK` 387 See :term:`bitbake:BB_DEFAULT_UMASK` in the BitBake manual. 388 389 :term:`BB_DISKMON_DIRS` 390 Monitors disk space and available inodes during the build and allows 391 you to control the build based on these parameters. 392 393 Disk space monitoring is disabled by default. To enable monitoring, 394 add the :term:`BB_DISKMON_DIRS` variable to your ``conf/local.conf`` file 395 found in the :term:`Build Directory`. Use the 396 following form: 397 398 .. code-block:: none 399 400 BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "action,dir,threshold [...]" 401 402 where: 403 404 action is: 405 ABORT: Immediately stop the build when 406 a threshold is broken. 407 STOPTASKS: Stop the build after the currently 408 executing tasks have finished when 409 a threshold is broken. 410 WARN: Issue a warning but continue the 411 build when a threshold is broken. 412 Subsequent warnings are issued as 413 defined by the BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL 414 variable, which must be defined in 415 the conf/local.conf file. 416 417 dir is: 418 Any directory you choose. You can specify one or 419 more directories to monitor by separating the 420 groupings with a space. If two directories are 421 on the same device, only the first directory 422 is monitored. 423 424 threshold is: 425 Either the minimum available disk space, 426 the minimum number of free inodes, or 427 both. You must specify at least one. To 428 omit one or the other, simply omit the value. 429 Specify the threshold using G, M, K for Gbytes, 430 Mbytes, and Kbytes, respectively. If you do 431 not specify G, M, or K, Kbytes is assumed by 432 default. Do not use GB, MB, or KB. 433 434 Here are some examples:: 435 436 BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "ABORT,${TMPDIR},1G,100K WARN,${SSTATE_DIR},1G,100K" 437 BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "STOPTASKS,${TMPDIR},1G" 438 BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "ABORT,${TMPDIR},,100K" 439 440 The first example works only if you also provide the 441 :term:`BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL` 442 variable in the ``conf/local.conf``. This example causes the build 443 system to immediately stop when either the disk space in 444 ``${TMPDIR}`` drops below 1 Gbyte or the available free inodes drops 445 below 100 Kbytes. Because two directories are provided with the 446 variable, the build system also issue a warning when the disk space 447 in the ``${SSTATE_DIR}`` directory drops below 1 Gbyte or the number 448 of free inodes drops below 100 Kbytes. Subsequent warnings are issued 449 during intervals as defined by the :term:`BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL` 450 variable. 451 452 The second example stops the build after all currently executing 453 tasks complete when the minimum disk space in the ``${TMPDIR}`` 454 directory drops below 1 Gbyte. No disk monitoring occurs for the free 455 inodes in this case. 456 457 The final example immediately stops the build when the number of 458 free inodes in the ``${TMPDIR}`` directory drops below 100 Kbytes. No 459 disk space monitoring for the directory itself occurs in this case. 460 461 :term:`BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL` 462 Defines the disk space and free inode warning intervals. To set these 463 intervals, define the variable in your ``conf/local.conf`` file in 464 the :term:`Build Directory`. 465 466 If you are going to use the :term:`BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL` variable, you 467 must also use the :term:`BB_DISKMON_DIRS` 468 variable and define its action as "WARN". During the build, 469 subsequent warnings are issued each time disk space or number of free 470 inodes further reduces by the respective interval. 471 472 If you do not provide a :term:`BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL` variable and you 473 do use :term:`BB_DISKMON_DIRS` with the "WARN" action, the disk 474 monitoring interval defaults to the following:: 475 476 BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "50M,5K" 477 478 When specifying the variable in your configuration file, use the 479 following form: 480 481 .. code-block:: none 482 483 BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "disk_space_interval,disk_inode_interval" 484 485 where: 486 487 disk_space_interval is: 488 An interval of memory expressed in either 489 G, M, or K for Gbytes, Mbytes, or Kbytes, 490 respectively. You cannot use GB, MB, or KB. 491 492 disk_inode_interval is: 493 An interval of free inodes expressed in either 494 G, M, or K for Gbytes, Mbytes, or Kbytes, 495 respectively. You cannot use GB, MB, or KB. 496 497 Here is an example:: 498 499 BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "WARN,${SSTATE_DIR},1G,100K" 500 BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "50M,5K" 501 502 These variables cause the 503 OpenEmbedded build system to issue subsequent warnings each time the 504 available disk space further reduces by 50 Mbytes or the number of 505 free inodes further reduces by 5 Kbytes in the ``${SSTATE_DIR}`` 506 directory. Subsequent warnings based on the interval occur each time 507 a respective interval is reached beyond the initial warning (i.e. 1 508 Gbytes and 100 Kbytes). 509 510 :term:`BB_ENV_PASSTHROUGH` 511 See :term:`bitbake:BB_ENV_PASSTHROUGH` in the BitBake manual. 512 513 :term:`BB_ENV_PASSTHROUGH_ADDITIONS` 514 See :term:`bitbake:BB_ENV_PASSTHROUGH_ADDITIONS` in the BitBake manual. 515 516 :term:`BB_FETCH_PREMIRRORONLY` 517 See :term:`bitbake:BB_FETCH_PREMIRRORONLY` in the BitBake manual. 518 519 :term:`BB_FILENAME` 520 See :term:`bitbake:BB_FILENAME` in the BitBake manual. 521 522 :term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS` 523 Causes tarballs of the source control repositories (e.g. Git 524 repositories), including metadata, to be placed in the 525 :term:`DL_DIR` directory. 526 527 For performance reasons, creating and placing tarballs of these 528 repositories is not the default action by the OpenEmbedded build 529 system:: 530 531 BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1" 532 533 Set this variable in your 534 ``local.conf`` file in the :term:`Build Directory`. 535 536 Once you have the tarballs containing your source files, you can 537 clean up your :term:`DL_DIR` directory by deleting any Git or other 538 source control work directories. 539 540 :term:`BB_GENERATE_SHALLOW_TARBALLS` 541 See :term:`bitbake:BB_GENERATE_SHALLOW_TARBALLS` in the BitBake manual. 542 543 :term:`BB_GIT_SHALLOW` 544 See :term:`bitbake:BB_GIT_SHALLOW` in the BitBake manual. 545 546 :term:`BB_GIT_SHALLOW_DEPTH` 547 See :term:`bitbake:BB_GIT_SHALLOW_DEPTH` in the BitBake manual. 548 549 :term:`BB_HASHCHECK_FUNCTION` 550 See :term:`bitbake:BB_HASHCHECK_FUNCTION` in the BitBake manual. 551 552 :term:`BB_HASHCONFIG_IGNORE_VARS` 553 See :term:`bitbake:BB_HASHCONFIG_IGNORE_VARS` in the BitBake manual. 554 555 :term:`BB_HASHSERVE` 556 See :term:`bitbake:BB_HASHSERVE` in the BitBake manual. 557 558 :term:`BB_HASHSERVE_UPSTREAM` 559 See :term:`bitbake:BB_HASHSERVE_UPSTREAM` in the BitBake manual. 560 561 :term:`BB_INVALIDCONF` 562 See :term:`bitbake:BB_INVALIDCONF` in the BitBake manual. 563 564 :term:`BB_LOGCONFIG` 565 See :term:`bitbake:BB_LOGCONFIG` in the BitBake manual. 566 567 :term:`BB_LOGFMT` 568 See :term:`bitbake:BB_LOGFMT` in the BitBake manual. 569 570 :term:`BB_MULTI_PROVIDER_ALLOWED` 571 See :term:`bitbake:BB_MULTI_PROVIDER_ALLOWED` in the BitBake manual. 572 573 :term:`BB_NICE_LEVEL` 574 See :term:`bitbake:BB_NICE_LEVEL` in the BitBake manual. 575 576 :term:`BB_NO_NETWORK` 577 See :term:`bitbake:BB_NO_NETWORK` in the BitBake manual. 578 579 :term:`BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS` 580 See :term:`bitbake:BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS` in the BitBake manual. 581 582 :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` 583 The maximum number of tasks BitBake should run in parallel at any one 584 time. The OpenEmbedded build system automatically configures this 585 variable to be equal to the number of cores on the build system. For 586 example, a system with a dual core processor that also uses 587 hyper-threading causes the :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` variable to default 588 to "4". 589 590 For single socket systems (i.e. one CPU), you should not have to 591 override this variable to gain optimal parallelism during builds. 592 However, if you have very large systems that employ multiple physical 593 CPUs, you might want to make sure the :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` variable 594 is not set higher than "20". 595 596 For more information on speeding up builds, see the 597 ":ref:`dev-manual/speeding-up-build:speeding up a build`" 598 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 599 600 On the other hand, if your goal is to limit the amount of system 601 resources consumed by BitBake tasks, setting :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` 602 to a number lower than the number of CPU threads in your machine 603 won't be sufficient. That's because each package will still be built 604 and installed through a number of parallel jobs specified by the 605 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable, which is by default the number of CPU 606 threads in your system, and is not impacted by the 607 :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` value. 608 609 So, if you set :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` to "1" but don't set 610 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`, most of your system resources will be consumed 611 anyway. 612 613 Therefore, if you intend to reduce the load of your build system by 614 setting :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` to a relatively low value compared 615 to the number of CPU threads on your system, you should also set 616 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` to a similarly low value. 617 618 An alternative to using :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` to keep the usage 619 of build system resources under control is to use the smarter 620 :term:`BB_PRESSURE_MAX_CPU`, :term:`BB_PRESSURE_MAX_IO` or 621 :term:`BB_PRESSURE_MAX_MEMORY` controls. They will prevent BitBake 622 from starting new tasks as long as thresholds are exceeded. Anyway, 623 as with :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS`, such controls won't prevent the 624 tasks already being run from using all CPU threads on the system 625 if :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` is not set to a low value. 626 627 :term:`BB_ORIGENV` 628 See :term:`bitbake:BB_ORIGENV` in the BitBake manual. 629 630 :term:`BB_PRESERVE_ENV` 631 See :term:`bitbake:BB_PRESERVE_ENV` in the BitBake manual. 632 633 :term:`BB_PRESSURE_MAX_CPU` 634 See :term:`bitbake:BB_PRESSURE_MAX_CPU` in the BitBake manual. 635 636 :term:`BB_PRESSURE_MAX_IO` 637 See :term:`bitbake:BB_PRESSURE_MAX_IO` in the BitBake manual. 638 639 :term:`BB_PRESSURE_MAX_MEMORY` 640 See :term:`bitbake:BB_PRESSURE_MAX_MEMORY` in the BitBake manual. 641 642 :term:`BB_RUNFMT` 643 See :term:`bitbake:BB_RUNFMT` in the BitBake manual. 644 645 :term:`BB_RUNTASK` 646 See :term:`bitbake:BB_RUNTASK` in the BitBake manual. 647 648 :term:`BB_SCHEDULER` 649 See :term:`bitbake:BB_SCHEDULER` in the BitBake manual. 650 651 :term:`BB_SCHEDULERS` 652 See :term:`bitbake:BB_SCHEDULERS` in the BitBake manual. 653 654 :term:`BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT` 655 Specifies the time (in seconds) after which to unload the BitBake 656 server due to inactivity. Set :term:`BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT` to determine how 657 long the BitBake server stays resident between invocations. 658 659 For example, the following statement in your ``local.conf`` file 660 instructs the server to be unloaded after 20 seconds of inactivity:: 661 662 BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT = "20" 663 664 If you want the server to never be unloaded, 665 set :term:`BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT` to "-1". 666 667 :term:`BB_SETSCENE_DEPVALID` 668 See :term:`bitbake:BB_SETSCENE_DEPVALID` in the BitBake manual. 669 670 :term:`BB_SIGNATURE_EXCLUDE_FLAGS` 671 See :term:`bitbake:BB_SIGNATURE_EXCLUDE_FLAGS` in the BitBake manual. 672 673 :term:`BB_SIGNATURE_HANDLER` 674 See :term:`bitbake:BB_SIGNATURE_HANDLER` in the BitBake manual. 675 676 :term:`BB_SRCREV_POLICY` 677 See :term:`bitbake:BB_SRCREV_POLICY` in the BitBake manual. 678 679 :term:`BB_STRICT_CHECKSUM` 680 See :term:`bitbake:BB_STRICT_CHECKSUM` in the BitBake manual. 681 682 :term:`BB_TASK_IONICE_LEVEL` 683 See :term:`bitbake:BB_TASK_IONICE_LEVEL` in the BitBake manual. 684 685 :term:`BB_TASK_NICE_LEVEL` 686 See :term:`bitbake:BB_TASK_NICE_LEVEL` in the BitBake manual. 687 688 :term:`BB_TASKHASH` 689 See :term:`bitbake:BB_TASKHASH` in the BitBake manual. 690 691 :term:`BB_VERBOSE_LOGS` 692 See :term:`bitbake:BB_VERBOSE_LOGS` in the BitBake manual. 693 694 :term:`BB_WORKERCONTEXT` 695 See :term:`bitbake:BB_WORKERCONTEXT` in the BitBake manual. 696 697 :term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` 698 Allows you to extend a recipe so that it builds variants of the 699 software. There are common variants for recipes as "natives" like 700 ``quilt-native``, which is a copy of Quilt built to run on the build 701 system; "crosses" such as ``gcc-cross``, which is a compiler built to 702 run on the build machine but produces binaries that run on the target 703 :term:`MACHINE`; ":ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk`", which 704 targets the SDK machine instead of :term:`MACHINE`; and "mulitlibs" in 705 the form "``multilib:``\ multilib_name". 706 707 To build a different variant of the recipe with a minimal amount of 708 code, it usually is as simple as adding the following to your recipe:: 709 710 BBCLASSEXTEND =+ "native nativesdk" 711 BBCLASSEXTEND =+ "multilib:multilib_name" 712 713 .. note:: 714 715 Internally, the :term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` mechanism generates recipe 716 variants by rewriting variable values and applying overrides such 717 as ``:class-native``. For example, to generate a native version of 718 a recipe, a :term:`DEPENDS` on "foo" is rewritten 719 to a :term:`DEPENDS` on "foo-native". 720 721 Even when using :term:`BBCLASSEXTEND`, the recipe is only parsed once. 722 Parsing once adds some limitations. For example, it is not 723 possible to include a different file depending on the variant, 724 since ``include`` statements are processed when the recipe is 725 parsed. 726 727 :term:`BBDEBUG` 728 See :term:`bitbake:BBDEBUG` in the BitBake manual. 729 730 :term:`BBFILE_COLLECTIONS` 731 Lists the names of configured layers. These names are used to find 732 the other ``BBFILE_*`` variables. Typically, each layer will append 733 its name to this variable in its ``conf/layer.conf`` file. 734 735 :term:`BBFILE_PATTERN` 736 Variable that expands to match files from 737 :term:`BBFILES` in a particular layer. This variable 738 is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be suffixed with the 739 name of the specific layer (e.g. ``BBFILE_PATTERN_emenlow``). 740 741 :term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY` 742 Assigns the priority for recipe files in each layer. 743 744 This variable is useful in situations where the same recipe appears 745 in more than one layer. Setting this variable allows you to 746 prioritize a layer against other layers that contain the same recipe 747 --- effectively letting you control the precedence for the multiple 748 layers. The precedence established through this variable stands 749 regardless of a recipe's version (:term:`PV` variable). For 750 example, a layer that has a recipe with a higher :term:`PV` value but for 751 which the :term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY` is set to have a lower precedence still 752 has a lower precedence. 753 754 A larger value for the :term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY` variable results in a 755 higher precedence. For example, the value 6 has a higher precedence 756 than the value 5. If not specified, the :term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY` variable 757 is set based on layer dependencies (see the :term:`LAYERDEPENDS` variable 758 for more information. The default priority, if unspecified for a 759 layer with no dependencies, is the lowest defined priority + 1 (or 1 760 if no priorities are defined). 761 762 .. tip:: 763 764 You can use the command ``bitbake-layers show-layers`` 765 to list all configured layers along with their priorities. 766 767 :term:`BBFILES` 768 A space-separated list of recipe files BitBake uses to build 769 software. 770 771 When specifying recipe files, you can pattern match using Python's 772 `glob <https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html>`__ syntax. 773 For details on the syntax, see the documentation by following the 774 previous link. 775 776 :term:`BBFILES_DYNAMIC` 777 Activates content when identified layers are present. You identify 778 the layers by the collections that the layers define. 779 780 Use the :term:`BBFILES_DYNAMIC` variable to avoid ``.bbappend`` files 781 whose corresponding ``.bb`` file is in a layer that attempts to 782 modify other layers through ``.bbappend`` but does not want to 783 introduce a hard dependency on those other layers. 784 785 Use the following form for :term:`BBFILES_DYNAMIC`: 786 ``collection_name:filename_pattern``. 787 788 The following example identifies two collection names and two 789 filename patterns:: 790 791 BBFILES_DYNAMIC += " \ 792 clang-layer:${LAYERDIR}/bbappends/meta-clang/*/*/*.bbappend \ 793 core:${LAYERDIR}/bbappends/openembedded-core/meta/*/*/*.bbappend \ 794 " 795 796 This next example shows an error message that occurs because invalid 797 entries are found, which cause parsing to fail: 798 799 .. code-block:: none 800 801 ERROR: BBFILES_DYNAMIC entries must be of the form <collection name>:<filename pattern>, not: 802 /work/my-layer/bbappends/meta-security-isafw/*/*/*.bbappend 803 /work/my-layer/bbappends/openembedded-core/meta/*/*/*.bbappend 804 805 :term:`BBINCLUDED` 806 See :term:`bitbake:BBINCLUDED` in the BitBake manual. 807 808 :term:`BBINCLUDELOGS` 809 Variable that controls how BitBake displays logs on build failure. 810 811 :term:`BBINCLUDELOGS_LINES` 812 If :term:`BBINCLUDELOGS` is set, specifies the 813 maximum number of lines from the task log file to print when 814 reporting a failed task. If you do not set :term:`BBINCLUDELOGS_LINES`, 815 the entire log is printed. 816 817 :term:`BBLAYERS` 818 Lists the layers to enable during the build. This variable is defined 819 in the ``bblayers.conf`` configuration file in the :term:`Build Directory`. 820 Here is an example:: 821 822 BBLAYERS = " \ 823 /home/scottrif/poky/meta \ 824 /home/scottrif/poky/meta-poky \ 825 /home/scottrif/poky/meta-yocto-bsp \ 826 /home/scottrif/poky/meta-mykernel \ 827 " 828 829 This example enables four layers, one of which is a custom, 830 user-defined layer named ``meta-mykernel``. 831 832 :term:`BBLAYERS_FETCH_DIR` 833 See :term:`bitbake:BBLAYERS_FETCH_DIR` in the BitBake manual. 834 835 :term:`BBMASK` 836 Prevents BitBake from processing recipes and recipe append files. 837 838 You can use the :term:`BBMASK` variable to "hide" these ``.bb`` and 839 ``.bbappend`` files. BitBake ignores any recipe or recipe append 840 files that match any of the expressions. It is as if BitBake does not 841 see them at all. Consequently, matching files are not parsed or 842 otherwise used by BitBake. 843 844 The values you provide are passed to Python's regular expression 845 compiler. Consequently, the syntax follows Python's Regular 846 Expression (re) syntax. The expressions are compared against the full 847 paths to the files. For complete syntax information, see Python's 848 documentation at https://docs.python.org/3/library/re.html#regular-expression-syntax. 849 850 The following example uses a complete regular expression to tell 851 BitBake to ignore all recipe and recipe append files in the 852 ``meta-ti/recipes-misc/`` directory:: 853 854 BBMASK = "meta-ti/recipes-misc/" 855 856 If you want to mask out multiple directories or recipes, you can 857 specify multiple regular expression fragments. This next example 858 masks out multiple directories and individual recipes:: 859 860 BBMASK += "/meta-ti/recipes-misc/ meta-ti/recipes-ti/packagegroup/" 861 BBMASK += "/meta-oe/recipes-support/" 862 BBMASK += "/meta-foo/.*/openldap" 863 BBMASK += "opencv.*\.bbappend" 864 BBMASK += "lzma" 865 866 .. note:: 867 868 When specifying a directory name, use the trailing slash character 869 to ensure you match just that directory name. 870 871 :term:`BBMULTICONFIG` 872 Specifies each additional separate configuration when you are 873 building targets with multiple configurations. Use this variable in 874 your ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file. Specify a 875 multiconfigname for each configuration file you are using. For 876 example, the following line specifies three configuration files:: 877 878 BBMULTICONFIG = "configA configB configC" 879 880 Each configuration file you use must reside in a ``multiconfig`` 881 subdirectory of a configuration directory within a layer, or 882 within the :term:`Build Directory` (e.g. 883 ``build_directory/conf/multiconfig/configA.conf`` or 884 ``mylayer/conf/multiconfig/configB.conf``). 885 886 For information on how to use :term:`BBMULTICONFIG` in an environment 887 that supports building targets with multiple configurations, see the 888 ":ref:`dev-manual/building:building images for multiple targets using multiple configurations`" 889 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 890 891 :term:`BBPATH` 892 See :term:`bitbake:BBPATH` in the BitBake manual. 893 894 :term:`BBSERVER` 895 If defined in the BitBake environment, :term:`BBSERVER` points to the 896 BitBake remote server. 897 898 Use the following format to export the variable to the BitBake 899 environment:: 900 901 export BBSERVER=localhost:$port 902 903 By default, :term:`BBSERVER` also appears in :term:`BB_BASEHASH_IGNORE_VARS`. 904 Consequently, :term:`BBSERVER` is excluded from checksum and dependency 905 data. 906 907 :term:`BBTARGETS` 908 See :term:`bitbake:BBTARGETS` in the BitBake manual. 909 910 :term:`BINCONFIG` 911 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-binconfig-disabled` class, this 912 variable specifies binary configuration scripts to disable in favor of 913 using ``pkg-config`` to query the information. The 914 :ref:`ref-classes-binconfig-disabled` class will modify the specified 915 scripts to return an error so that calls to them can be easily found 916 and replaced. 917 918 To add multiple scripts, separate them by spaces. Here is an example 919 from the ``libpng`` recipe:: 920 921 BINCONFIG = "${bindir}/libpng-config ${bindir}/libpng16-config" 922 923 :term:`BINCONFIG_GLOB` 924 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-binconfig` class, 925 this variable specifies a wildcard for configuration scripts that 926 need editing. The scripts are edited to correct any paths that have 927 been set up during compilation so that they are correct for use when 928 installed into the sysroot and called by the build processes of other 929 recipes. 930 931 .. note:: 932 933 The :term:`BINCONFIG_GLOB` variable uses 934 `shell globbing <https://tldp.org/LDP/abs/html/globbingref.html>`__, 935 which is recognition and expansion of wildcards during pattern 936 matching. Shell globbing is very similar to 937 `fnmatch <https://docs.python.org/3/library/fnmatch.html#module-fnmatch>`__ 938 and `glob <https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html>`__. 939 940 For more information on how this variable works, see 941 ``meta/classes-recipe/binconfig.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`. 942 You can also find general 943 information on the class in the 944 ":ref:`ref-classes-binconfig`" section. 945 946 :term:`BITBAKE_UI` 947 See :term:`bitbake:BITBAKE_UI` in the BitBake manual. 948 949 :term:`BP` 950 The base recipe name and version but without any special recipe name 951 suffix (i.e. ``-native``, ``lib64-``, and so forth). :term:`BP` is 952 comprised of the following:: 953 954 ${BPN}-${PV} 955 956 :term:`BPN` 957 This variable is a version of the :term:`PN` variable with 958 common prefixes and suffixes removed, such as ``nativesdk-``, 959 ``-cross``, ``-native``, and multilib's ``lib64-`` and ``lib32-``. 960 The exact lists of prefixes and suffixes removed are specified by the 961 :term:`MLPREFIX` and 962 :term:`SPECIAL_PKGSUFFIX` variables, 963 respectively. 964 965 :term:`BUGTRACKER` 966 Specifies a URL for an upstream bug tracking website for a recipe. 967 The OpenEmbedded build system does not use this variable. Rather, the 968 variable is a useful pointer in case a bug in the software being 969 built needs to be manually reported. 970 971 :term:`BUILD_ARCH` 972 Specifies the architecture of the build host (e.g. ``i686``). The 973 OpenEmbedded build system sets the value of :term:`BUILD_ARCH` from the 974 machine name reported by the ``uname`` command. 975 976 :term:`BUILD_AS_ARCH` 977 Specifies the architecture-specific assembler flags for the build 978 host. By default, the value of :term:`BUILD_AS_ARCH` is empty. 979 980 :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH` 981 Specifies the architecture-specific C compiler flags for the build 982 host. By default, the value of :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH` is empty. 983 984 :term:`BUILD_CCLD` 985 Specifies the linker command to be used for the build host when the C 986 compiler is being used as the linker. By default, :term:`BUILD_CCLD` 987 points to GCC and passes as arguments the value of 988 :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH`, assuming 989 :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH` is set. 990 991 :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` 992 Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the 993 build host. When building in the ``-native`` context, 994 :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by 995 default. 996 997 :term:`BUILD_CPPFLAGS` 998 Specifies the flags to pass to the C preprocessor (i.e. to both the C 999 and the C++ compilers) when building for the build host. When 1000 building in the ``-native`` context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` 1001 is set to the value of this variable by default. 1002 1003 :term:`BUILD_CXXFLAGS` 1004 Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the 1005 build host. When building in the ``-native`` context, 1006 :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable 1007 by default. 1008 1009 :term:`BUILD_FC` 1010 Specifies the Fortran compiler command for the build host. By 1011 default, :term:`BUILD_FC` points to Gfortran and passes as arguments the 1012 value of :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH`, assuming 1013 :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH` is set. 1014 1015 :term:`BUILD_LD` 1016 Specifies the linker command for the build host. By default, 1017 :term:`BUILD_LD` points to the GNU linker (ld) and passes as arguments 1018 the value of :term:`BUILD_LD_ARCH`, assuming 1019 :term:`BUILD_LD_ARCH` is set. 1020 1021 :term:`BUILD_LD_ARCH` 1022 Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the build host. By 1023 default, the value of :term:`BUILD_LD_ARCH` is empty. 1024 1025 :term:`BUILD_LDFLAGS` 1026 Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the build 1027 host. When building in the ``-native`` context, 1028 :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable 1029 by default. 1030 1031 :term:`BUILD_OPTIMIZATION` 1032 Specifies the optimization flags passed to the C compiler when 1033 building for the build host or the SDK. The flags are passed through 1034 the :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` and 1035 :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` default values. 1036 1037 The default value of the :term:`BUILD_OPTIMIZATION` variable is "-O2 1038 -pipe". 1039 1040 :term:`BUILD_OS` 1041 Specifies the operating system in use on the build host (e.g. 1042 "linux"). The OpenEmbedded build system sets the value of 1043 :term:`BUILD_OS` from the OS reported by the ``uname`` command --- the 1044 first word, converted to lower-case characters. 1045 1046 :term:`BUILD_PREFIX` 1047 The toolchain binary prefix used for native recipes. The OpenEmbedded 1048 build system uses the :term:`BUILD_PREFIX` value to set the 1049 :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` when building for :ref:`ref-classes-native` recipes. 1050 1051 :term:`BUILD_STRIP` 1052 Specifies the command to be used to strip debugging symbols from 1053 binaries produced for the build host. By default, :term:`BUILD_STRIP` 1054 points to 1055 ``${``\ :term:`BUILD_PREFIX`\ ``}strip``. 1056 1057 :term:`BUILD_SYS` 1058 Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating 1059 system, to use when building for the build host (i.e. when building 1060 :ref:`ref-classes-native` recipes). 1061 1062 The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based 1063 on :term:`BUILD_ARCH`, 1064 :term:`BUILD_VENDOR`, and 1065 :term:`BUILD_OS`. You do not need to set the 1066 :term:`BUILD_SYS` variable yourself. 1067 1068 :term:`BUILD_VENDOR` 1069 Specifies the vendor name to use when building for the build host. 1070 The default value is an empty string (""). 1071 1072 :term:`BUILDDIR` 1073 Points to the location of the :term:`Build Directory`. You can define 1074 this directory indirectly through the :ref:`structure-core-script` script 1075 by passing in a :term:`Build Directory` path when you run the script. If 1076 you run the script and do not provide a :term:`Build Directory` path, the 1077 :term:`BUILDDIR` defaults to ``build`` in the current directory. 1078 1079 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` 1080 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class, this variable 1081 specifies whether or not to commit the build history output in a local 1082 Git repository. If set to "1", this local repository will be maintained 1083 automatically by the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class and a commit 1084 will be created on every build for changes to each top-level subdirectory 1085 of the build history output (images, packages, and sdk). If you want to 1086 track changes to build history over time, you should set this value to 1087 "1". 1088 1089 By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class 1090 enables committing the buildhistory output in a local Git repository:: 1091 1092 BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT ?= "1" 1093 1094 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR` 1095 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` 1096 class, this variable specifies the author to use for each Git commit. 1097 In order for the :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR` variable to work, the 1098 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` variable must 1099 be set to "1". 1100 1101 Git requires that the value you provide for the 1102 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR` variable takes the form of "name 1103 email@host". Providing an email address or host that is not valid 1104 does not produce an error. 1105 1106 By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class sets the variable 1107 as follows:: 1108 1109 BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR ?= "buildhistory <buildhistory@${DISTRO}>" 1110 1111 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_DIR` 1112 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` 1113 class, this variable specifies the directory in which build history 1114 information is kept. For more information on how the variable works, 1115 see the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class. 1116 1117 By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class sets the directory 1118 as follows:: 1119 1120 BUILDHISTORY_DIR ?= "${TOPDIR}/buildhistory" 1121 1122 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES` 1123 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` 1124 class, this variable specifies the build history features to be 1125 enabled. For more information on how build history works, see the 1126 ":ref:`dev-manual/build-quality:maintaining build output quality`" 1127 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 1128 1129 You can specify these features in the form of a space-separated list: 1130 1131 - *image:* Analysis of the contents of images, which includes the 1132 list of installed packages among other things. 1133 1134 - *package:* Analysis of the contents of individual packages. 1135 1136 - *sdk:* Analysis of the contents of the software development kit 1137 (SDK). 1138 1139 - *task:* Save output file signatures for 1140 :ref:`shared state <overview-manual/concepts:shared state cache>` 1141 (sstate) tasks. 1142 This saves one file per task and lists the SHA-256 checksums for 1143 each file staged (i.e. the output of the task). 1144 1145 By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class enables the 1146 following features:: 1147 1148 BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES ?= "image package sdk" 1149 1150 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES` 1151 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` 1152 class, this variable specifies a list of paths to files copied from 1153 the image contents into the build history directory under an 1154 "image-files" directory in the directory for the image, so that you 1155 can track the contents of each file. The default is to copy 1156 ``/etc/passwd`` and ``/etc/group``, which allows you to monitor for 1157 changes in user and group entries. You can modify the list to include 1158 any file. Specifying an invalid path does not produce an error. 1159 Consequently, you can include files that might not always be present. 1160 1161 By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class provides paths to 1162 the following files:: 1163 1164 BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES ?= "/etc/passwd /etc/group" 1165 1166 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_PATH_PREFIX_STRIP` 1167 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` 1168 class, this variable specifies a common path prefix that should be 1169 stripped off the beginning of paths in the task signature list when the 1170 ``task`` feature is active in :term:`BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES`. This can be 1171 useful when build history is populated from multiple sources that may not 1172 all use the same top level directory. 1173 1174 By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class sets the variable 1175 as follows:: 1176 1177 BUILDHISTORY_PATH_PREFIX_STRIP ?= "" 1178 1179 In this case, no prefixes will be stripped. 1180 1181 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO` 1182 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class, this variable 1183 optionally specifies a remote repository to which build history pushes 1184 Git changes. In order for :term:`BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO` to work, 1185 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` must be set to "1". 1186 1187 The repository should correspond to a remote address that specifies a 1188 repository as understood by Git, or alternatively to a remote name 1189 that you have set up manually using ``git remote`` within the local 1190 repository. 1191 1192 By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-buildhistory` class sets the variable 1193 as follows:: 1194 1195 BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO ?= "" 1196 1197 :term:`BUILDNAME` 1198 See :term:`bitbake:BUILDNAME` in the BitBake manual. 1199 1200 :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` 1201 Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the 1202 SDK. When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, 1203 :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by 1204 default. 1205 1206 :term:`BUILDSDK_CPPFLAGS` 1207 Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the 1208 C and the C++ compilers) when building for the SDK. When building in 1209 the ``nativesdk-`` context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` is set 1210 to the value of this variable by default. 1211 1212 :term:`BUILDSDK_CXXFLAGS` 1213 Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the 1214 SDK. When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, 1215 :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable 1216 by default. 1217 1218 :term:`BUILDSDK_LDFLAGS` 1219 Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the SDK. 1220 When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, 1221 :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable 1222 by default. 1223 1224 :term:`BUILDSTATS_BASE` 1225 Points to the location of the directory that holds build statistics 1226 when you use and enable the :ref:`ref-classes-buildstats` class. The 1227 :term:`BUILDSTATS_BASE` directory defaults to 1228 ``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}/buildstats/``. 1229 1230 :term:`BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID` 1231 For the BusyBox recipe, specifies whether to split the output 1232 executable file into two parts: one for features that require 1233 ``setuid root``, and one for the remaining features (i.e. those that 1234 do not require ``setuid root``). 1235 1236 The :term:`BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID` variable defaults to "1", which results in 1237 splitting the output executable file. Set the variable to "0" to get 1238 a single output executable file. 1239 1240 :term:`BZRDIR` 1241 See :term:`bitbake:BZRDIR` in the BitBake manual. 1242 1243 :term:`CACHE` 1244 Specifies the directory BitBake uses to store a cache of the 1245 :term:`Metadata` so it does not need to be parsed every time 1246 BitBake is started. 1247 1248 :term:`CC` 1249 The minimal command and arguments used to run the C compiler. 1250 1251 :term:`CFLAGS` 1252 Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler. This variable is 1253 exported to an environment variable and thus made visible to the 1254 software being built during the compilation step. 1255 1256 Default initialization for :term:`CFLAGS` varies depending on what is 1257 being built: 1258 1259 - :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` when building for the 1260 target 1261 1262 - :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` when building for the 1263 build host (i.e. ``-native``) 1264 1265 - :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` when building for 1266 an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) 1267 1268 :term:`CLASSOVERRIDE` 1269 An internal variable specifying the special class override that 1270 should currently apply (e.g. "class-target", "class-native", and so 1271 forth). The classes that use this variable (e.g. 1272 :ref:`ref-classes-native`, :ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk`, and so forth) 1273 set the variable to appropriate values. 1274 1275 .. note:: 1276 1277 :term:`CLASSOVERRIDE` gets its default "class-target" value from the 1278 ``bitbake.conf`` file. 1279 1280 As an example, the following override allows you to install extra 1281 files, but only when building for the target:: 1282 1283 do_install:append:class-target() { 1284 install my-extra-file ${D}${sysconfdir} 1285 } 1286 1287 Here is an example where ``FOO`` is set to 1288 "native" when building for the build host, and to "other" when not 1289 building for the build host:: 1290 1291 FOO:class-native = "native" 1292 FOO = "other" 1293 1294 The underlying mechanism behind :term:`CLASSOVERRIDE` is simply 1295 that it is included in the default value of 1296 :term:`OVERRIDES`. 1297 1298 :term:`CLEANBROKEN` 1299 If set to "1" within a recipe, :term:`CLEANBROKEN` specifies that the 1300 ``make clean`` command does not work for the software being built. 1301 Consequently, the OpenEmbedded build system will not try to run 1302 ``make clean`` during the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` 1303 task, which is the default behavior. 1304 1305 :term:`COMBINED_FEATURES` 1306 Provides a list of hardware features that are enabled in both 1307 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` and 1308 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`. This select list of 1309 features contains features that make sense to be controlled both at 1310 the machine and distribution configuration level. For example, the 1311 "bluetooth" feature requires hardware support but should also be 1312 optional at the distribution level, in case the hardware supports 1313 Bluetooth but you do not ever intend to use it. 1314 1315 :term:`COMMERCIAL_AUDIO_PLUGINS` 1316 This variable is specific to the :yocto_git:`GStreamer recipes 1317 </poky/tree/meta/recipes-multimedia/gstreamer/gstreamer1.0-meta-base.bb>`. 1318 It allows to build the GStreamer `"ugly" 1319 <https://github.com/GStreamer/gst-plugins-ugly>`__ and 1320 `"bad" <https://github.com/GStreamer/gst-plugins-bad>`__ audio plugins. 1321 1322 See the :ref:`dev-manual/licenses:other variables related to commercial licenses` 1323 section for usage details. 1324 1325 :term:`COMMERCIAL_VIDEO_PLUGINS` 1326 This variable is specific to the :yocto_git:`GStreamer recipes 1327 </poky/tree/meta/recipes-multimedia/gstreamer/gstreamer1.0-meta-base.bb>`. 1328 It allows to build the GStreamer `"ugly" 1329 <https://github.com/GStreamer/gst-plugins-ugly>`__ and 1330 `"bad" <https://github.com/GStreamer/gst-plugins-bad>`__ video plugins. 1331 1332 See the :ref:`dev-manual/licenses:other variables related to commercial licenses` 1333 section for usage details. 1334 1335 :term:`COMMON_LICENSE_DIR` 1336 Points to ``meta/files/common-licenses`` in the 1337 :term:`Source Directory`, which is where generic license 1338 files reside. 1339 1340 :term:`COMPATIBLE_HOST` 1341 A regular expression that resolves to one or more hosts (when the 1342 recipe is native) or one or more targets (when the recipe is 1343 non-native) with which a recipe is compatible. The regular expression 1344 is matched against :term:`HOST_SYS`. You can use the 1345 variable to stop recipes from being built for classes of systems with 1346 which the recipes are not compatible. Stopping these builds is 1347 particularly useful with kernels. The variable also helps to increase 1348 parsing speed since the build system skips parsing recipes not 1349 compatible with the current system. 1350 1351 :term:`COMPATIBLE_MACHINE` 1352 A regular expression that resolves to one or more target machines 1353 with which a recipe is compatible. The regular expression is matched 1354 against :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES`. You can use 1355 the variable to stop recipes from being built for machines with which 1356 the recipes are not compatible. Stopping these builds is particularly 1357 useful with kernels. The variable also helps to increase parsing 1358 speed since the build system skips parsing recipes not compatible 1359 with the current machine. 1360 1361 If one wants to have a recipe only available for some architectures 1362 (here ``aarch64`` and ``mips64``), the following can be used:: 1363 1364 COMPATIBLE_MACHINE = "^$" 1365 COMPATIBLE_MACHINE:arch64 = "^(aarch64)$" 1366 COMPATIBLE_MACHINE:mips64 = "^(mips64)$" 1367 1368 The first line means "match all machines whose :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES` 1369 contains the empty string", which will always be none. 1370 1371 The second is for matching all machines whose :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES` 1372 contains one override which is exactly ``aarch64``. 1373 1374 The third is for matching all machines whose :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES` 1375 contains one override which is exactly ``mips64``. 1376 1377 The same could be achieved with:: 1378 1379 COMPATIBLE_MACHINE = "^(aarch64|mips64)$" 1380 1381 .. note:: 1382 1383 When :term:`COMPATIBLE_MACHINE` is set in a recipe inherits from 1384 native, the recipe is always skipped. All native recipes must be 1385 entirely target independent and should not rely on :term:`MACHINE`. 1386 1387 :term:`COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB` 1388 Defines wildcards to match when installing a list of complementary 1389 packages for all the packages explicitly (or implicitly) installed in 1390 an image. 1391 1392 The :term:`COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB` variable uses Unix filename pattern matching 1393 (`fnmatch <https://docs.python.org/3/library/fnmatch.html#module-fnmatch>`__), 1394 which is similar to the Unix style pathname pattern expansion 1395 (`glob <https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html>`__). 1396 1397 The resulting list of complementary packages is associated with an 1398 item that can be added to 1399 :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. An example usage of 1400 this is the "dev-pkgs" item that when added to :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` 1401 will install -dev packages (containing headers and other development 1402 files) for every package in the image. 1403 1404 To add a new feature item pointing to a wildcard, use a variable flag 1405 to specify the feature item name and use the value to specify the 1406 wildcard. Here is an example:: 1407 1408 COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB[dev-pkgs] = '*-dev' 1409 1410 .. note:: 1411 1412 When installing complementary packages, recommends relationships 1413 (set via :term:`RRECOMMENDS`) are always ignored. 1414 1415 :term:`COMPONENTS_DIR` 1416 Stores sysroot components for each recipe. The OpenEmbedded build 1417 system uses :term:`COMPONENTS_DIR` when constructing recipe-specific 1418 sysroots for other recipes. 1419 1420 The default is 1421 "``${``\ :term:`STAGING_DIR`\ ``}-components``." 1422 (i.e. 1423 "``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}/sysroots-components``"). 1424 1425 :term:`CONF_VERSION` 1426 Tracks the version of the local configuration file (i.e. 1427 ``local.conf``). The value for :term:`CONF_VERSION` increments each time 1428 ``build/conf/`` compatibility changes. 1429 1430 :term:`CONFFILES` 1431 Identifies editable or configurable files that are part of a package. 1432 If the Package Management System (PMS) is being used to update 1433 packages on the target system, it is possible that configuration 1434 files you have changed after the original installation and that you 1435 now want to remain unchanged are overwritten. In other words, 1436 editable files might exist in the package that you do not want reset 1437 as part of the package update process. You can use the :term:`CONFFILES` 1438 variable to list the files in the package that you wish to prevent 1439 the PMS from overwriting during this update process. 1440 1441 To use the :term:`CONFFILES` variable, provide a package name override 1442 that identifies the resulting package. Then, provide a 1443 space-separated list of files. Here is an example:: 1444 1445 CONFFILES:${PN} += "${sysconfdir}/file1 \ 1446 ${sysconfdir}/file2 ${sysconfdir}/file3" 1447 1448 There is a relationship between the :term:`CONFFILES` and :term:`FILES` 1449 variables. The files listed within :term:`CONFFILES` must be a subset of 1450 the files listed within :term:`FILES`. Because the configuration files 1451 you provide with :term:`CONFFILES` are simply being identified so that 1452 the PMS will not overwrite them, it makes sense that the files must 1453 already be included as part of the package through the :term:`FILES` 1454 variable. 1455 1456 .. note:: 1457 1458 When specifying paths as part of the :term:`CONFFILES` variable, it is 1459 good practice to use appropriate path variables. 1460 For example, ``${sysconfdir}`` rather than ``/etc`` or ``${bindir}`` 1461 rather than ``/usr/bin``. You can find a list of these variables at 1462 the top of the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file in the 1463 :term:`Source Directory`. 1464 1465 :term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE` 1466 Identifies the initial RAM filesystem (:term:`Initramfs`) source files. The 1467 OpenEmbedded build system receives and uses this kernel Kconfig 1468 variable as an environment variable. By default, the variable is set 1469 to null (""). 1470 1471 The :term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE` can be either a single cpio archive 1472 with a ``.cpio`` suffix or a space-separated list of directories and 1473 files for building the :term:`Initramfs` image. A cpio archive should contain 1474 a filesystem archive to be used as an :term:`Initramfs` image. Directories 1475 should contain a filesystem layout to be included in the :term:`Initramfs` 1476 image. Files should contain entries according to the format described 1477 by the ``usr/gen_init_cpio`` program in the kernel tree. 1478 1479 If you specify multiple directories and files, the :term:`Initramfs` image 1480 will be the aggregate of all of them. 1481 1482 For information on creating an :term:`Initramfs`, see the 1483 ":ref:`dev-manual/building:building an initial ram filesystem (Initramfs) image`" section 1484 in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 1485 1486 :term:`CONFIG_SITE` 1487 A list of files that contains ``autoconf`` test results relevant to 1488 the current build. This variable is used by the Autotools utilities 1489 when running ``configure``. 1490 1491 :term:`CONFIGURE_FLAGS` 1492 The minimal arguments for GNU configure. 1493 1494 :term:`CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES` 1495 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-features_check` 1496 class, this variable identifies distribution features that would be 1497 in conflict should the recipe be built. In other words, if the 1498 :term:`CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES` variable lists a feature that also 1499 appears in :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` within the current configuration, then 1500 the recipe will be skipped, and if the build system attempts to build 1501 the recipe then an error will be triggered. 1502 1503 :term:`CONVERSION_CMD` 1504 This variable is used for storing image conversion commands. 1505 Image conversion can convert an image into different objects like: 1506 1507 - Compressed version of the image 1508 1509 - Checksums for the image 1510 1511 An example of :term:`CONVERSION_CMD` from :ref:`ref-classes-image_types` 1512 class is:: 1513 1514 CONVERSION_CMD:lzo = "lzop -9 ${IMAGE_NAME}${IMAGE_NAME_SUFFIX}.${type}" 1515 1516 :term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` 1517 If set to "1" along with the 1518 :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable, the 1519 OpenEmbedded build system copies into the image the license files, 1520 which are located in ``/usr/share/common-licenses``, for each 1521 package. The license files are placed in directories within the image 1522 itself during build time. 1523 1524 .. note:: 1525 1526 The :term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` does not offer a path for adding licenses for 1527 newly installed packages to an image, which might be most suitable for 1528 read-only filesystems that cannot be upgraded. See the 1529 :term:`LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE` variable for additional information. 1530 You can also reference the ":ref:`dev-manual/licenses:providing license text`" 1531 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for 1532 information on providing license text. 1533 1534 :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` 1535 If set to "1", the OpenEmbedded build system copies the license 1536 manifest for the image to 1537 ``/usr/share/common-licenses/license.manifest`` within the image 1538 itself during build time. 1539 1540 .. note:: 1541 1542 The :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` does not offer a path for adding licenses for 1543 newly installed packages to an image, which might be most suitable for 1544 read-only filesystems that cannot be upgraded. See the 1545 :term:`LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE` variable for additional information. 1546 You can also reference the ":ref:`dev-manual/licenses:providing license text`" 1547 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for 1548 information on providing license text. 1549 1550 :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` 1551 A space-separated list of licenses to exclude from the source archived by 1552 the :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. In other words, if a license in a 1553 recipe's :term:`LICENSE` value is in the value of 1554 :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE`, then its source is not archived by the 1555 class. 1556 1557 .. note:: 1558 1559 The :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` variable takes precedence over the 1560 :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` variable. 1561 1562 The default value, which is "CLOSED Proprietary", for 1563 :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` is set by the 1564 :ref:`ref-classes-copyleft_filter` class, which 1565 is inherited by the :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. 1566 1567 :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` 1568 A space-separated list of licenses to include in the source archived 1569 by the :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. In other 1570 words, if a license in a recipe's :term:`LICENSE` 1571 value is in the value of :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE`, then its 1572 source is archived by the class. 1573 1574 The default value is set by the :ref:`ref-classes-copyleft_filter` class, 1575 which is inherited by the :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. The default 1576 value includes "GPL*", "LGPL*", and "AGPL*". 1577 1578 :term:`COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE` 1579 A list of recipes to exclude in the source archived by the 1580 :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. The :term:`COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE` 1581 variable overrides the license inclusion and exclusion caused through the 1582 :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` and :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` 1583 variables, respectively. 1584 1585 The default value, which is "" indicating to not explicitly exclude 1586 any recipes by name, for :term:`COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE` is set by the 1587 :ref:`ref-classes-copyleft_filter` class, which is inherited by the 1588 :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. 1589 1590 :term:`COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE` 1591 A list of recipes to include in the source archived by the 1592 :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. The :term:`COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE` 1593 variable overrides the license inclusion and exclusion caused through the 1594 :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` and :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` 1595 variables, respectively. 1596 1597 The default value, which is "" indicating to not explicitly include 1598 any recipes by name, for :term:`COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE` is set by the 1599 :ref:`ref-classes-copyleft_filter` class, which is inherited by the 1600 :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. 1601 1602 :term:`COPYLEFT_RECIPE_TYPES` 1603 A space-separated list of recipe types to include in the source 1604 archived by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. 1605 Recipe types are ``target``, :ref:`ref-classes-native`, 1606 :ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk`, :ref:`ref-classes-cross`, 1607 :ref:`ref-classes-crosssdk`, and :ref:`ref-classes-cross-canadian`. 1608 1609 The default value, which is "target*", for :term:`COPYLEFT_RECIPE_TYPES` 1610 is set by the :ref:`ref-classes-copyleft_filter` class, which is 1611 inherited by the :ref:`ref-classes-archiver` class. 1612 1613 :term:`CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL` 1614 Specifies the list of packages to be added to the image. You should 1615 only set this variable in the ``local.conf`` configuration file found 1616 in the :term:`Build Directory`. 1617 1618 This variable replaces ``POKY_EXTRA_INSTALL``, which is no longer 1619 supported. 1620 1621 :term:`COREBASE` 1622 Specifies the parent directory of the OpenEmbedded-Core Metadata 1623 layer (i.e. ``meta``). 1624 1625 It is an important distinction that :term:`COREBASE` points to the parent 1626 of this layer and not the layer itself. Consider an example where you 1627 have cloned the Poky Git repository and retained the ``poky`` name 1628 for your local copy of the repository. In this case, :term:`COREBASE` 1629 points to the ``poky`` folder because it is the parent directory of 1630 the ``poky/meta`` layer. 1631 1632 :term:`COREBASE_FILES` 1633 Lists files from the :term:`COREBASE` directory that 1634 should be copied other than the layers listed in the 1635 ``bblayers.conf`` file. The :term:`COREBASE_FILES` variable allows 1636 to copy metadata from the OpenEmbedded build system 1637 into the extensible SDK. 1638 1639 Explicitly listing files in :term:`COREBASE` is needed because it 1640 typically contains build directories and other files that should not 1641 normally be copied into the extensible SDK. Consequently, the value 1642 of :term:`COREBASE_FILES` is used in order to only copy the files that 1643 are actually needed. 1644 1645 :term:`CPP` 1646 The minimal command and arguments used to run the C preprocessor. 1647 1648 :term:`CPPFLAGS` 1649 Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the 1650 C and the C++ compilers). This variable is exported to an environment 1651 variable and thus made visible to the software being built during the 1652 compilation step. 1653 1654 Default initialization for :term:`CPPFLAGS` varies depending on what is 1655 being built: 1656 1657 - :term:`TARGET_CPPFLAGS` when building for 1658 the target 1659 1660 - :term:`BUILD_CPPFLAGS` when building for the 1661 build host (i.e. ``-native``) 1662 1663 - :term:`BUILDSDK_CPPFLAGS` when building 1664 for an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) 1665 1666 :term:`CROSS_COMPILE` 1667 The toolchain binary prefix for the target tools. The 1668 :term:`CROSS_COMPILE` variable is the same as the 1669 :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` variable. 1670 1671 .. note:: 1672 1673 The OpenEmbedded build system sets the :term:`CROSS_COMPILE` 1674 variable only in certain contexts (e.g. when building for kernel 1675 and kernel module recipes). 1676 1677 :term:`CVE_CHECK_IGNORE` 1678 This variable is deprecated and should be replaced by :term:`CVE_STATUS`. 1679 1680 :term:`CVE_CHECK_SHOW_WARNINGS` 1681 Specifies whether or not the :ref:`ref-classes-cve-check` 1682 class should generate warning messages on the console when unpatched 1683 CVEs are found. The default is "1", but you may wish to set it to "0" if 1684 you are already examining/processing the logs after the build has 1685 completed and thus do not need the warning messages. 1686 1687 :term:`CVE_CHECK_SKIP_RECIPE` 1688 The list of package names (:term:`PN`) for which 1689 CVEs (Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures) are ignored. 1690 1691 :term:`CVE_DB_UPDATE_INTERVAL` 1692 Specifies the CVE database update interval in seconds, as used by 1693 ``cve-update-db-native``. The default value is "86400" i.e. once a day 1694 (24*60*60). If the value is set to "0" then the update will be forced 1695 every time. Alternatively, a negative value e.g. "-1" will disable 1696 updates entirely. 1697 1698 :term:`CVE_PRODUCT` 1699 In a recipe, defines the name used to match the recipe name 1700 against the name in the upstream `NIST CVE database <https://nvd.nist.gov/>`__. 1701 1702 The default is ${:term:`BPN`} (except for recipes that inherit the 1703 :ref:`ref-classes-pypi` class where it is set based upon 1704 :term:`PYPI_PACKAGE`). If it does not match the name in the NIST CVE 1705 database or matches with multiple entries in the database, the default 1706 value needs to be changed. 1707 1708 Here is an example from the :oe_layerindex:`Berkeley DB recipe </layerindex/recipe/544>`:: 1709 1710 CVE_PRODUCT = "oracle_berkeley_db berkeley_db" 1711 1712 Sometimes the product name is not specific enough, for example 1713 "tar" has been matching CVEs for the GNU ``tar`` package and also 1714 the ``node-tar`` node.js extension. To avoid this problem, use the 1715 vendor name as a prefix. The syntax for this is:: 1716 1717 CVE_PRODUCT = "vendor:package" 1718 1719 :term:`CVE_STATUS` 1720 The CVE ID which is patched or should be ignored. Here is 1721 an example from the :oe_layerindex:`Python3 recipe</layerindex/recipe/23823>`:: 1722 1723 CVE_STATUS[CVE-2020-15523] = "not-applicable-platform: Issue only applies on Windows" 1724 1725 It has the format "reason: description" and the description is optional. 1726 The Reason is mapped to the final CVE state by mapping via 1727 :term:`CVE_CHECK_STATUSMAP`. See :ref:`dev-manual/vulnerabilities:fixing vulnerabilities in recipes` 1728 for details. 1729 1730 :term:`CVE_STATUS_GROUPS` 1731 If there are many CVEs with the same status and reason, they can by simplified by using this 1732 variable instead of many similar lines with :term:`CVE_STATUS`:: 1733 1734 CVE_STATUS_GROUPS = "CVE_STATUS_WIN CVE_STATUS_PATCHED" 1735 1736 CVE_STATUS_WIN = "CVE-1234-0001 CVE-1234-0002" 1737 CVE_STATUS_WIN[status] = "not-applicable-platform: Issue only applies on Windows" 1738 CVE_STATUS_PATCHED = "CVE-1234-0003 CVE-1234-0004" 1739 CVE_STATUS_PATCHED[status] = "fixed-version: Fixed externally" 1740 1741 :term:`CVE_CHECK_STATUSMAP` 1742 Mapping variable for all possible reasons of :term:`CVE_STATUS`: 1743 ``Patched``, ``Unpatched`` and ``Ignored``. 1744 See :ref:`ref-classes-cve-check` or ``meta/conf/cve-check-map.conf`` for more details:: 1745 1746 CVE_CHECK_STATUSMAP[cpe-incorrect] = "Ignored" 1747 1748 :term:`CVE_VERSION` 1749 In a recipe, defines the version used to match the recipe version 1750 against the version in the `NIST CVE database <https://nvd.nist.gov/>`__ 1751 when usign :ref:`ref-classes-cve-check`. 1752 1753 The default is ${:term:`PV`} but if recipes use custom version numbers 1754 which do not map to upstream software component release versions and the versions 1755 used in the CVE database, then this variable can be used to set the 1756 version number for :ref:`ref-classes-cve-check`. Example:: 1757 1758 CVE_VERSION = "2.39" 1759 1760 :term:`CVSDIR` 1761 The directory in which files checked out under the CVS system are 1762 stored. 1763 1764 :term:`CXX` 1765 The minimal command and arguments used to run the C++ compiler. 1766 1767 :term:`CXXFLAGS` 1768 Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler. This variable is 1769 exported to an environment variable and thus made visible to the 1770 software being built during the compilation step. 1771 1772 Default initialization for :term:`CXXFLAGS` varies depending on what is 1773 being built: 1774 1775 - :term:`TARGET_CXXFLAGS` when building for 1776 the target 1777 1778 - :term:`BUILD_CXXFLAGS` when building for the 1779 build host (i.e. ``-native``) 1780 1781 - :term:`BUILDSDK_CXXFLAGS` when building 1782 for an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) 1783 1784 :term:`D` 1785 The destination directory. The location in the :term:`Build Directory` 1786 where components are installed by the 1787 :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task. This location defaults 1788 to:: 1789 1790 ${WORKDIR}/image 1791 1792 .. note:: 1793 1794 Tasks that read from or write to this directory should run under 1795 :ref:`fakeroot <overview-manual/concepts:fakeroot and pseudo>`. 1796 1797 :term:`DATE` 1798 The date the build was started. Dates appear using the year, month, 1799 and day (YMD) format (e.g. "20150209" for February 9th, 2015). 1800 1801 :term:`DATETIME` 1802 The date and time on which the current build started. The format is 1803 suitable for timestamps. 1804 1805 :term:`DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME` 1806 When the :ref:`ref-classes-debian` class is inherited, 1807 which is the default behavior, :term:`DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME` specifies a 1808 particular package should not be renamed according to Debian library 1809 package naming. You must use the package name as an override when you 1810 set this variable. Here is an example from the ``fontconfig`` recipe:: 1811 1812 DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME:fontconfig-utils = "1" 1813 1814 :term:`DEBIANNAME` 1815 When the :ref:`ref-classes-debian` class is inherited, 1816 which is the default behavior, :term:`DEBIANNAME` allows you to override 1817 the library name for an individual package. Overriding the library 1818 name in these cases is rare. You must use the package name as an 1819 override when you set this variable. Here is an example from the 1820 ``dbus`` recipe:: 1821 1822 DEBIANNAME:${PN} = "dbus-1" 1823 1824 :term:`DEBUG_BUILD` 1825 Specifies to build packages with debugging information. This 1826 influences the value of the :term:`SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION` variable. 1827 1828 :term:`DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION` 1829 The options to pass in :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` and :term:`CFLAGS` when 1830 compiling a system for debugging. This variable defaults to "-O 1831 -fno-omit-frame-pointer ${DEBUG_FLAGS} -pipe". 1832 1833 :term:`DEBUG_PREFIX_MAP` 1834 Allows to set C compiler options, such as ``-fdebug-prefix-map``, 1835 ``-fmacro-prefix-map``, and ``-ffile-prefix-map``, which allow to 1836 replace build-time paths by install-time ones in the debugging sections 1837 of binaries. This makes compiler output files location independent, 1838 at the cost of having to pass an extra command to tell the debugger 1839 where source files are. 1840 1841 This is used by the Yocto Project to guarantee 1842 :doc:`/test-manual/reproducible-builds` even when the source code of 1843 a package uses the ``__FILE__`` or ``assert()`` macros. See the 1844 `reproducible-builds.org <https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/build-path/>`__ 1845 website for details. 1846 1847 This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is 1848 not intended to be user-configurable. 1849 1850 :term:`DEFAULT_PREFERENCE` 1851 Specifies a weak bias for recipe selection priority. 1852 1853 The most common usage of this is variable is to set it to "-1" within 1854 a recipe for a development version of a piece of software. Using the 1855 variable in this way causes the stable version of the recipe to build 1856 by default in the absence of :term:`PREFERRED_VERSION` being used to 1857 build the development version. 1858 1859 .. note:: 1860 1861 The bias provided by :term:`DEFAULT_PREFERENCE` is weak and is overridden 1862 by :term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY` if that variable is different between two 1863 layers that contain different versions of the same recipe. 1864 1865 :term:`DEFAULTTUNE` 1866 The default CPU and Application Binary Interface (ABI) tunings (i.e. 1867 the "tune") used by the OpenEmbedded build system. The 1868 :term:`DEFAULTTUNE` helps define 1869 :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. 1870 1871 The default tune is either implicitly or explicitly set by the 1872 machine (:term:`MACHINE`). However, you can override 1873 the setting using available tunes as defined with 1874 :term:`AVAILTUNES`. 1875 1876 :term:`DEPENDS` 1877 Lists a recipe's build-time dependencies. These are dependencies on 1878 other recipes whose contents (e.g. headers and shared libraries) are 1879 needed by the recipe at build time. 1880 1881 As an example, consider a recipe ``foo`` that contains the following 1882 assignment:: 1883 1884 DEPENDS = "bar" 1885 1886 The practical effect of the previous assignment is that all files 1887 installed by bar will be available in the appropriate staging sysroot, 1888 given by the :term:`STAGING_DIR* <STAGING_DIR>` variables, by the time 1889 the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task for ``foo`` runs. This mechanism is 1890 implemented by having :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` depend on the 1891 :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task of each recipe listed in 1892 :term:`DEPENDS`, through a 1893 ``[``\ :ref:`deptask <bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:variable flags>`\ ``]`` 1894 declaration in the :ref:`ref-classes-base` class. 1895 1896 .. note:: 1897 1898 It seldom is necessary to reference, for example, :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST` 1899 explicitly. The standard classes and build-related variables are 1900 configured to automatically use the appropriate staging sysroots. 1901 1902 As another example, :term:`DEPENDS` can also be used to add utilities 1903 that run on the build machine during the build. For example, a recipe 1904 that makes use of a code generator built by the recipe ``codegen`` 1905 might have the following:: 1906 1907 DEPENDS = "codegen-native" 1908 1909 For more 1910 information, see the :ref:`ref-classes-native` class and 1911 the :term:`EXTRANATIVEPATH` variable. 1912 1913 .. note:: 1914 1915 - :term:`DEPENDS` is a list of recipe names. Or, to be more precise, 1916 it is a list of :term:`PROVIDES` names, which 1917 usually match recipe names. Putting a package name such as 1918 "foo-dev" in :term:`DEPENDS` does not make sense. Use "foo" 1919 instead, as this will put files from all the packages that make 1920 up ``foo``, which includes those from ``foo-dev``, into the 1921 sysroot. 1922 1923 - One recipe having another recipe in :term:`DEPENDS` does not by 1924 itself add any runtime dependencies between the packages 1925 produced by the two recipes. However, as explained in the 1926 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`" 1927 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, 1928 runtime dependencies will often be added automatically, meaning 1929 :term:`DEPENDS` alone is sufficient for most recipes. 1930 1931 - Counterintuitively, :term:`DEPENDS` is often necessary even for 1932 recipes that install precompiled components. For example, if 1933 ``libfoo`` is a precompiled library that links against 1934 ``libbar``, then linking against ``libfoo`` requires both 1935 ``libfoo`` and ``libbar`` to be available in the sysroot. 1936 Without a :term:`DEPENDS` from the recipe that installs ``libfoo`` 1937 to the recipe that installs ``libbar``, other recipes might 1938 fail to link against ``libfoo``. 1939 1940 For information on runtime dependencies, see the :term:`RDEPENDS` 1941 variable. You can also see the 1942 ":ref:`bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks`" and 1943 ":ref:`bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies`" 1944 sections in the BitBake User Manual for additional information on tasks 1945 and dependencies. 1946 1947 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR` 1948 Points to the general area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to 1949 place images, packages, SDKs, and other output files that are ready 1950 to be used outside of the build system. By default, this directory 1951 resides within the :term:`Build Directory` as ``${TMPDIR}/deploy``. 1952 1953 For more information on the structure of the Build Directory, see 1954 ":ref:`ref-manual/structure:the build directory --- \`\`build/\`\``" section. 1955 For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy`` directory, see the 1956 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:images`", 1957 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:package feeds`", and 1958 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:application development sdk`" sections all in the 1959 Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 1960 1961 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_DEB` 1962 Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place 1963 Debian packages that are ready to be used outside of the build 1964 system. This variable applies only when :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains 1965 ":ref:`ref-classes-package_deb`". 1966 1967 The BitBake configuration file initially defines the 1968 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_DEB` variable as a sub-folder of 1969 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`:: 1970 1971 DEPLOY_DIR_DEB = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/deb" 1972 1973 The :ref:`ref-classes-package_deb` class uses the 1974 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_DEB` variable to make sure the 1975 :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_deb` task 1976 writes Debian packages into the appropriate folder. For more 1977 information on how packaging works, see the 1978 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:package feeds`" section 1979 in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 1980 1981 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` 1982 Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place 1983 images and other associated output files that are ready to be 1984 deployed onto the target machine. The directory is machine-specific 1985 as it contains the ``${MACHINE}`` name. By default, this directory 1986 resides within the :term:`Build Directory` as 1987 ``${DEPLOY_DIR}/images/${MACHINE}/``. 1988 1989 It must not be used directly in recipes when deploying files. Instead, 1990 it's only useful when a recipe needs to "read" a file already deployed 1991 by a dependency. So, it should be filled with the contents of 1992 :term:`DEPLOYDIR` by the :ref:`ref-classes-deploy` class or with the 1993 contents of :term:`IMGDEPLOYDIR` by the :ref:`ref-classes-image` class. 1994 1995 For more information on the structure of the :term:`Build Directory`, see 1996 ":ref:`ref-manual/structure:the build directory --- \`\`build/\`\``" section. 1997 For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy`` directory, see the 1998 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:images`" and 1999 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:application development sdk`" sections both in 2000 the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 2001 2002 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IPK` 2003 Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place 2004 IPK packages that are ready to be used outside of the build system. 2005 This variable applies only when :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains 2006 ":ref:`ref-classes-package_ipk`". 2007 2008 The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a 2009 sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`:: 2010 2011 DEPLOY_DIR_IPK = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/ipk" 2012 2013 The :ref:`ref-classes-package_ipk` class uses the :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IPK` 2014 variable to make sure the :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_ipk` task 2015 writes IPK packages into the appropriate folder. For more information 2016 on how packaging works, see the 2017 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:package feeds`" section 2018 in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 2019 2020 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_RPM` 2021 Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place 2022 RPM packages that are ready to be used outside of the build system. 2023 This variable applies only when :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains 2024 ":ref:`ref-classes-package_rpm`". 2025 2026 The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a 2027 sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`:: 2028 2029 DEPLOY_DIR_RPM = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/rpm" 2030 2031 The :ref:`ref-classes-package_rpm` class uses the 2032 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_RPM` variable to make sure the 2033 :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_rpm` task 2034 writes RPM packages into the appropriate folder. For more information 2035 on how packaging works, see the 2036 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:package feeds`" section 2037 in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 2038 2039 :term:`DEPLOYDIR` 2040 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-deploy` class, the 2041 :term:`DEPLOYDIR` points to a temporary work area for deployed files that 2042 is set in the :ref:`ref-classes-deploy` class as follows:: 2043 2044 DEPLOYDIR = "${WORKDIR}/deploy-${PN}" 2045 2046 Recipes inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-deploy` class should copy files to be 2047 deployed into :term:`DEPLOYDIR`, and the class will take care of copying 2048 them into :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` 2049 afterwards. 2050 2051 :term:`DESCRIPTION` 2052 The package description used by package managers. If not set, 2053 :term:`DESCRIPTION` takes the value of the :term:`SUMMARY` 2054 variable. 2055 2056 :term:`DEV_PKG_DEPENDENCY` 2057 Provides an easy way for recipes to disable or adjust the runtime recommendation 2058 (:term:`RRECOMMENDS`) of the ``${PN}-dev`` package on the main 2059 (``${PN}``) package. 2060 2061 :term:`DISABLE_STATIC` 2062 Used in order to disable static linking by default (in order to save 2063 space, since static libraries are often unused in embedded systems.) 2064 The default value is " --disable-static", however it can be set to "" 2065 in order to enable static linking if desired. Certain recipes do this 2066 individually, and also there is a 2067 ``meta/conf/distro/include/no-static-libs.inc`` include file that 2068 disables static linking for a number of recipes. Some software 2069 packages or build tools (such as CMake) have explicit support for 2070 enabling / disabling static linking, and in those cases 2071 :term:`DISABLE_STATIC` is not used. 2072 2073 :term:`DISTRO` 2074 The short name of the distribution. For information on the long name 2075 of the distribution, see the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` 2076 variable. 2077 2078 The :term:`DISTRO` variable corresponds to a distribution configuration 2079 file whose root name is the same as the variable's argument and whose 2080 filename extension is ``.conf``. For example, the distribution 2081 configuration file for the Poky distribution is named ``poky.conf`` 2082 and resides in the ``meta-poky/conf/distro`` directory of the 2083 :term:`Source Directory`. 2084 2085 Within that ``poky.conf`` file, the :term:`DISTRO` variable is set as 2086 follows:: 2087 2088 DISTRO = "poky" 2089 2090 Distribution configuration files are located in a ``conf/distro`` 2091 directory within the :term:`Metadata` that contains the 2092 distribution configuration. The value for :term:`DISTRO` must not contain 2093 spaces, and is typically all lower-case. 2094 2095 .. note:: 2096 2097 If the :term:`DISTRO` variable is blank, a set of default configurations 2098 are used, which are specified within 2099 ``meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf`` also in the Source Directory. 2100 2101 :term:`DISTRO_CODENAME` 2102 Specifies a codename for the distribution being built. 2103 2104 :term:`DISTRO_EXTRA_RDEPENDS` 2105 Specifies a list of distro-specific packages to add to all images. 2106 This variable takes effect through ``packagegroup-base`` so the 2107 variable only really applies to the more full-featured images that 2108 include ``packagegroup-base``. You can use this variable to keep 2109 distro policy out of generic images. As with all other distro 2110 variables, you set this variable in the distro ``.conf`` file. 2111 2112 :term:`DISTRO_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS` 2113 Specifies a list of distro-specific packages to add to all images if 2114 the packages exist. The packages might not exist or be empty (e.g. 2115 kernel modules). The list of packages are automatically installed but 2116 you can remove them. 2117 2118 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` 2119 The software support you want in your distribution for various 2120 features. You define your distribution features in the distribution 2121 configuration file. 2122 2123 In most cases, the presence or absence of a feature in 2124 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` is translated to the appropriate option supplied 2125 to the configure script during the 2126 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task for recipes that 2127 optionally support the feature. For example, specifying "x11" in 2128 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`, causes every piece of software built for the 2129 target that can optionally support X11 to have its X11 support 2130 enabled. 2131 2132 .. note:: 2133 2134 Just enabling :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` alone doesn't 2135 enable feature support for packages. Mechanisms such as making 2136 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` track :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` are used 2137 to enable/disable package features. 2138 2139 Two more examples are Bluetooth and NFS support. For a more complete 2140 list of features that ships with the Yocto Project and that you can 2141 provide with this variable, see the ":ref:`ref-features-distro`" section. 2142 2143 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL` 2144 A space-separated list of features to be added to :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` 2145 if not also present in :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`. 2146 2147 This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is 2148 not intended to be user-configurable. It is best to just reference 2149 the variable to see which distro features are being 2150 :ref:`backfilled <ref-features-backfill>` for all distro configurations. 2151 2152 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED` 2153 A space-separated list of features from :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL` 2154 that should not be :ref:`backfilled <ref-features-backfill>` (i.e. added 2155 to :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`) during the build. 2156 2157 This corresponds to an opt-out mechanism. When new default distro 2158 features are introduced, distribution maintainers can review (`consider`) 2159 them and decide to exclude them from the 2160 :ref:`backfilled <ref-features-backfill>` features. Therefore, the 2161 combination of :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL` and 2162 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED` makes it possible to 2163 add new default features without breaking existing distributions. 2164 2165 2166 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT` 2167 A convenience variable that gives you the default list of distro 2168 features with the exception of any features specific to the C library 2169 (``libc``). 2170 2171 When creating a custom distribution, you might find it useful to be 2172 able to reuse the default 2173 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` options without the 2174 need to write out the full set. Here is an example that uses 2175 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT` from a custom distro configuration file:: 2176 2177 DISTRO_FEATURES ?= "${DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT} myfeature" 2178 2179 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE` 2180 Specifies a list of features that if present in the target 2181 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value should be 2182 included in :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building native recipes. This 2183 variable is used in addition to the features filtered using the 2184 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE` 2185 variable. 2186 2187 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK` 2188 Specifies a list of features that if present in the target 2189 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value should be included in 2190 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building :ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk` 2191 recipes. This variable is used in addition to the features filtered using 2192 the :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK` variable. 2193 2194 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE` 2195 Specifies a list of features that should be included in 2196 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building native 2197 recipes. This variable is used in addition to the features filtered 2198 using the 2199 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE` 2200 variable. 2201 2202 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK` 2203 Specifies a list of features that should be included in 2204 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building 2205 :ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk` recipes. This variable is used 2206 in addition to the features filtered using the 2207 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK` variable. 2208 2209 :term:`DISTRO_NAME` 2210 The long name of the distribution. For information on the short name 2211 of the distribution, see the :term:`DISTRO` variable. 2212 2213 The :term:`DISTRO_NAME` variable corresponds to a distribution 2214 configuration file whose root name is the same as the variable's 2215 argument and whose filename extension is ``.conf``. For example, the 2216 distribution configuration file for the Poky distribution is named 2217 ``poky.conf`` and resides in the ``meta-poky/conf/distro`` directory 2218 of the :term:`Source Directory`. 2219 2220 Within that ``poky.conf`` file, the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` variable is set 2221 as follows:: 2222 2223 DISTRO_NAME = "Poky (Yocto Project Reference Distro)" 2224 2225 Distribution configuration files are located in a ``conf/distro`` 2226 directory within the :term:`Metadata` that contains the 2227 distribution configuration. 2228 2229 .. note:: 2230 2231 If the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` variable is blank, a set of default 2232 configurations are used, which are specified within 2233 ``meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf`` also in the Source Directory. 2234 2235 :term:`DISTRO_VERSION` 2236 The version of the distribution. 2237 2238 :term:`DISTROOVERRIDES` 2239 A colon-separated list of overrides specific to the current 2240 distribution. By default, this list includes the value of 2241 :term:`DISTRO`. 2242 2243 You can extend :term:`DISTROOVERRIDES` to add extra overrides that should 2244 apply to the distribution. 2245 2246 The underlying mechanism behind :term:`DISTROOVERRIDES` is simply that it 2247 is included in the default value of 2248 :term:`OVERRIDES`. 2249 2250 Here is an example from :yocto_git:`meta-poky/conf/distro/poky-tiny.conf 2251 </poky/tree/meta-poky/conf/distro/poky-tiny.conf>`:: 2252 2253 DISTROOVERRIDES = "poky:poky-tiny" 2254 2255 :term:`DL_DIR` 2256 The central download directory used by the build process to store 2257 downloads. By default, :term:`DL_DIR` gets files suitable for mirroring 2258 for everything except Git repositories. If you want tarballs of Git 2259 repositories, use the 2260 :term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS` 2261 variable. 2262 2263 You can set this directory by defining the :term:`DL_DIR` variable in the 2264 ``conf/local.conf`` file. This directory is self-maintaining and you 2265 should not have to touch it. By default, the directory is 2266 ``downloads`` in the :term:`Build Directory`:: 2267 2268 #DL_DIR ?= "${TOPDIR}/downloads" 2269 2270 To specify a different download directory, 2271 simply remove the comment from the line and provide your directory. 2272 2273 During a first build, the system downloads many different source code 2274 tarballs from various upstream projects. Downloading can take a 2275 while, particularly if your network connection is slow. Tarballs are 2276 all stored in the directory defined by :term:`DL_DIR` and the build 2277 system looks there first to find source tarballs. 2278 2279 .. note:: 2280 2281 When wiping and rebuilding, you can preserve this directory to 2282 speed up this part of subsequent builds. 2283 2284 You can safely share this directory between multiple builds on the 2285 same development machine. For additional information on how the build 2286 process gets source files when working behind a firewall or proxy 2287 server, see this specific question in the ":doc:`faq`" 2288 chapter. You can also refer to the 2289 ":yocto_wiki:`Working Behind a Network Proxy </Working_Behind_a_Network_Proxy>`" 2290 Wiki page. 2291 2292 :term:`DOC_COMPRESS` 2293 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-compress_doc` 2294 class, this variable sets the compression policy used when the 2295 OpenEmbedded build system compresses man pages and info pages. By 2296 default, the compression method used is gz (gzip). Other policies 2297 available are xz and bz2. 2298 2299 For information on policies and on how to use this variable, see the 2300 comments in the ``meta/classes-recipe/compress_doc.bbclass`` file. 2301 2302 :term:`DT_FILES` 2303 Space-separated list of device tree source files to compile using 2304 a recipe that inherits the :ref:`ref-classes-devicetree` class. These 2305 are relative to the :term:`DT_FILES_PATH`. 2306 2307 For convenience, both ``.dts`` and ``.dtb`` extensions can be used. 2308 2309 Use an empty string (default) to build all device tree sources within 2310 the :term:`DT_FILES_PATH` directory. 2311 2312 :term:`DT_FILES_PATH` 2313 When compiling out-of-tree device tree sources using a recipe that 2314 inherits the :ref:`ref-classes-devicetree` class, this variable specifies 2315 the path to the directory containing dts files to build. 2316 2317 Defaults to the :term:`S` directory. 2318 2319 :term:`DT_PADDING_SIZE` 2320 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-devicetree` class, this variable 2321 specifies the size of padding appended to the device tree blob, used as 2322 extra space typically for additional properties during boot. 2323 2324 :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` 2325 When building bootable images (i.e. where ``hddimg``, ``iso``, or 2326 ``wic.vmdk`` is in :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`), the 2327 :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` variable specifies the EFI bootloader to use. The 2328 default is "grub-efi", but "systemd-boot" can be used instead. 2329 2330 See the :ref:`ref-classes-systemd-boot` and :ref:`ref-classes-image-live` 2331 classes for more information. 2332 2333 :term:`ENABLE_BINARY_LOCALE_GENERATION` 2334 Variable that controls which locales for ``glibc`` are generated 2335 during the build (useful if the target device has 64Mbytes of RAM or 2336 less). 2337 2338 :term:`ERR_REPORT_DIR` 2339 When used with the :ref:`ref-classes-report-error` class, specifies the 2340 path used for storing the debug files created by the :ref:`error reporting 2341 tool <dev-manual/error-reporting-tool:using the error reporting tool>`, 2342 which allows you to submit build errors you encounter to a central 2343 database. By default, the value of this variable is 2344 ``${``\ :term:`LOG_DIR`\ ``}/error-report``. 2345 2346 You can set :term:`ERR_REPORT_DIR` to the path you want the error 2347 reporting tool to store the debug files as follows in your 2348 ``local.conf`` file:: 2349 2350 ERR_REPORT_DIR = "path" 2351 2352 :term:`ERROR_QA` 2353 Specifies the quality assurance checks whose failures are reported as 2354 errors by the OpenEmbedded build system. You set this variable in 2355 your distribution configuration file. For a list of the checks you 2356 can control with this variable, see the 2357 ":ref:`ref-classes-insane`" section. 2358 2359 :term:`ESDK_CLASS_INHERIT_DISABLE` 2360 A list of classes to remove from the :term:`INHERIT` 2361 value globally within the extensible SDK configuration. The 2362 :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class sets the 2363 default value:: 2364 2365 ESDK_CLASS_INHERIT_DISABLE ?= "buildhistory icecc" 2366 2367 Some classes are not generally applicable within the extensible SDK 2368 context. You can use this variable to disable those classes. 2369 2370 For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's 2371 configuration, see the 2372 ":ref:`sdk-manual/appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`" 2373 section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the 2374 Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. 2375 2376 :term:`ESDK_LOCALCONF_ALLOW` 2377 A list of variables allowed through from the OpenEmbedded build 2378 system configuration into the extensible SDK configuration. By 2379 default, the list of variables is empty and is set in the 2380 :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class. 2381 2382 This list overrides the variables specified using the 2383 :term:`ESDK_LOCALCONF_REMOVE` variable as well as 2384 other variables automatically added due to the "/" character 2385 being found at the start of the 2386 value, which is usually indicative of being a path and thus might not 2387 be valid on the system where the SDK is installed. 2388 2389 For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's 2390 configuration, see the 2391 ":ref:`sdk-manual/appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`" 2392 section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the 2393 Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. 2394 2395 :term:`ESDK_LOCALCONF_REMOVE` 2396 A list of variables not allowed through from the OpenEmbedded build 2397 system configuration into the extensible SDK configuration. Usually, 2398 these are variables that are specific to the machine on which the 2399 build system is running and thus would be potentially problematic 2400 within the extensible SDK. 2401 2402 By default, :term:`ESDK_LOCALCONF_REMOVE` is set in the 2403 :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class and 2404 excludes the following variables: 2405 2406 - :term:`CONF_VERSION` 2407 - :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` 2408 - :term:`BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS` 2409 - :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` 2410 - :term:`PRSERV_HOST` 2411 - :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` :term:`DL_DIR` 2412 - :term:`SSTATE_DIR` :term:`TMPDIR` 2413 - :term:`BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT` 2414 2415 For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's 2416 configuration, see the 2417 ":ref:`sdk-manual/appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`" 2418 section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the 2419 Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. 2420 2421 :term:`EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS` 2422 Triggers the OpenEmbedded build system's shared libraries resolver to 2423 exclude an entire package when scanning for shared libraries. 2424 2425 .. note:: 2426 2427 The shared libraries resolver's functionality results in part from 2428 the internal function ``package_do_shlibs``, which is part of the 2429 :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task. You should be aware that the shared 2430 libraries resolver might implicitly define some dependencies between 2431 packages. 2432 2433 The :term:`EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS` variable is similar to the 2434 :term:`PRIVATE_LIBS` variable, which excludes a 2435 package's particular libraries only and not the whole package. 2436 2437 Use the :term:`EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS` variable by setting it to "1" for a 2438 particular package:: 2439 2440 EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS = "1" 2441 2442 :term:`EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD` 2443 Directs BitBake to exclude a recipe from world builds (i.e. 2444 ``bitbake world``). During world builds, BitBake locates, parses and 2445 builds all recipes found in every layer exposed in the 2446 ``bblayers.conf`` configuration file. 2447 2448 To exclude a recipe from a world build using this variable, set the 2449 variable to "1" in the recipe. 2450 2451 .. note:: 2452 2453 Recipes added to :term:`EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD` may still be built during a 2454 world build in order to satisfy dependencies of other recipes. Adding 2455 a recipe to :term:`EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD` only ensures that the recipe is not 2456 explicitly added to the list of build targets in a world build. 2457 2458 :term:`EXTENDPE` 2459 Used with file and pathnames to create a prefix for a recipe's 2460 version based on the recipe's :term:`PE` value. If :term:`PE` 2461 is set and greater than zero for a recipe, :term:`EXTENDPE` becomes that 2462 value (e.g if :term:`PE` is equal to "1" then :term:`EXTENDPE` becomes "1"). 2463 If a recipe's :term:`PE` is not set (the default) or is equal to zero, 2464 :term:`EXTENDPE` becomes "". 2465 2466 See the :term:`STAMP` variable for an example. 2467 2468 :term:`EXTENDPKGV` 2469 The full package version specification as it appears on the final 2470 packages produced by a recipe. The variable's value is normally used 2471 to fix a runtime dependency to the exact same version of another 2472 package in the same recipe:: 2473 2474 RDEPENDS:${PN}-additional-module = "${PN} (= ${EXTENDPKGV})" 2475 2476 The dependency relationships are intended to force the package 2477 manager to upgrade these types of packages in lock-step. 2478 2479 :term:`EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS` 2480 When set, the :term:`EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS` variable indicates that these 2481 tools are not in the source tree. 2482 2483 When kernel tools are available in the tree, they are preferred over 2484 any externally installed tools. Setting the :term:`EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS` 2485 variable tells the OpenEmbedded build system to prefer the installed 2486 external tools. See the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-yocto` class in 2487 ``meta/classes-recipe`` to see how the variable is used. 2488 2489 :term:`KERNEL_LOCALVERSION` 2490 This variable allows to append a string to the version 2491 of the kernel image. This corresponds to the ``CONFIG_LOCALVERSION`` 2492 kernel configuration parameter. 2493 2494 Using this variable is only useful when you are using a kernel recipe 2495 inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class, and which doesn't 2496 already set a local version. Therefore, setting this variable has no 2497 impact on ``linux-yocto`` kernels. 2498 2499 :term:`EXTERNAL_TOOLCHAIN` 2500 When you intend to use an 2501 :ref:`external toolchain <dev-manual/external-toolchain:optionally using an external toolchain>`, 2502 this variable allows to specify the directory where this toolchain was 2503 installed. 2504 2505 :term:`EXTERNALSRC` 2506 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-externalsrc` 2507 class, this variable points to the source tree, which is outside of 2508 the OpenEmbedded build system. When set, this variable sets the 2509 :term:`S` variable, which is what the OpenEmbedded build 2510 system uses to locate unpacked recipe source code. 2511 2512 See the ":ref:`ref-classes-externalsrc`" section for details. You 2513 can also find information on how to use this variable in the 2514 ":ref:`dev-manual/building:building software from an external source`" 2515 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 2516 2517 :term:`EXTERNALSRC_BUILD` 2518 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-externalsrc` 2519 class, this variable points to the directory in which the recipe's 2520 source code is built, which is outside of the OpenEmbedded build 2521 system. When set, this variable sets the :term:`B` variable, 2522 which is what the OpenEmbedded build system uses to locate the 2523 :term:`Build Directory`. 2524 2525 See the ":ref:`ref-classes-externalsrc`" section for details. You 2526 can also find information on how to use this variable in the 2527 ":ref:`dev-manual/building:building software from an external source`" 2528 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 2529 2530 :term:`EXTRA_AUTORECONF` 2531 For recipes inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-autotools` 2532 class, you can use :term:`EXTRA_AUTORECONF` to specify extra options to 2533 pass to the ``autoreconf`` command that is executed during the 2534 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task. 2535 2536 The default value is "--exclude=autopoint". 2537 2538 :term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` 2539 A list of additional features to include in an image. When listing 2540 more than one feature, separate them with a space. 2541 2542 Typically, you configure this variable in your ``local.conf`` file, 2543 which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`. Although you can use this 2544 variable from within a recipe, best practices dictate that you do not. 2545 2546 .. note:: 2547 2548 To enable primary features from within the image recipe, use the 2549 :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` variable. 2550 2551 Here are some examples of features you can add: 2552 2553 - "dbg-pkgs" --- adds -dbg packages for all installed packages including 2554 symbol information for debugging and profiling. 2555 2556 - "debug-tweaks" --- makes an image suitable for debugging. For example, allows root logins without passwords and 2557 enables post-installation logging. See the 'allow-empty-password' and 2558 'post-install-logging' features in the ":ref:`ref-features-image`" 2559 section for more information. 2560 - "dev-pkgs" --- adds -dev packages for all installed packages. This is 2561 useful if you want to develop against the libraries in the image. 2562 - "read-only-rootfs" --- creates an image whose root filesystem is 2563 read-only. See the 2564 ":ref:`dev-manual/read-only-rootfs:creating a read-only root filesystem`" 2565 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more 2566 information 2567 - "tools-debug" --- adds debugging tools such as gdb and strace. 2568 - "tools-sdk" --- adds development tools such as gcc, make, 2569 pkgconfig and so forth. 2570 - "tools-testapps" --- adds useful testing tools 2571 such as ts_print, aplay, arecord and so forth. 2572 2573 For a complete list of image features that ships with the Yocto 2574 Project, see the ":ref:`ref-features-image`" section. 2575 2576 For an example that shows how to customize your image by using this 2577 variable, see the ":ref:`dev-manual/customizing-images:customizing images using custom \`\`image_features\`\` and \`\`extra_image_features\`\``" 2578 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 2579 2580 :term:`EXTRA_IMAGECMD` 2581 Specifies additional options for the image creation command that has 2582 been specified in :term:`IMAGE_CMD`. When setting 2583 this variable, use an override for the associated image type. Here is 2584 an example:: 2585 2586 EXTRA_IMAGECMD:ext3 ?= "-i 4096" 2587 2588 :term:`EXTRA_IMAGEDEPENDS` 2589 A list of recipes to build that do not provide packages for 2590 installing into the root filesystem. 2591 2592 Sometimes a recipe is required to build the final image but is not 2593 needed in the root filesystem. You can use the :term:`EXTRA_IMAGEDEPENDS` 2594 variable to list these recipes and thus specify the dependencies. A 2595 typical example is a required bootloader in a machine configuration. 2596 2597 .. note:: 2598 2599 To add packages to the root filesystem, see the various 2600 :term:`RDEPENDS` and :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variables. 2601 2602 :term:`EXTRA_OECMAKE` 2603 Additional `CMake <https://cmake.org/overview/>`__ options. See the 2604 :ref:`ref-classes-cmake` class for additional information. 2605 2606 :term:`EXTRA_OECONF` 2607 Additional ``configure`` script options. See 2608 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` for 2609 additional information on passing configure script options. 2610 2611 :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE` 2612 Additional GNU ``make`` options. 2613 2614 Because the :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE` defaults to "", you need to set the 2615 variable to specify any required GNU options. 2616 2617 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` and 2618 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST` also make use of 2619 :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE` to pass the required flags. 2620 2621 :term:`EXTRA_OESCONS` 2622 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-scons` class, this 2623 variable specifies additional configuration options you want to pass 2624 to the ``scons`` command line. 2625 2626 :term:`EXTRA_OEMESON` 2627 Additional `Meson <https://mesonbuild.com/>`__ options. See the 2628 :ref:`ref-classes-meson` class for additional information. 2629 2630 In addition to standard Meson options, such options correspond to 2631 `Meson build options <https://mesonbuild.com/Build-options.html>`__ 2632 defined in the ``meson_options.txt`` file in the sources to build. 2633 Here is an example:: 2634 2635 EXTRA_OEMESON = "-Dpython=disabled -Dvalgrind=disabled" 2636 2637 Note that any custom value for the Meson ``--buildtype`` option 2638 should be set through the :term:`MESON_BUILDTYPE` variable. 2639 2640 :term:`EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS` 2641 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-extrausers` 2642 class, this variable provides image level user and group operations. 2643 This is a more global method of providing user and group 2644 configuration as compared to using the 2645 :ref:`ref-classes-useradd` class, which ties user and 2646 group configurations to a specific recipe. 2647 2648 The set list of commands you can configure using the 2649 :term:`EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS` is shown in the 2650 :ref:`ref-classes-extrausers` class. These commands map to the normal 2651 Unix commands of the same names:: 2652 2653 # EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\ 2654 # useradd -p '' tester; \ 2655 # groupadd developers; \ 2656 # userdel nobody; \ 2657 # groupdel -g video; \ 2658 # groupmod -g 1020 developers; \ 2659 # usermod -s /bin/sh tester; \ 2660 # " 2661 2662 Hardcoded passwords are supported via the ``-p`` parameters for 2663 ``useradd`` or ``usermod``, but only hashed. 2664 2665 Here is an example that adds two users named "tester-jim" and "tester-sue" and assigns 2666 passwords. First on host, create the (escaped) password hash:: 2667 2668 printf "%q" $(mkpasswd -m sha256crypt tester01) 2669 2670 The resulting hash is set to a variable and used in ``useradd`` command parameters:: 2671 2672 inherit extrausers 2673 PASSWD = "\$X\$ABC123\$A-Long-Hash" 2674 EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\ 2675 useradd -p '${PASSWD}' tester-jim; \ 2676 useradd -p '${PASSWD}' tester-sue; \ 2677 " 2678 2679 Finally, here is an example that sets the root password:: 2680 2681 inherit extrausers 2682 EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\ 2683 usermod -p '${PASSWD}' root; \ 2684 " 2685 2686 .. note:: 2687 2688 From a security perspective, hardcoding a default password is not 2689 generally a good idea or even legal in some jurisdictions. It is 2690 recommended that you do not do this if you are building a production 2691 image. 2692 2693 Additionally there is a special ``passwd-expire`` command that will 2694 cause the password for a user to be expired and thus force changing it 2695 on first login, for example:: 2696 2697 EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS += " useradd myuser; passwd-expire myuser;" 2698 2699 .. note:: 2700 2701 At present, ``passwd-expire`` may only work for remote logins when 2702 using OpenSSH and not dropbear as an SSH server. 2703 2704 :term:`EXTRANATIVEPATH` 2705 A list of subdirectories of 2706 ``${``\ :term:`STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE`\ ``}`` 2707 added to the beginning of the environment variable ``PATH``. As an 2708 example, the following prepends 2709 "${STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE}/foo:${STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE}/bar:" to 2710 ``PATH``:: 2711 2712 EXTRANATIVEPATH = "foo bar" 2713 2714 :term:`FAKEROOT` 2715 See :term:`bitbake:FAKEROOT` in the BitBake manual. 2716 2717 :term:`FAKEROOTBASEENV` 2718 See :term:`bitbake:FAKEROOTBASEENV` in the BitBake manual. 2719 2720 :term:`FAKEROOTCMD` 2721 See :term:`bitbake:FAKEROOTCMD` in the BitBake manual. 2722 2723 :term:`FAKEROOTDIRS` 2724 See :term:`bitbake:FAKEROOTDIRS` in the BitBake manual. 2725 2726 :term:`FAKEROOTENV` 2727 See :term:`bitbake:FAKEROOTENV` in the BitBake manual. 2728 2729 :term:`FAKEROOTNOENV` 2730 See :term:`bitbake:FAKEROOTNOENV` in the BitBake manual. 2731 2732 :term:`FEATURE_PACKAGES` 2733 Defines one or more packages to include in an image when a specific 2734 item is included in :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. 2735 When setting the value, :term:`FEATURE_PACKAGES` should have the name of 2736 the feature item as an override. Here is an example:: 2737 2738 FEATURE_PACKAGES_widget = "package1 package2" 2739 2740 In this example, if "widget" were added to :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`, 2741 package1 and package2 would be included in the image. 2742 2743 .. note:: 2744 2745 Packages installed by features defined through :term:`FEATURE_PACKAGES` 2746 are often package groups. While similarly named, you should not 2747 confuse the :term:`FEATURE_PACKAGES` variable with package groups, which 2748 are discussed elsewhere in the documentation. 2749 2750 :term:`FEED_DEPLOYDIR_BASE_URI` 2751 Points to the base URL of the server and location within the 2752 document-root that provides the metadata and packages required by 2753 OPKG to support runtime package management of IPK packages. You set 2754 this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. 2755 2756 Consider the following example:: 2757 2758 FEED_DEPLOYDIR_BASE_URI = "http://192.168.7.1/BOARD-dir" 2759 2760 This example assumes you are serving 2761 your packages over HTTP and your databases are located in a directory 2762 named ``BOARD-dir``, which is underneath your HTTP server's 2763 document-root. In this case, the OpenEmbedded build system generates 2764 a set of configuration files for you in your target that work with 2765 the feed. 2766 2767 :term:`FETCHCMD` 2768 See :term:`bitbake:FETCHCMD` in the BitBake manual. 2769 2770 :term:`FILE` 2771 See :term:`bitbake:FILE` in the BitBake manual. 2772 2773 :term:`FILES` 2774 The list of files and directories that are placed in a package. The 2775 :term:`PACKAGES` variable lists the packages 2776 generated by a recipe. 2777 2778 To use the :term:`FILES` variable, provide a package name override that 2779 identifies the resulting package. Then, provide a space-separated 2780 list of files or paths that identify the files you want included as 2781 part of the resulting package. Here is an example:: 2782 2783 FILES:${PN} += "${bindir}/mydir1 ${bindir}/mydir2/myfile" 2784 2785 .. note:: 2786 2787 - When specifying files or paths, you can pattern match using 2788 Python's 2789 `glob <https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html>`__ 2790 syntax. For details on the syntax, see the documentation by 2791 following the previous link. 2792 2793 - When specifying paths as part of the :term:`FILES` variable, it is 2794 good practice to use appropriate path variables. For example, 2795 use ``${sysconfdir}`` rather than ``/etc``, or ``${bindir}`` 2796 rather than ``/usr/bin``. You can find a list of these 2797 variables at the top of the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file in 2798 the :term:`Source Directory`. You will also 2799 find the default values of the various ``FILES:*`` variables in 2800 this file. 2801 2802 If some of the files you provide with the :term:`FILES` variable are 2803 editable and you know they should not be overwritten during the 2804 package update process by the Package Management System (PMS), you 2805 can identify these files so that the PMS will not overwrite them. See 2806 the :term:`CONFFILES` variable for information on 2807 how to identify these files to the PMS. 2808 2809 :term:`FILES_SOLIBSDEV` 2810 Defines the file specification to match 2811 :term:`SOLIBSDEV`. In other words, 2812 :term:`FILES_SOLIBSDEV` defines the full path name of the development 2813 symbolic link (symlink) for shared libraries on the target platform. 2814 2815 The following statement from the ``bitbake.conf`` shows how it is 2816 set:: 2817 2818 FILES_SOLIBSDEV ?= "${base_libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV} ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV}" 2819 2820 :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` 2821 A colon-separated list to extend the search path the OpenEmbedded build 2822 system uses when looking for files and patches as it processes recipes 2823 and append files. The default directories BitBake uses when it processes 2824 recipes are initially defined by the :term:`FILESPATH` variable. You can 2825 extend :term:`FILESPATH` variable by using :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS`. 2826 2827 Best practices dictate that you accomplish this by using 2828 :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` from within a ``.bbappend`` file and that you 2829 prepend paths as follows:: 2830 2831 FILESEXTRAPATHS:prepend := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:" 2832 2833 In the above example, the build system first 2834 looks for files in a directory that has the same name as the 2835 corresponding append file. 2836 2837 .. note:: 2838 2839 When extending :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS`, be sure to use the immediate 2840 expansion (``:=``) operator. Immediate expansion makes sure that 2841 BitBake evaluates :term:`THISDIR` at the time the 2842 directive is encountered rather than at some later time when 2843 expansion might result in a directory that does not contain the 2844 files you need. 2845 2846 Also, include the trailing separating colon character if you are 2847 prepending. The trailing colon character is necessary because you 2848 are directing BitBake to extend the path by prepending directories 2849 to the search path. 2850 2851 Here is another common use:: 2852 2853 FILESEXTRAPATHS:prepend := "${THISDIR}/files:" 2854 2855 In this example, the build system extends the 2856 :term:`FILESPATH` variable to include a directory named ``files`` that is 2857 in the same directory as the corresponding append file. 2858 2859 This next example specifically adds three paths:: 2860 2861 FILESEXTRAPATHS:prepend := "path_1:path_2:path_3:" 2862 2863 A final example shows how you can extend the search path and include 2864 a :term:`MACHINE`-specific override, which is useful 2865 in a BSP layer:: 2866 2867 FILESEXTRAPATHS:prepend:intel-x86-common := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:" 2868 2869 The previous statement appears in the 2870 ``linux-yocto-dev.bbappend`` file, which is found in the 2871 :ref:`overview-manual/development-environment:yocto project source repositories` in 2872 ``meta-intel/common/recipes-kernel/linux``. Here, the machine 2873 override is a special :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` 2874 definition for multiple ``meta-intel`` machines. 2875 2876 .. note:: 2877 2878 For a layer that supports a single BSP, the override could just be 2879 the value of :term:`MACHINE`. 2880 2881 By prepending paths in ``.bbappend`` files, you allow multiple append 2882 files that reside in different layers but are used for the same 2883 recipe to correctly extend the path. 2884 2885 :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` 2886 A colon-separated list to specify a subset of :term:`OVERRIDES` used by 2887 the OpenEmbedded build system for creating :term:`FILESPATH`. The 2888 :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` variable uses overrides to automatically extend 2889 the :term:`FILESPATH` variable. For an example of how that works, see the 2890 :term:`FILESPATH` variable description. Additionally, you find more 2891 information on how overrides are handled in the 2892 ":ref:`bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:conditional syntax (overrides)`" 2893 section of the BitBake User Manual. 2894 2895 By default, the :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` variable is defined as:: 2896 2897 FILESOVERRIDES = "${TRANSLATED_TARGET_ARCH}:${MACHINEOVERRIDES}:${DISTROOVERRIDES}" 2898 2899 .. note:: 2900 2901 Do not hand-edit the :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` variable. The values match up 2902 with expected overrides and are used in an expected manner by the 2903 build system. 2904 2905 :term:`FILESPATH` 2906 A colon-separated list specifying the default set of directories the 2907 OpenEmbedded build system uses when searching for patches and files. 2908 2909 During the build process, BitBake searches each directory in 2910 :term:`FILESPATH` in the specified order when looking for files and 2911 patches specified by each ``file://`` URI in a recipe's 2912 :term:`SRC_URI` statements. 2913 2914 The default value for the :term:`FILESPATH` variable is defined in the 2915 :ref:`ref-classes-base` class found in ``meta/classes-global`` in the 2916 :term:`Source Directory`:: 2917 2918 FILESPATH = "${@base_set_filespath(["${FILE_DIRNAME}/${BP}", \ 2919 "${FILE_DIRNAME}/${BPN}", "${FILE_DIRNAME}/files"], d)}" 2920 2921 The 2922 :term:`FILESPATH` variable is automatically extended using the overrides 2923 from the :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` variable. 2924 2925 .. note:: 2926 2927 - Do not hand-edit the :term:`FILESPATH` variable. If you want the 2928 build system to look in directories other than the defaults, 2929 extend the :term:`FILESPATH` variable by using the 2930 :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` variable. 2931 2932 - Be aware that the default :term:`FILESPATH` directories do not map 2933 to directories in custom layers where append files 2934 (``.bbappend``) are used. If you want the build system to find 2935 patches or files that reside with your append files, you need 2936 to extend the :term:`FILESPATH` variable by using the 2937 :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` variable. 2938 2939 You can take advantage of this searching behavior in useful ways. For 2940 example, consider a case where there is the following directory structure 2941 for general and machine-specific configurations:: 2942 2943 files/defconfig 2944 files/MACHINEA/defconfig 2945 files/MACHINEB/defconfig 2946 2947 Also in the example, the :term:`SRC_URI` statement contains 2948 "file://defconfig". Given this scenario, you can set 2949 :term:`MACHINE` to "MACHINEA" and cause the build 2950 system to use files from ``files/MACHINEA``. Set :term:`MACHINE` to 2951 "MACHINEB" and the build system uses files from ``files/MACHINEB``. 2952 Finally, for any machine other than "MACHINEA" and "MACHINEB", the 2953 build system uses files from ``files/defconfig``. 2954 2955 You can find out more about the patching process in the 2956 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:patching`" section 2957 in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the 2958 ":ref:`dev-manual/new-recipe:patching code`" section in 2959 the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. See the 2960 :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task as well. 2961 2962 :term:`FILESYSTEM_PERMS_TABLES` 2963 Allows you to define your own file permissions settings table as part 2964 of your configuration for the packaging process. For example, suppose 2965 you need a consistent set of custom permissions for a set of groups 2966 and users across an entire work project. It is best to do this in the 2967 packages themselves but this is not always possible. 2968 2969 By default, the OpenEmbedded build system uses the ``fs-perms.txt``, 2970 which is located in the ``meta/files`` folder in the :term:`Source Directory`. 2971 If you create your own file 2972 permissions setting table, you should place it in your layer or the 2973 distro's layer. 2974 2975 You define the :term:`FILESYSTEM_PERMS_TABLES` variable in the 2976 ``conf/local.conf`` file, which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`, 2977 to point to your custom ``fs-perms.txt``. You can specify more than a 2978 single file permissions setting table. The paths you specify to these 2979 files must be defined within the :term:`BBPATH` variable. 2980 2981 For guidance on how to create your own file permissions settings 2982 table file, examine the existing ``fs-perms.txt``. 2983 2984 :term:`FIT_ADDRESS_CELLS` 2985 Specifies the value of the ``#address-cells`` value for the 2986 description of the FIT image. 2987 2988 The default value is set to "1" by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` 2989 class, which corresponds to 32 bit addresses. 2990 2991 For platforms that need to set 64 bit addresses, for example in 2992 :term:`UBOOT_LOADADDRESS` and :term:`UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT`, you need to 2993 set this value to "2", as two 32 bit values (cells) will be needed 2994 to represent such addresses. 2995 2996 Here is an example setting "0x400000000" as a load address:: 2997 2998 FIT_ADDRESS_CELLS = "2" 2999 UBOOT_LOADADDRESS= "0x04 0x00000000" 3000 3001 See `more details about #address-cells <https://elinux.org/Device_Tree_Usage#How_Addressing_Works>`__. 3002 3003 :term:`FIT_CONF_DEFAULT_DTB` 3004 Specifies the default device tree binary (dtb) file for a FIT image 3005 when multiple ones are provided. 3006 3007 This variable is used in the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class. 3008 3009 :term:`FIT_DESC` 3010 Specifies the description string encoded into a FIT image. The 3011 default value is set by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class as 3012 follows:: 3013 3014 FIT_DESC ?= "U-Boot fitImage for ${DISTRO_NAME}/${PV}/${MACHINE}" 3015 3016 :term:`FIT_GENERATE_KEYS` 3017 Decides whether to generate the keys for signing the FIT image if 3018 they don't already exist. The keys are created in 3019 :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYDIR`. The default value is set to "0" 3020 by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class. 3021 3022 :term:`FIT_HASH_ALG` 3023 Specifies the hash algorithm used in creating the FIT Image. 3024 This variable is set by default to "sha256" by the 3025 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class. 3026 3027 :term:`FIT_KERNEL_COMP_ALG` 3028 The compression algorithm to use for the kernel image inside the FIT Image. 3029 At present, the only supported values are "gzip" (default), "lzo" or "none". 3030 If you set this variable to anything other than "none" you may also need 3031 to set :term:`FIT_KERNEL_COMP_ALG_EXTENSION`. 3032 3033 This variable is used in the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-uboot` class. 3034 3035 :term:`FIT_KERNEL_COMP_ALG_EXTENSION` 3036 File extension corresponding to :term:`FIT_KERNEL_COMP_ALG`. The default 3037 value is set ".gz" by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-uboot` class. If you 3038 set :term:`FIT_KERNEL_COMP_ALG` to "lzo", you may want to set this 3039 variable to ".lzo". 3040 3041 :term:`FIT_KEY_GENRSA_ARGS` 3042 Arguments to ``openssl genrsa`` for generating a RSA private key for 3043 signing the FIT image. The default value is set to "-F4" by the 3044 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class. 3045 3046 :term:`FIT_KEY_REQ_ARGS` 3047 Arguments to ``openssl req`` for generating a certificate for signing 3048 the FIT image. The default value is "-batch -new" by the 3049 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class, "batch" for 3050 non interactive mode and "new" for generating new keys. 3051 3052 :term:`FIT_KEY_SIGN_PKCS` 3053 Format for the public key certificate used for signing the FIT image. 3054 The default value is set to "x509" by the 3055 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class. 3056 3057 :term:`FIT_SIGN_ALG` 3058 Specifies the signature algorithm used in creating the FIT Image. 3059 This variable is set by default to "rsa2048" by the 3060 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class. 3061 3062 :term:`FIT_PAD_ALG` 3063 Specifies the padding algorithm used in creating the FIT Image. 3064 The default value is set to "pkcs-1.5" by the 3065 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class. 3066 3067 :term:`FIT_SIGN_INDIVIDUAL` 3068 If set to "1", then the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` 3069 class will sign the kernel, dtb and ramdisk images individually in addition 3070 to signing the FIT image itself. This could be useful if you are 3071 intending to verify signatures in another context than booting via 3072 U-Boot. 3073 3074 This variable is set to "0" by default. 3075 3076 :term:`FIT_SIGN_NUMBITS` 3077 Size of the private key used in the FIT image, in number of bits. 3078 The default value for this variable is set to "2048" 3079 by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class. 3080 3081 :term:`FONT_EXTRA_RDEPENDS` 3082 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-fontcache` class, 3083 this variable specifies the runtime dependencies for font packages. 3084 By default, the :term:`FONT_EXTRA_RDEPENDS` is set to "fontconfig-utils". 3085 3086 :term:`FONT_PACKAGES` 3087 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-fontcache` class, this variable 3088 identifies packages containing font files that need to be cached by 3089 Fontconfig. By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-fontcache` class assumes 3090 that fonts are in the recipe's main package (i.e. 3091 ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). Use this variable if fonts you 3092 need are in a package other than that main package. 3093 3094 :term:`FORCE_RO_REMOVE` 3095 Forces the removal of the packages listed in ``ROOTFS_RO_UNNEEDED`` 3096 during the generation of the root filesystem. 3097 3098 Set the variable to "1" to force the removal of these packages. 3099 3100 :term:`FULL_OPTIMIZATION` 3101 The options to pass in :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` and :term:`CFLAGS` when 3102 compiling an optimized system. This variable defaults to "-O2 -pipe 3103 ${DEBUG_FLAGS}". 3104 3105 :term:`GCCPIE` 3106 Enables Position Independent Executables (PIE) within the GNU C 3107 Compiler (GCC). Enabling PIE in the GCC makes Return Oriented 3108 Programming (ROP) attacks much more difficult to execute. 3109 3110 By default the ``security_flags.inc`` file enables PIE by setting the 3111 variable as follows:: 3112 3113 GCCPIE ?= "--enable-default-pie" 3114 3115 :term:`GCCVERSION` 3116 Specifies the default version of the GNU C Compiler (GCC) used for 3117 compilation. By default, :term:`GCCVERSION` is set to "8.x" in the 3118 ``meta/conf/distro/include/tcmode-default.inc`` include file:: 3119 3120 GCCVERSION ?= "8.%" 3121 3122 You can override this value by setting it in a 3123 configuration file such as the ``local.conf``. 3124 3125 :term:`GDB` 3126 The minimal command and arguments to run the GNU Debugger. 3127 3128 :term:`GIR_EXTRA_LIBS_PATH` 3129 Allows to specify an extra search path for ``.so`` files 3130 in GLib related recipes using GObject introspection, 3131 and which do not compile without this setting. 3132 See the ":ref:`dev-manual/gobject-introspection:enabling gobject introspection support`" 3133 section for details. 3134 3135 :term:`GITDIR` 3136 The directory in which a local copy of a Git repository is stored 3137 when it is cloned. 3138 3139 :term:`GITHUB_BASE_URI` 3140 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-github-releases` 3141 class, specifies the base URL for fetching releases for the github 3142 project you wish to fetch sources from. The default value is as follows:: 3143 3144 GITHUB_BASE_URI ?= "https://github.com/${BPN}/${BPN}/releases/" 3145 3146 :term:`GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES` 3147 Specifies the list of GLIBC locales to generate should you not wish 3148 to generate all LIBC locals, which can be time consuming. 3149 3150 .. note:: 3151 3152 If you specifically remove the locale ``en_US.UTF-8``, you must set 3153 :term:`IMAGE_LINGUAS` appropriately. 3154 3155 You can set :term:`GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES` in your ``local.conf`` file. 3156 By default, all locales are generated:: 3157 3158 GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES = "en_GB.UTF-8 en_US.UTF-8" 3159 3160 :term:`GO_IMPORT` 3161 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-go` class, this mandatory variable 3162 sets the import path for the Go package that will be created for the code 3163 to build. If you have a ``go.mod`` file in the source directory, this 3164 typically matches the path in the ``module`` line in this file. 3165 3166 Other Go programs importing this package will use this path. 3167 3168 Here is an example setting from the 3169 :yocto_git:`go-helloworld_0.1.bb </poky/tree/meta/recipes-extended/go-examples/go-helloworld_0.1.bb>` 3170 recipe:: 3171 3172 GO_IMPORT = "golang.org/x/example" 3173 3174 :term:`GO_INSTALL` 3175 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-go` class, this optional variable 3176 specifies which packages in the sources should be compiled and 3177 installed in the Go build space by the 3178 `go install <https://go.dev/ref/mod#go-install>`__ command. 3179 3180 Here is an example setting from the 3181 :oe_git:`crucible </meta-openembedded/tree/meta-oe/recipes-support/crucible/>` 3182 recipe:: 3183 3184 GO_INSTALL = "\ 3185 ${GO_IMPORT}/cmd/crucible \ 3186 ${GO_IMPORT}/cmd/habtool \ 3187 " 3188 3189 By default, :term:`GO_INSTALL` is defined as:: 3190 3191 GO_INSTALL ?= "${GO_IMPORT}/..." 3192 3193 The ``...`` wildcard means that it will catch all 3194 packages found in the sources. 3195 3196 See the :term:`GO_INSTALL_FILTEROUT` variable for 3197 filtering out unwanted packages from the ones 3198 found from the :term:`GO_INSTALL` value. 3199 3200 :term:`GO_INSTALL_FILTEROUT` 3201 When using the Go "vendor" mechanism to bring in dependencies for a Go 3202 package, the default :term:`GO_INSTALL` setting, which uses the ``...`` 3203 wildcard, will include the vendored packages in the build, which produces 3204 incorrect results. 3205 3206 There are also some Go packages that are structured poorly, so that the 3207 ``...`` wildcard results in building example or test code that should not 3208 be included in the build, or could fail to build. 3209 3210 This optional variable allows for filtering out a subset of the sources. 3211 It defaults to excluding everything under the ``vendor`` subdirectory 3212 under package's main directory. This is the normal location for vendored 3213 packages, but it can be overridden by a recipe to filter out other 3214 subdirectories if needed. 3215 3216 :term:`GO_WORKDIR` 3217 When using Go Modules, the current working directory must be the directory 3218 containing the ``go.mod`` file, or one of its subdirectories. When the 3219 ``go`` tool is used, it will automatically look for the ``go.mod`` file 3220 in the Go working directory or in any parent directory, but not in 3221 subdirectories. 3222 3223 When using the :ref:`ref-classes-go-mod` class to use Go modules, 3224 the optional :term:`GO_WORKDIR` variable, defaulting to the value 3225 of :term:`GO_IMPORT`, allows to specify a different Go working directory. 3226 3227 :term:`GROUPADD_PARAM` 3228 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-useradd` class, 3229 this variable specifies for a package what parameters should be 3230 passed to the ``groupadd`` command if you wish to add a group to the 3231 system when the package is installed. 3232 3233 Here is an example from the ``dbus`` recipe:: 3234 3235 GROUPADD_PARAM:${PN} = "-r netdev" 3236 3237 More than one group can be added by separating each set of different 3238 groups' parameters with a semicolon. 3239 3240 Here is an example adding multiple groups from the ``useradd-example.bb`` 3241 file in the ``meta-skeleton`` layer:: 3242 3243 GROUPADD_PARAM:${PN} = "-g 880 group1; -g 890 group2" 3244 3245 For information on the standard Linux shell command 3246 ``groupadd``, see https://linux.die.net/man/8/groupadd. 3247 3248 :term:`GROUPMEMS_PARAM` 3249 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-useradd` class, 3250 this variable specifies for a package what parameters should be 3251 passed to the ``groupmems`` command if you wish to modify the members 3252 of a group when the package is installed. 3253 3254 For information on the standard Linux shell command ``groupmems``, 3255 see https://linux.die.net/man/8/groupmems. 3256 3257 :term:`GRUB_GFXSERIAL` 3258 Configures the GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB) to have graphics 3259 and serial in the boot menu. Set this variable to "1" in your 3260 ``local.conf`` or distribution configuration file to enable graphics 3261 and serial in the menu. 3262 3263 See the :ref:`ref-classes-grub-efi` class for more 3264 information on how this variable is used. 3265 3266 :term:`GRUB_OPTS` 3267 Additional options to add to the GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB) 3268 configuration. Use a semi-colon character (``;``) to separate 3269 multiple options. 3270 3271 The :term:`GRUB_OPTS` variable is optional. See the 3272 :ref:`ref-classes-grub-efi` class for more information 3273 on how this variable is used. 3274 3275 :term:`GRUB_TIMEOUT` 3276 Specifies the timeout before executing the default ``LABEL`` in the 3277 GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB). 3278 3279 The :term:`GRUB_TIMEOUT` variable is optional. See the 3280 :ref:`ref-classes-grub-efi` class for more information 3281 on how this variable is used. 3282 3283 :term:`GTKIMMODULES_PACKAGES` 3284 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-gtk-immodules-cache` class, 3285 this variable specifies the packages that contain the GTK+ input 3286 method modules being installed when the modules are in packages other 3287 than the main package. 3288 3289 :term:`HGDIR` 3290 See :term:`bitbake:HGDIR` in the BitBake manual. 3291 3292 :term:`HOMEPAGE` 3293 Website where more information about the software the recipe is 3294 building can be found. 3295 3296 :term:`HOST_ARCH` 3297 The name of the target architecture, which is normally the same as 3298 :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. The OpenEmbedded build system 3299 supports many architectures. Here is an example list of architectures 3300 supported. This list is by no means complete as the architecture is 3301 configurable: 3302 3303 - arm 3304 - i586 3305 - x86_64 3306 - powerpc 3307 - powerpc64 3308 - mips 3309 - mipsel 3310 3311 :term:`HOST_CC_ARCH` 3312 Specifies architecture-specific compiler flags that are passed to the 3313 C compiler. 3314 3315 Default initialization for :term:`HOST_CC_ARCH` varies depending on what 3316 is being built: 3317 3318 - :term:`TARGET_CC_ARCH` when building for the 3319 target 3320 3321 - :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH` when building for the build host (i.e. 3322 ``-native``) 3323 3324 - ``BUILDSDK_CC_ARCH`` when building for an SDK (i.e. 3325 ``nativesdk-``) 3326 3327 :term:`HOST_OS` 3328 Specifies the name of the target operating system, which is normally 3329 the same as the :term:`TARGET_OS`. The variable can 3330 be set to "linux" for ``glibc``-based systems and to "linux-musl" for 3331 ``musl``. For ARM/EABI targets, there are also "linux-gnueabi" and 3332 "linux-musleabi" values possible. 3333 3334 :term:`HOST_PREFIX` 3335 Specifies the prefix for the cross-compile toolchain. :term:`HOST_PREFIX` 3336 is normally the same as :term:`TARGET_PREFIX`. 3337 3338 :term:`HOST_SYS` 3339 Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating 3340 system, for which the build is occurring in the context of the 3341 current recipe. 3342 3343 The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based 3344 on :term:`HOST_ARCH`, 3345 :term:`HOST_VENDOR`, and 3346 :term:`HOST_OS` variables. 3347 3348 .. note:: 3349 3350 You do not need to set the variable yourself. 3351 3352 Consider these two examples: 3353 3354 - Given a native recipe on a 32-bit x86 machine running Linux, the 3355 value is "i686-linux". 3356 3357 - Given a recipe being built for a little-endian MIPS target running 3358 Linux, the value might be "mipsel-linux". 3359 3360 :term:`HOST_VENDOR` 3361 Specifies the name of the vendor. :term:`HOST_VENDOR` is normally the 3362 same as :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`. 3363 3364 :term:`HOSTTOOLS` 3365 A space-separated list (filter) of tools on the build host that 3366 should be allowed to be called from within build tasks. Using this 3367 filter helps reduce the possibility of host contamination. If a tool 3368 specified in the value of :term:`HOSTTOOLS` is not found on the build 3369 host, the OpenEmbedded build system produces an error and the build 3370 is not started. 3371 3372 For additional information, see 3373 :term:`HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`. 3374 3375 :term:`HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL` 3376 A space-separated list (filter) of tools on the build host that 3377 should be allowed to be called from within build tasks. Using this 3378 filter helps reduce the possibility of host contamination. Unlike 3379 :term:`HOSTTOOLS`, the OpenEmbedded build system 3380 does not produce an error if a tool specified in the value of 3381 :term:`HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL` is not found on the build host. Thus, you can 3382 use :term:`HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL` to filter optional host tools. 3383 3384 :term:`ICECC_CLASS_DISABLE` 3385 Identifies user classes that you do not want the Icecream distributed 3386 compile support to consider. This variable is used by the 3387 :ref:`ref-classes-icecc` class. You set this variable in 3388 your ``local.conf`` file. 3389 3390 When you list classes using this variable, the recipes inheriting 3391 those classes will not benefit from distributed compilation across 3392 remote hosts. Instead they will be built locally. 3393 3394 :term:`ICECC_DISABLED` 3395 Disables or enables the ``icecc`` (Icecream) function. For more 3396 information on this function and best practices for using this 3397 variable, see the ":ref:`ref-classes-icecc`" 3398 section. 3399 3400 Setting this variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` disables the 3401 function:: 3402 3403 ICECC_DISABLED ??= "1" 3404 3405 To enable the function, set the variable as follows:: 3406 3407 ICECC_DISABLED = "" 3408 3409 :term:`ICECC_ENV_EXEC` 3410 Points to the ``icecc-create-env`` script that you provide. This 3411 variable is used by the :ref:`ref-classes-icecc` class. You 3412 set this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. 3413 3414 If you do not point to a script that you provide, the OpenEmbedded 3415 build system uses the default script provided by the 3416 :oe_git:`icecc-create-env_0.1.bb 3417 </openembedded-core/tree/meta/recipes-devtools/icecc-create-env/icecc-create-env_0.1.bb>` 3418 recipe, which is a modified version and not the one that comes with 3419 ``icecream``. 3420 3421 :term:`ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE` 3422 Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the 3423 :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task that specify parallel 3424 compilation. This variable usually takes the form of "-j x", where x 3425 represents the maximum number of parallel threads ``make`` can run. 3426 3427 .. note:: 3428 3429 The options passed affect builds on all enabled machines on the 3430 network, which are machines running the ``iceccd`` daemon. 3431 3432 If your enabled machines support multiple cores, coming up with the 3433 maximum number of parallel threads that gives you the best 3434 performance could take some experimentation since machine speed, 3435 network lag, available memory, and existing machine loads can all 3436 affect build time. Consequently, unlike the 3437 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable, there is no 3438 rule-of-thumb for setting :term:`ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE` to achieve optimal 3439 performance. 3440 3441 If you do not set :term:`ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE`, the build system does not 3442 use it (i.e. the system does not detect and assign the number of 3443 cores as is done with :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`). 3444 3445 :term:`ICECC_PATH` 3446 The location of the ``icecc`` binary. You can set this variable in 3447 your ``local.conf`` file. If your ``local.conf`` file does not define 3448 this variable, the :ref:`ref-classes-icecc` class attempts 3449 to define it by locating ``icecc`` using ``which``. 3450 3451 :term:`ICECC_RECIPE_DISABLE` 3452 Identifies user recipes that you do not want the Icecream distributed 3453 compile support to consider. This variable is used by the 3454 :ref:`ref-classes-icecc` class. You set this variable in 3455 your ``local.conf`` file. 3456 3457 When you list recipes using this variable, you are excluding them 3458 from distributed compilation across remote hosts. Instead they will 3459 be built locally. 3460 3461 :term:`ICECC_RECIPE_ENABLE` 3462 Identifies user recipes that use an empty 3463 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable that you want to 3464 force remote distributed compilation on using the Icecream 3465 distributed compile support. This variable is used by the 3466 :ref:`ref-classes-icecc` class. You set this variable in 3467 your ``local.conf`` file. 3468 3469 :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME` 3470 The base name of image output files. This variable defaults to the 3471 recipe name (``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). 3472 3473 :term:`IMAGE_BOOT_FILES` 3474 A space-separated list of files installed into the boot partition 3475 when preparing an image using the Wic tool with the 3476 ``bootimg-partition`` source plugin. By default, 3477 the files are 3478 installed under the same name as the source files. To change the 3479 installed name, separate it from the original name with a semi-colon 3480 (;). Source files need to be located in 3481 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`. Here are two 3482 examples:: 3483 3484 IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "u-boot.img uImage;kernel" 3485 IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "u-boot.${UBOOT_SUFFIX} ${KERNEL_IMAGETYPE}" 3486 3487 Alternatively, source files can be picked up using a glob pattern. In 3488 this case, the destination file must have the same name as the base 3489 name of the source file path. To install files into a directory 3490 within the target location, pass its name after a semi-colon (;). 3491 Here are two examples:: 3492 3493 IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "bcm2835-bootfiles/*" 3494 IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "bcm2835-bootfiles/*;boot/" 3495 3496 The first example 3497 installs all files from ``${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/bcm2835-bootfiles`` 3498 into the root of the target partition. The second example installs 3499 the same files into a ``boot`` directory within the target partition. 3500 3501 You can find information on how to use the Wic tool in the 3502 ":ref:`dev-manual/wic:creating partitioned images using wic`" 3503 section of the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. Reference 3504 material for Wic is located in the 3505 ":doc:`/ref-manual/kickstart`" chapter. 3506 3507 :term:`IMAGE_BUILDINFO_FILE` 3508 When using the :ref:`ref-classes-image-buildinfo` class, 3509 specifies the file in the image to write the build information into. The 3510 default value is "``${sysconfdir}/buildinfo``". 3511 3512 :term:`IMAGE_BUILDINFO_VARS` 3513 When using the :ref:`ref-classes-image-buildinfo` class, 3514 specifies the list of variables to include in the `Build Configuration` 3515 section of the output file (as a space-separated list). Defaults to 3516 ":term:`DISTRO` :term:`DISTRO_VERSION`". 3517 3518 :term:`IMAGE_CLASSES` 3519 A list of classes that all images should inherit. This is typically used 3520 to enable functionality across all image recipes. 3521 3522 Classes specified in :term:`IMAGE_CLASSES` must be located in the 3523 ``classes-recipe/`` or ``classes/`` subdirectories. 3524 3525 :term:`IMAGE_CMD` 3526 Specifies the command to create the image file for a specific image 3527 type, which corresponds to the value set in 3528 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`, (e.g. ``ext3``, 3529 ``btrfs``, and so forth). When setting this variable, you should use 3530 an override for the associated type. Here is an example:: 3531 3532 IMAGE_CMD:jffs2 = "mkfs.jffs2 --root=${IMAGE_ROOTFS} --faketime \ 3533 --output=${IMGDEPLOYDIR}/${IMAGE_NAME}${IMAGE_NAME_SUFFIX}.jffs2 \ 3534 ${EXTRA_IMAGECMD}" 3535 3536 You typically do not need to set this variable unless you are adding 3537 support for a new image type. For more examples on how to set this 3538 variable, see the :ref:`ref-classes-image_types` 3539 class file, which is ``meta/classes-recipe/image_types.bbclass``. 3540 3541 :term:`IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES` 3542 Specifies one or more files that contain custom device tables that 3543 are passed to the ``makedevs`` command as part of creating an image. 3544 These files list basic device nodes that should be created under 3545 ``/dev`` within the image. If :term:`IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES` is not set, 3546 ``files/device_table-minimal.txt`` is used, which is located by 3547 :term:`BBPATH`. For details on how you should write 3548 device table files, see ``meta/files/device_table-minimal.txt`` as an 3549 example. 3550 3551 :term:`IMAGE_EFI_BOOT_FILES` 3552 A space-separated list of files installed into the boot partition 3553 when preparing an image using the Wic tool with the 3554 ``bootimg-efi`` source plugin. By default, 3555 the files are 3556 installed under the same name as the source files. To change the 3557 installed name, separate it from the original name with a semi-colon 3558 (;). Source files need to be located in 3559 :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`. Here are two 3560 examples:: 3561 3562 IMAGE_EFI_BOOT_FILES = "${KERNEL_IMAGETYPE};bz2" 3563 IMAGE_EFI_BOOT_FILES = "${KERNEL_IMAGETYPE} microcode.cpio" 3564 3565 Alternatively, source files can be picked up using a glob pattern. In 3566 this case, the destination file must have the same name as the base 3567 name of the source file path. To install files into a directory 3568 within the target location, pass its name after a semi-colon (;). 3569 Here are two examples:: 3570 3571 IMAGE_EFI_BOOT_FILES = "boot/loader/*" 3572 IMAGE_EFI_BOOT_FILES = "boot/loader/*;boot/" 3573 3574 The first example 3575 installs all files from ``${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/boot/loader/`` 3576 into the root of the target partition. The second example installs 3577 the same files into a ``boot`` directory within the target partition. 3578 3579 You can find information on how to use the Wic tool in the 3580 ":ref:`dev-manual/wic:creating partitioned images using wic`" 3581 section of the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. Reference 3582 material for Wic is located in the 3583 ":doc:`/ref-manual/kickstart`" chapter. 3584 3585 :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` 3586 The primary list of features to include in an image. Typically, you 3587 configure this variable in an image recipe. Although you can use this 3588 variable from your ``local.conf`` file, which is found in the 3589 :term:`Build Directory`, best practices dictate that you do 3590 not. 3591 3592 .. note:: 3593 3594 To enable extra features from outside the image recipe, use the 3595 :term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` variable. 3596 3597 For a list of image features that ships with the Yocto Project, see 3598 the ":ref:`ref-features-image`" section. 3599 3600 For an example that shows how to customize your image by using this 3601 variable, see the ":ref:`dev-manual/customizing-images:customizing images using custom \`\`image_features\`\` and \`\`extra_image_features\`\``" 3602 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 3603 3604 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` 3605 Specifies the formats the OpenEmbedded build system uses during the 3606 build when creating the root filesystem. For example, setting 3607 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` as follows causes the build system to create root 3608 filesystems using two formats: ``.ext3`` and ``.tar.bz2``:: 3609 3610 IMAGE_FSTYPES = "ext3 tar.bz2" 3611 3612 For the complete list of supported image formats from which you can 3613 choose, see :term:`IMAGE_TYPES`. 3614 3615 .. note:: 3616 3617 - If an image recipe uses the "inherit image" line and you are 3618 setting :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` inside the recipe, you must set 3619 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` prior to using the "inherit image" line. 3620 3621 - Due to the way the OpenEmbedded build system processes this 3622 variable, you cannot update its contents by using ``:append`` 3623 or ``:prepend``. You must use the ``+=`` operator to add one or 3624 more options to the :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable. 3625 3626 :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` 3627 Used by recipes to specify the packages to install into an image 3628 through the :ref:`ref-classes-image` class. Use the 3629 :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable with care to avoid ordering issues. 3630 3631 Image recipes set :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` to specify the packages to 3632 install into an image through :ref:`ref-classes-image`. Additionally, 3633 there are "helper" classes such as the :ref:`ref-classes-core-image` 3634 class which can take lists used with :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` and turn 3635 them into auto-generated entries in :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` in addition 3636 to its default contents. 3637 3638 When you use this variable, it is best to use it as follows:: 3639 3640 IMAGE_INSTALL:append = " package-name" 3641 3642 Be sure to include the space 3643 between the quotation character and the start of the package name or 3644 names. 3645 3646 .. note:: 3647 3648 - When working with a 3649 :ref:`core-image-minimal-initramfs <ref-manual/images:images>` 3650 image, do not use the :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable to specify 3651 packages for installation. Instead, use the 3652 :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` variable, which 3653 allows the initial RAM filesystem (:term:`Initramfs`) recipe to use a 3654 fixed set of packages and not be affected by :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`. 3655 For information on creating an :term:`Initramfs`, see the 3656 ":ref:`dev-manual/building:building an initial ram filesystem (Initramfs) image`" 3657 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 3658 3659 - Using :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` with the 3660 :ref:`+= <bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:appending (+=) and prepending (=+) with spaces>` 3661 BitBake operator within the ``/conf/local.conf`` file or from 3662 within an image recipe is not recommended. Use of this operator in 3663 these ways can cause ordering issues. Since 3664 :ref:`ref-classes-core-image` sets :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` to a 3665 default value using the 3666 :ref:`?= <bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:setting a default value (?=)>` 3667 operator, using a ``+=`` operation against :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` 3668 results in unexpected behavior when used within 3669 ``conf/local.conf``. Furthermore, the same operation from within an 3670 image recipe may or may not succeed depending on the specific 3671 situation. In both these cases, the behavior is contrary to how 3672 most users expect the ``+=`` operator to work. 3673 3674 :term:`IMAGE_LINGUAS` 3675 Specifies the list of locales to install into the image during the 3676 root filesystem construction process. The OpenEmbedded build system 3677 automatically splits locale files, which are used for localization, 3678 into separate packages. Setting the :term:`IMAGE_LINGUAS` variable 3679 ensures that any locale packages that correspond to packages already 3680 selected for installation into the image are also installed. Here is 3681 an example:: 3682 3683 IMAGE_LINGUAS = "pt-br de-de" 3684 3685 In this example, the build system ensures any Brazilian Portuguese 3686 and German locale files that correspond to packages in the image are 3687 installed (i.e. ``*-locale-pt-br`` and ``*-locale-de-de`` as well as 3688 ``*-locale-pt`` and ``*-locale-de``, since some software packages 3689 only provide locale files by language and not by country-specific 3690 language). 3691 3692 See the :term:`GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES` 3693 variable for information on generating GLIBC locales. 3694 3695 3696 :term:`IMAGE_LINK_NAME` 3697 The name of the output image symlink (which does not include 3698 the version part as :term:`IMAGE_NAME` does). The default value 3699 is derived using the :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME` and 3700 :term:`IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX` variables:: 3701 3702 IMAGE_LINK_NAME ?= "${IMAGE_BASENAME}${IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX}" 3703 3704 .. note:: 3705 3706 It is possible to set this to "" to disable symlink creation, 3707 however, you also need to set :term:`IMAGE_NAME` to still have 3708 a reasonable value e.g.:: 3709 3710 IMAGE_LINK_NAME = "" 3711 IMAGE_NAME = "${IMAGE_BASENAME}${IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" 3712 3713 :term:`IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX` 3714 Specifies the by default machine-specific suffix for image file names 3715 (before the extension). The default value is set as follows:: 3716 3717 IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX ??= "-${MACHINE}" 3718 3719 The default :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` already has a :term:`MACHINE` 3720 subdirectory, so you may find it unnecessary to also include this suffix 3721 in the name of every image file. If you prefer to remove the suffix you 3722 can set this variable to an empty string:: 3723 3724 IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX = "" 3725 3726 (Not to be confused with :term:`IMAGE_NAME_SUFFIX`.) 3727 3728 :term:`IMAGE_MANIFEST` 3729 The manifest file for the image. This file lists all the installed 3730 packages that make up the image. The file contains package 3731 information on a line-per-package basis as follows:: 3732 3733 packagename packagearch version 3734 3735 The :ref:`rootfs-postcommands <ref-classes-rootfs*>` class defines the manifest 3736 file as follows:: 3737 3738 IMAGE_MANIFEST ="${IMGDEPLOYDIR}/${IMAGE_NAME}${IMAGE_NAME_SUFFIX}.manifest" 3739 3740 The location is 3741 derived using the :term:`IMGDEPLOYDIR` 3742 and :term:`IMAGE_NAME` variables. You can find 3743 information on how the image is created in the ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:image generation`" 3744 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 3745 3746 :term:`IMAGE_NAME` 3747 The name of the output image files minus the extension. By default 3748 this variable is set using the :term:`IMAGE_LINK_NAME`, and 3749 :term:`IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX` variables:: 3750 3751 IMAGE_NAME ?= "${IMAGE_LINK_NAME}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" 3752 3753 :term:`IMAGE_NAME_SUFFIX` 3754 Suffix used for the image output filename --- defaults to ``".rootfs"`` 3755 to distinguish the image file from other files created during image 3756 building; however if this suffix is redundant or not desired you can 3757 clear the value of this variable (set the value to ""). For example, 3758 this is typically cleared in :term:`Initramfs` image recipes. 3759 3760 :term:`IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR` 3761 Defines a multiplier that the build system applies to the initial 3762 image size for cases when the multiplier times the returned disk 3763 usage value for the image is greater than the sum of 3764 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE` and :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE`. The result of 3765 the multiplier applied to the initial image size creates free disk 3766 space in the image as overhead. By default, the build process uses a 3767 multiplier of 1.3 for this variable. This default value results in 3768 30% free disk space added to the image when this method is used to 3769 determine the final generated image size. You should be aware that 3770 post install scripts and the package management system uses disk 3771 space inside this overhead area. Consequently, the multiplier does 3772 not produce an image with all the theoretical free disk space. See 3773 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE` for information on how the build system 3774 determines the overall image size. 3775 3776 The default 30% free disk space typically gives the image enough room 3777 to boot and allows for basic post installs while still leaving a 3778 small amount of free disk space. If 30% free space is inadequate, you 3779 can increase the default value. For example, the following setting 3780 gives you 50% free space added to the image:: 3781 3782 IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR = "1.5" 3783 3784 Alternatively, you can ensure a specific amount of free disk space is 3785 added to the image by using the :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE` 3786 variable. 3787 3788 :term:`IMAGE_PKGTYPE` 3789 Defines the package type (i.e. DEB, RPM, IPK, or TAR) used by the 3790 OpenEmbedded build system. The variable is defined appropriately by 3791 the :ref:`ref-classes-package_deb`, :ref:`ref-classes-package_rpm`, 3792 or :ref:`ref-classes-package_ipk` class. 3793 3794 The :ref:`ref-classes-populate-sdk-*` and :ref:`ref-classes-image` 3795 classes use the :term:`IMAGE_PKGTYPE` for packaging up images and SDKs. 3796 3797 You should not set the :term:`IMAGE_PKGTYPE` manually. Rather, the 3798 variable is set indirectly through the appropriate 3799 :ref:`package_* <ref-classes-package>` class using the 3800 :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` variable. The 3801 OpenEmbedded build system uses the first package type (e.g. DEB, RPM, 3802 or IPK) that appears with the variable 3803 3804 .. note:: 3805 3806 Files using the ``.tar`` format are never used as a substitute 3807 packaging format for DEB, RPM, and IPK formatted files for your image 3808 or SDK. 3809 3810 :term:`IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND` 3811 Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build 3812 system creates the final image output files. You can specify 3813 functions separated by spaces:: 3814 3815 IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function" 3816 3817 If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within the 3818 function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the 3819 directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the 3820 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more 3821 information. 3822 3823 :term:`IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND` 3824 Specifies a list of functions to call before the OpenEmbedded build 3825 system creates the final image output files. You can specify 3826 functions separated by spaces:: 3827 3828 IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND += "function" 3829 3830 If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within the 3831 function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the 3832 directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the 3833 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more 3834 information. 3835 3836 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` 3837 The location of the root filesystem while it is under construction 3838 (i.e. during the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task). This 3839 variable is not configurable. Do not change it. 3840 3841 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_ALIGNMENT` 3842 Specifies the alignment for the output image file in Kbytes. If the 3843 size of the image is not a multiple of this value, then the size is 3844 rounded up to the nearest multiple of the value. The default value is 3845 "1". See :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE` for 3846 additional information. 3847 3848 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE` 3849 Defines additional free disk space created in the image in Kbytes. By 3850 default, this variable is set to "0". This free disk space is added 3851 to the image after the build system determines the image size as 3852 described in :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE`. 3853 3854 This variable is particularly useful when you want to ensure that a 3855 specific amount of free disk space is available on a device after an 3856 image is installed and running. For example, to be sure 5 Gbytes of 3857 free disk space is available, set the variable as follows:: 3858 3859 IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE = "5242880" 3860 3861 For example, the Yocto Project Build Appliance specifically requests 3862 40 Gbytes of extra space with the line:: 3863 3864 IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE = "41943040" 3865 3866 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE` 3867 Defines the size in Kbytes for the generated image. The OpenEmbedded 3868 build system determines the final size for the generated image using 3869 an algorithm that takes into account the initial disk space used for 3870 the generated image, a requested size for the image, and requested 3871 additional free disk space to be added to the image. Programatically, 3872 the build system determines the final size of the generated image as 3873 follows:: 3874 3875 if (image-du * overhead) < rootfs-size: 3876 internal-rootfs-size = rootfs-size + xspace 3877 else: 3878 internal-rootfs-size = (image-du * overhead) + xspace 3879 where: 3880 image-du = Returned value of the du command on the image. 3881 overhead = IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR 3882 rootfs-size = IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE 3883 internal-rootfs-size = Initial root filesystem size before any modifications. 3884 xspace = IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE 3885 3886 See the :term:`IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR` 3887 and :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE` 3888 variables for related information. 3889 3890 :term:`IMAGE_TYPEDEP` 3891 Specifies a dependency from one image type on another. Here is an 3892 example from the :ref:`ref-classes-image-live` class:: 3893 3894 IMAGE_TYPEDEP:live = "ext3" 3895 3896 In the previous example, the variable ensures that when "live" is 3897 listed with the :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable, 3898 the OpenEmbedded build system produces an ``ext3`` image first since 3899 one of the components of the live image is an ``ext3`` formatted 3900 partition containing the root filesystem. 3901 3902 :term:`IMAGE_TYPES` 3903 Specifies the complete list of supported image types by default: 3904 3905 - btrfs 3906 - container 3907 - cpio 3908 - cpio.gz 3909 - cpio.lz4 3910 - cpio.lzma 3911 - cpio.xz 3912 - cramfs 3913 - erofs 3914 - erofs-lz4 3915 - erofs-lz4hc 3916 - ext2 3917 - ext2.bz2 3918 - ext2.gz 3919 - ext2.lzma 3920 - ext3 3921 - ext3.gz 3922 - ext4 3923 - ext4.gz 3924 - f2fs 3925 - hddimg 3926 - iso 3927 - jffs2 3928 - jffs2.sum 3929 - multiubi 3930 - squashfs 3931 - squashfs-lz4 3932 - squashfs-lzo 3933 - squashfs-xz 3934 - tar 3935 - tar.bz2 3936 - tar.gz 3937 - tar.lz4 3938 - tar.xz 3939 - tar.zst 3940 - ubi 3941 - ubifs 3942 - wic 3943 - wic.bz2 3944 - wic.gz 3945 - wic.lzma 3946 3947 For more information about these types of images, see 3948 ``meta/classes-recipe/image_types*.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`. 3949 3950 :term:`IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX` 3951 Version suffix that is part of the default :term:`IMAGE_NAME` and 3952 :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` values. 3953 Defaults to ``"-${DATETIME}"``, however you could set this to a 3954 version string that comes from your external build environment if 3955 desired, and this suffix would then be used consistently across 3956 the build artifacts. 3957 3958 :term:`IMGDEPLOYDIR` 3959 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-image` class directly or 3960 through the :ref:`ref-classes-core-image` class, the 3961 :term:`IMGDEPLOYDIR` points to a temporary work area for deployed files 3962 that is set in the ``image`` class as follows:: 3963 3964 IMGDEPLOYDIR = "${WORKDIR}/deploy-${PN}-image-complete" 3965 3966 Recipes inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-image` class should copy 3967 files to be deployed into :term:`IMGDEPLOYDIR`, and the class will take 3968 care of copying them into :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` afterwards. 3969 3970 :term:`INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE` 3971 Specifies a space-separated list of license names (as they would 3972 appear in :term:`LICENSE`) that should be excluded 3973 from the build (if set globally), or from an image (if set locally 3974 in an image recipe). 3975 3976 When the variable is set globally, recipes that provide no alternatives to listed 3977 incompatible licenses are not built. Packages that are individually 3978 licensed with the specified incompatible licenses will be deleted. 3979 Most of the time this does not allow a feasible build (because it becomes impossible 3980 to satisfy build time dependencies), so the recommended way to 3981 implement license restrictions is to set the variable in specific 3982 image recipes where the restrictions must apply. That way there 3983 are no build time restrictions, but the license check is still 3984 performed when the image's filesystem is assembled from packages. 3985 3986 There is some support for wildcards in this variable's value, 3987 however it is restricted to specific licenses. Currently only 3988 these wildcards are allowed and expand as follows: 3989 3990 - ``AGPL-3.0*"``: ``AGPL-3.0-only``, ``AGPL-3.0-or-later`` 3991 - ``GPL-3.0*``: ``GPL-3.0-only``, ``GPL-3.0-or-later`` 3992 - ``LGPL-3.0*``: ``LGPL-3.0-only``, ``LGPL-3.0-or-later`` 3993 3994 .. note:: 3995 3996 This functionality is only regularly tested using the following 3997 setting:: 3998 3999 INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE = "GPL-3.0* LGPL-3.0* AGPL-3.0*" 4000 4001 4002 Although you can use other settings, you might be required to 4003 remove dependencies on (or provide alternatives to) components that 4004 are required to produce a functional system image. 4005 4006 :term:`INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE_EXCEPTIONS` 4007 Specifies a space-separated list of package and license pairs that 4008 are allowed to be used even if the license is specified in 4009 :term:`INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE`. The package and license pairs are 4010 separated using a colon. Example:: 4011 4012 INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE_EXCEPTIONS = "gdbserver:GPL-3.0-only gdbserver:LGPL-3.0-only" 4013 4014 :term:`INHERIT` 4015 Causes the named class or classes to be inherited globally. Anonymous 4016 functions in the class or classes are not executed for the base 4017 configuration and in each individual recipe. The OpenEmbedded build 4018 system ignores changes to :term:`INHERIT` in individual recipes. 4019 Classes inherited using :term:`INHERIT` must be located in the 4020 ``classes-global/`` or ``classes/`` subdirectories. 4021 4022 For more information on :term:`INHERIT`, see the 4023 :ref:`bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:\`\`inherit\`\` configuration directive`" 4024 section in the BitBake User Manual. 4025 4026 :term:`INHERIT_DISTRO` 4027 Lists classes that will be inherited at the distribution level. It is 4028 unlikely that you want to edit this variable. 4029 4030 Classes specified in :term:`INHERIT_DISTRO` must be located in the 4031 ``classes-global/`` or ``classes/`` subdirectories. 4032 4033 The default value of the variable is set as follows in the 4034 ``meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf`` file:: 4035 4036 INHERIT_DISTRO ?= "debian devshell sstate license" 4037 4038 :term:`INHIBIT_DEFAULT_DEPS` 4039 Prevents the default dependencies, namely the C compiler and standard 4040 C library (libc), from being added to :term:`DEPENDS`. 4041 This variable is usually used within recipes that do not require any 4042 compilation using the C compiler. 4043 4044 Set the variable to "1" to prevent the default dependencies from 4045 being added. 4046 4047 :term:`INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT` 4048 Prevents the OpenEmbedded build system from splitting out debug 4049 information during packaging. By default, the build system splits out 4050 debugging information during the 4051 :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task. For more information on 4052 how debug information is split out, see the 4053 :term:`PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE` 4054 variable. 4055 4056 To prevent the build system from splitting out debug information 4057 during packaging, set the :term:`INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT` variable as 4058 follows:: 4059 4060 INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT = "1" 4061 4062 :term:`INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP` 4063 If set to "1", causes the build to not strip binaries in resulting 4064 packages and prevents the ``-dbg`` package from containing the source 4065 files. 4066 4067 By default, the OpenEmbedded build system strips binaries and puts 4068 the debugging symbols into ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-dbg``. 4069 Consequently, you should not set :term:`INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP` when you 4070 plan to debug in general. 4071 4072 :term:`INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP` 4073 If set to "1", causes the build to not strip binaries in the 4074 resulting sysroot. 4075 4076 By default, the OpenEmbedded build system strips binaries in the 4077 resulting sysroot. When you specifically set the 4078 :term:`INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP` variable to "1" in your recipe, you inhibit 4079 this stripping. 4080 4081 If you want to use this variable, include the :ref:`ref-classes-staging` 4082 class. This class uses a ``sys_strip()`` function to test for the variable 4083 and acts accordingly. 4084 4085 .. note:: 4086 4087 Use of the :term:`INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP` variable occurs in rare and 4088 special circumstances. For example, suppose you are building 4089 bare-metal firmware by using an external GCC toolchain. Furthermore, 4090 even if the toolchain's binaries are strippable, there are other files 4091 needed for the build that are not strippable. 4092 4093 :term:`INIT_MANAGER` 4094 Specifies the system init manager to use. Available options are: 4095 4096 - ``sysvinit`` 4097 - ``systemd`` 4098 - ``mdev-busybox`` 4099 4100 With ``sysvinit``, the init manager is set to 4101 :wikipedia:`SysVinit <Init#SysV-style>`, the traditional UNIX init 4102 system. This is the default choice in the Poky distribution, together with 4103 the Udev device manager (see the ":ref:`device-manager`" section). 4104 4105 With ``systemd``, the init manager becomes :wikipedia:`systemd <Systemd>`, 4106 which comes with the :wikipedia:`udev <Udev>` device manager. 4107 4108 With ``mdev-busybox``, the init manager becomes the much simpler BusyBox 4109 init, together with the BusyBox mdev device manager. This is the simplest 4110 and lightest solution, and probably the best choice for low-end systems 4111 with a rather slow CPU and a limited amount of RAM. 4112 4113 More concretely, this is used to include 4114 ``conf/distro/include/init-manager-${INIT_MANAGER}.inc`` into the global 4115 configuration. You can have a look at the 4116 :yocto_git:`meta/conf/distro/include/init-manager-*.inc </poky/tree/meta/conf/distro/include>` 4117 files for more information, and also the ":ref:`init-manager`" 4118 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 4119 4120 :term:`INITRAMFS_DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` 4121 Indicates the deploy directory used by :ref:`ref-tasks-bundle_initramfs` 4122 where the :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` will be fetched from. This variable is 4123 set by default to ``${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}`` in the 4124 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class and it's only meant to be changed when 4125 building an :term:`Initramfs` image from a separate multiconfig via 4126 :term:`INITRAMFS_MULTICONFIG`. 4127 4128 :term:`INITRAMFS_FSTYPES` 4129 Defines the format for the output image of an initial RAM filesystem 4130 (:term:`Initramfs`), which is used during boot. Supported formats are the 4131 same as those supported by the 4132 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable. 4133 4134 The default value of this variable, which is set in the 4135 ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file in the 4136 :term:`Source Directory`, is "cpio.gz". The Linux kernel's 4137 :term:`Initramfs` mechanism, as opposed to the initial RAM filesystem 4138 :wikipedia:`initrd <Initrd>` mechanism, expects 4139 an optionally compressed cpio archive. 4140 4141 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` 4142 Specifies the :term:`PROVIDES` name of an image 4143 recipe that is used to build an initial RAM filesystem (:term:`Initramfs`) 4144 image. In other words, the :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` variable causes an 4145 additional recipe to be built as a dependency to whatever root 4146 filesystem recipe you might be using (e.g. ``core-image-sato``). The 4147 :term:`Initramfs` image recipe you provide should set 4148 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` to 4149 :term:`INITRAMFS_FSTYPES`. 4150 4151 An :term:`Initramfs` image provides a temporary root filesystem used for 4152 early system initialization (e.g. loading of modules needed to locate 4153 and mount the "real" root filesystem). 4154 4155 .. note:: 4156 4157 See the ``meta/recipes-core/images/core-image-minimal-initramfs.bb`` 4158 recipe in the :term:`Source Directory` 4159 for an example :term:`Initramfs` recipe. To select this sample recipe as 4160 the one built to provide the :term:`Initramfs` image, set :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` 4161 to "core-image-minimal-initramfs". 4162 4163 You can also find more information by referencing the 4164 ``meta-poky/conf/templates/default/local.conf.sample.extended`` 4165 configuration file in the Source Directory, the :ref:`ref-classes-image` 4166 class, and the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class to see how to use the 4167 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` variable. 4168 4169 If :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` is empty, which is the default, then no 4170 :term:`Initramfs` image is built. 4171 4172 For more information, you can also see the 4173 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE` 4174 variable, which allows the generated image to be bundled inside the 4175 kernel image. Additionally, for information on creating an :term:`Initramfs` 4176 image, see the ":ref:`dev-manual/building:building an initial ram filesystem (Initramfs) image`" section 4177 in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 4178 4179 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE` 4180 Controls whether or not the image recipe specified by 4181 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` is run through an 4182 extra pass 4183 (:ref:`ref-tasks-bundle_initramfs`) during 4184 kernel compilation in order to build a single binary that contains 4185 both the kernel image and the initial RAM filesystem (:term:`Initramfs`) 4186 image. This makes use of the 4187 :term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE` kernel 4188 feature. 4189 4190 .. note:: 4191 4192 Bundling the :term:`Initramfs` with the kernel conflates the code in the 4193 :term:`Initramfs` with the GPLv2 licensed Linux kernel binary. Thus only GPLv2 4194 compatible software may be part of a bundled :term:`Initramfs`. 4195 4196 .. note:: 4197 4198 Using an extra compilation pass to bundle the :term:`Initramfs` avoids a 4199 circular dependency between the kernel recipe and the :term:`Initramfs` 4200 recipe should the :term:`Initramfs` include kernel modules. Should that be 4201 the case, the :term:`Initramfs` recipe depends on the kernel for the 4202 kernel modules, and the kernel depends on the :term:`Initramfs` recipe 4203 since the :term:`Initramfs` is bundled inside the kernel image. 4204 4205 The combined binary is deposited into the ``tmp/deploy`` directory, 4206 which is part of the :term:`Build Directory`. 4207 4208 Setting the variable to "1" in a configuration file causes the 4209 OpenEmbedded build system to generate a kernel image with the 4210 :term:`Initramfs` specified in :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` bundled within:: 4211 4212 INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE = "1" 4213 4214 By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class sets this variable to a 4215 null string as follows:: 4216 4217 INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE ?= "" 4218 4219 .. note:: 4220 4221 You must set the :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE` variable in a 4222 configuration file. You cannot set the variable in a recipe file. 4223 4224 See the 4225 :yocto_git:`local.conf.sample.extended </poky/tree/meta-poky/conf/templates/default/local.conf.sample.extended>` 4226 file for additional information. Also, for information on creating an 4227 :term:`Initramfs`, see the ":ref:`dev-manual/building:building an initial ram filesystem (Initramfs) image`" section 4228 in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 4229 4230 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_NAME` 4231 4232 This value needs to stay in sync with :term:`IMAGE_LINK_NAME`, but with 4233 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` instead of :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME`. The default value 4234 is set as follows: 4235 4236 INITRAMFS_IMAGE_NAME ?= "${@['${INITRAMFS_IMAGE}${IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX}', ''][d.getVar('INITRAMFS_IMAGE') == '']}" 4237 4238 That is, if :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` is set, the value of 4239 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_NAME` will be set based upon 4240 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` and :term:`IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX`. 4241 4242 4243 :term:`INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME` 4244 The link name of the initial RAM filesystem image. This variable is 4245 set in the ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as 4246 follows:: 4247 4248 INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME ?= "initramfs-${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" 4249 4250 The value of the 4251 ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same 4252 file, has the following value:: 4253 4254 KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" 4255 4256 See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional 4257 information. 4258 4259 :term:`INITRAMFS_MULTICONFIG` 4260 Defines the multiconfig to create a multiconfig dependency to be used by 4261 the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class. 4262 4263 This allows the kernel to bundle an :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` coming from 4264 a separate multiconfig, this is meant to be used in addition to :term:`INITRAMFS_DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`. 4265 4266 For more information on how to bundle an :term:`Initramfs` image from a separate 4267 multiconfig see the ":ref:`dev-manual/building:Bundling an Initramfs Image From a Separate Multiconfig`" 4268 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 4269 4270 :term:`INITRAMFS_NAME` 4271 The base name of the initial RAM filesystem image. This variable is 4272 set in the ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as 4273 follows:: 4274 4275 INITRAMFS_NAME ?= "initramfs-${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" 4276 4277 See :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` for additional information. 4278 4279 :term:`INITRD` 4280 Indicates list of filesystem images to concatenate and use as an 4281 initial RAM disk (``initrd``). 4282 4283 The :term:`INITRD` variable is an optional variable used with the 4284 :ref:`ref-classes-image-live` class. 4285 4286 :term:`INITRD_IMAGE` 4287 When building a "live" bootable image (i.e. when 4288 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` contains "live"), 4289 :term:`INITRD_IMAGE` specifies the image recipe that should be built to 4290 provide the initial RAM disk image. The default value is 4291 "core-image-minimal-initramfs". 4292 4293 See the :ref:`ref-classes-image-live` class for more information. 4294 4295 :term:`INITSCRIPT_NAME` 4296 The filename of the initialization script as installed to 4297 ``${sysconfdir}/init.d``. 4298 4299 This variable is used in recipes when using :ref:`ref-classes-update-rc.d`. 4300 The variable is mandatory. 4301 4302 :term:`INITSCRIPT_PACKAGES` 4303 A list of the packages that contain initscripts. If multiple packages 4304 are specified, you need to append the package name to the other 4305 ``INITSCRIPT_*`` as an override. 4306 4307 This variable is used in recipes when using :ref:`ref-classes-update-rc.d`. 4308 The variable is optional and defaults to the :term:`PN` 4309 variable. 4310 4311 :term:`INITSCRIPT_PARAMS` 4312 Specifies the options to pass to ``update-rc.d``. Here is an example:: 4313 4314 INITSCRIPT_PARAMS = "start 99 5 2 . stop 20 0 1 6 ." 4315 4316 In this example, the script has a runlevel of 99, starts the script 4317 in initlevels 2 and 5, and stops the script in levels 0, 1 and 6. 4318 4319 The variable's default value is "defaults", which is set in the 4320 :ref:`ref-classes-update-rc.d` class. 4321 4322 The value in :term:`INITSCRIPT_PARAMS` is passed through to the 4323 ``update-rc.d`` command. For more information on valid parameters, 4324 please see the ``update-rc.d`` manual page at 4325 https://manpages.debian.org/buster/init-system-helpers/update-rc.d.8.en.html 4326 4327 :term:`INSANE_SKIP` 4328 Specifies the QA checks to skip for a specific package within a 4329 recipe. For example, to skip the check for symbolic link ``.so`` 4330 files in the main package of a recipe, add the following to the 4331 recipe. The package name override must be used, which in this example 4332 is ``${PN}``:: 4333 4334 INSANE_SKIP:${PN} += "dev-so" 4335 4336 See the ":ref:`ref-classes-insane`" section for a 4337 list of the valid QA checks you can specify using this variable. 4338 4339 :term:`INSTALL_TIMEZONE_FILE` 4340 By default, the ``tzdata`` recipe packages an ``/etc/timezone`` file. 4341 Set the :term:`INSTALL_TIMEZONE_FILE` variable to "0" at the 4342 configuration level to disable this behavior. 4343 4344 :term:`IPK_FEED_URIS` 4345 When the IPK backend is in use and package management is enabled on 4346 the target, you can use this variable to set up ``opkg`` in the 4347 target image to point to package feeds on a nominated server. Once 4348 the feed is established, you can perform installations or upgrades 4349 using the package manager at runtime. 4350 4351 :term:`KARCH` 4352 Defines the kernel architecture used when assembling the 4353 configuration. Architectures supported for this release are: 4354 4355 - powerpc 4356 - i386 4357 - x86_64 4358 - arm 4359 - qemu 4360 - mips 4361 4362 You define the :term:`KARCH` variable in the :ref:`kernel-dev/advanced:bsp descriptions`. 4363 4364 :term:`KBRANCH` 4365 A regular expression used by the build process to explicitly identify 4366 the kernel branch that is validated, patched, and configured during a 4367 build. You must set this variable to ensure the exact kernel branch 4368 you want is being used by the build process. 4369 4370 Values for this variable are set in the kernel's recipe file and the 4371 kernel's append file. For example, if you are using the 4372 ``linux-yocto_4.12`` kernel, the kernel recipe file is the 4373 ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_4.12.bb`` file. :term:`KBRANCH` 4374 is set as follows in that kernel recipe file:: 4375 4376 KBRANCH ?= "standard/base" 4377 4378 This variable is also used from the kernel's append file to identify 4379 the kernel branch specific to a particular machine or target 4380 hardware. Continuing with the previous kernel example, the kernel's 4381 append file is located in the 4382 BSP layer for a given machine. For example, the append file for the 4383 Beaglebone and generic versions of both 32 and 64-bit IA 4384 machines (``meta-yocto-bsp``) is named 4385 ``meta-yocto-bsp/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_6.1.bbappend``. 4386 Here are the related statements from that append file:: 4387 4388 KBRANCH:genericx86 = "v6.1/standard/base" 4389 KBRANCH:genericx86-64 = "v6.1/standard/base" 4390 KBRANCH:beaglebone-yocto = "v6.1/standard/beaglebone" 4391 4392 The :term:`KBRANCH` statements 4393 identify the kernel branch to use when building for each supported 4394 BSP. 4395 4396 :term:`KBUILD_DEFCONFIG` 4397 When used with the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-yocto` 4398 class, specifies an "in-tree" kernel configuration file for use 4399 during a kernel build. 4400 4401 Typically, when using a ``defconfig`` to configure a kernel during a 4402 build, you place the file in your layer in the same manner as you 4403 would place patch files and configuration fragment files (i.e. 4404 "out-of-tree"). However, if you want to use a ``defconfig`` file that 4405 is part of the kernel tree (i.e. "in-tree"), you can use the 4406 :term:`KBUILD_DEFCONFIG` variable and append the 4407 :term:`KMACHINE` variable to point to the 4408 ``defconfig`` file. 4409 4410 To use the variable, set it in the append file for your kernel recipe 4411 using the following form:: 4412 4413 KBUILD_DEFCONFIG:<machine> ?= "defconfig_file" 4414 4415 Here is an example from a "raspberrypi2" :term:`MACHINE` build that uses 4416 a ``defconfig`` file named "bcm2709_defconfig":: 4417 4418 KBUILD_DEFCONFIG:raspberrypi2 = "bcm2709_defconfig" 4419 4420 As an alternative, you can use the following within your append file:: 4421 4422 KBUILD_DEFCONFIG:pn-linux-yocto ?= "defconfig_file" 4423 4424 For more 4425 information on how to use the :term:`KBUILD_DEFCONFIG` variable, see the 4426 ":ref:`kernel-dev/common:using an "in-tree" \`\`defconfig\`\` file`" 4427 section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. 4428 4429 :term:`KCONFIG_MODE` 4430 When used with the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-yocto` 4431 class, specifies the kernel configuration values to use for options 4432 not specified in the provided ``defconfig`` file. Valid options are:: 4433 4434 KCONFIG_MODE = "alldefconfig" 4435 KCONFIG_MODE = "allnoconfig" 4436 4437 In ``alldefconfig`` mode the options not explicitly specified will be 4438 assigned their Kconfig default value. In ``allnoconfig`` mode the 4439 options not explicitly specified will be disabled in the kernel 4440 config. 4441 4442 In case :term:`KCONFIG_MODE` is not set the behaviour will depend on where 4443 the ``defconfig`` file is coming from. An "in-tree" ``defconfig`` file 4444 will be handled in ``alldefconfig`` mode, a ``defconfig`` file placed 4445 in ``${WORKDIR}`` through a meta-layer will be handled in 4446 ``allnoconfig`` mode. 4447 4448 An "in-tree" ``defconfig`` file can be selected via the 4449 :term:`KBUILD_DEFCONFIG` variable. :term:`KCONFIG_MODE` does not need to 4450 be explicitly set. 4451 4452 A ``defconfig`` file compatible with ``allnoconfig`` mode can be 4453 generated by copying the ``.config`` file from a working Linux kernel 4454 build, renaming it to ``defconfig`` and placing it into the Linux 4455 kernel ``${WORKDIR}`` through your meta-layer. :term:`KCONFIG_MODE` does 4456 not need to be explicitly set. 4457 4458 A ``defconfig`` file compatible with ``alldefconfig`` mode can be 4459 generated using the 4460 :ref:`ref-tasks-savedefconfig` 4461 task and placed into the Linux kernel ``${WORKDIR}`` through your 4462 meta-layer. Explicitely set :term:`KCONFIG_MODE`:: 4463 4464 KCONFIG_MODE = "alldefconfig" 4465 4466 :term:`KERNEL_ALT_IMAGETYPE` 4467 Specifies an alternate kernel image type for creation in addition to 4468 the kernel image type specified using the :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE` and 4469 :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPES` variables. 4470 4471 :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` 4472 Specifies the name of all of the build artifacts. You can change the 4473 name of the artifacts by changing the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` 4474 variable. 4475 4476 The value of :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME`, which is set in the 4477 ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file, has the 4478 following default value:: 4479 4480 KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}${IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" 4481 4482 See the :term:`PKGE`, :term:`PKGV`, :term:`PKGR`, :term:`IMAGE_MACHINE_SUFFIX` 4483 and :term:`IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX` variables for additional information. 4484 4485 :term:`KERNEL_CLASSES` 4486 A list of classes defining kernel image types that the 4487 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class should inherit. You typically 4488 append this variable to enable extended image types. An example is 4489 ":ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage`", which enables 4490 FIT image support and resides in ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-fitimage.bbclass``. 4491 You can register custom kernel image types with the 4492 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class using this variable. 4493 4494 :term:`KERNEL_DANGLING_FEATURES_WARN_ONLY` 4495 When kernel configuration fragments are missing for some 4496 :term:`KERNEL_FEATURES` specified by layers or BSPs, 4497 building and configuring the kernel stops with an error. 4498 4499 You can turn these errors into warnings by setting the 4500 following in ``conf/local.conf``:: 4501 4502 KERNEL_DANGLING_FEATURES_WARN_ONLY = "1" 4503 4504 You will still be warned that runtime issues may occur, 4505 but at least the kernel configuration and build process will 4506 be allowed to continue. 4507 4508 :term:`KERNEL_DEBUG_TIMESTAMPS` 4509 If set to "1", enables timestamping functionality during building 4510 the kernel. The default is "0" to disable this for reproducibility 4511 reasons. 4512 4513 :term:`KERNEL_DEPLOY_DEPEND` 4514 Provides a means of controlling the dependency of an image recipe 4515 on the kernel. The default value is "virtual/kernel:do_deploy", 4516 however for a small initramfs image or other images that do not 4517 need the kernel, this can be set to "" in the image recipe. 4518 4519 :term:`KERNEL_DEVICETREE` 4520 Specifies the name of the generated Linux kernel device tree (i.e. 4521 the ``.dtb``) file. 4522 4523 .. note:: 4524 4525 There is legacy support for specifying the full path to the device 4526 tree. However, providing just the ``.dtb`` file is preferred. 4527 4528 In order to use this variable, the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-devicetree` 4529 class must be inherited. 4530 4531 :term:`KERNEL_DEVICETREE_BUNDLE` 4532 When set to "1", this variable allows to bundle the Linux kernel 4533 and the Device Tree Binary together in a single file. 4534 4535 This feature is currently only supported on the "arm" (32 bit) 4536 architecture. 4537 4538 This variable is set to "0" by default by the 4539 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-devicetree` class. 4540 4541 :term:`KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME` 4542 The link name of the kernel device tree binary (DTB). This variable 4543 is set in the ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as 4544 follows:: 4545 4546 KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" 4547 4548 The 4549 value of the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in 4550 the same file, has the following value:: 4551 4552 KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" 4553 4554 See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional 4555 information. 4556 4557 :term:`KERNEL_DTB_NAME` 4558 The base name of the kernel device tree binary (DTB). This variable 4559 is set in the ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as 4560 follows:: 4561 4562 KERNEL_DTB_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" 4563 4564 See :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` for additional information. 4565 4566 :term:`KERNEL_DTBDEST` 4567 This variable, used by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-devicetree` 4568 class, allows to change the installation directory of the DTB 4569 (Device Tree Binary) files. 4570 4571 It is set by default to "${KERNEL_IMAGEDEST}" by the 4572 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class. 4573 4574 :term:`KERNEL_DTBVENDORED` 4575 This variable, used by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-devicetree`, 4576 allows to ignore vendor subdirectories when installing DTB 4577 (Device Tree Binary) files, when it is set to "false". 4578 4579 To keep vendor subdirectories, set this variable to "true". 4580 4581 It is set by default to "false" by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class. 4582 4583 :term:`KERNEL_DTC_FLAGS` 4584 Specifies the ``dtc`` flags that are passed to the Linux kernel build 4585 system when generating the device trees (via ``DTC_FLAGS`` environment 4586 variable). 4587 4588 In order to use this variable, the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-devicetree` 4589 class must be inherited. 4590 4591 :term:`KERNEL_EXTRA_ARGS` 4592 Specifies additional ``make`` command-line arguments the OpenEmbedded 4593 build system passes on when compiling the kernel. 4594 4595 :term:`KERNEL_FEATURES` 4596 Includes additional kernel metadata. In the OpenEmbedded build 4597 system, the default Board Support Packages (BSPs) 4598 :term:`Metadata` is provided through the 4599 :term:`KMACHINE` and :term:`KBRANCH` 4600 variables. You can use the :term:`KERNEL_FEATURES` variable from within 4601 the kernel recipe or kernel append file to further add metadata for 4602 all BSPs or specific BSPs. 4603 4604 The metadata you add through this variable includes config fragments 4605 and features descriptions, which usually includes patches as well as 4606 config fragments. You typically override the :term:`KERNEL_FEATURES` 4607 variable for a specific machine. In this way, you can provide 4608 validated, but optional, sets of kernel configurations and features. 4609 4610 For example, the following example from the ``linux-yocto-rt_4.12`` 4611 kernel recipe adds "netfilter" and "taskstats" features to all BSPs 4612 as well as "virtio" configurations to all QEMU machines. The last two 4613 statements add specific configurations to targeted machine types:: 4614 4615 KERNEL_EXTRA_FEATURES ?= "features/netfilter/netfilter.scc features/taskstats/taskstats.scc" 4616 KERNEL_FEATURES:append = " ${KERNEL_EXTRA_FEATURES}" 4617 KERNEL_FEATURES:append:qemuall = " cfg/virtio.scc" 4618 KERNEL_FEATURES:append:qemux86 = " cfg/sound.scc cfg/paravirt_kvm.scc" 4619 KERNEL_FEATURES:append:qemux86-64 = " cfg/sound.scc" 4620 4621 :term:`KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME` 4622 The link name of the kernel flattened image tree (FIT) image. This 4623 variable is set in the ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` 4624 file as follows:: 4625 4626 KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" 4627 4628 The value of the 4629 ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same 4630 file, has the following value:: 4631 4632 KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" 4633 4634 See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional 4635 information. 4636 4637 :term:`KERNEL_FIT_NAME` 4638 The base name of the kernel flattened image tree (FIT) image. This 4639 variable is set in the ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` 4640 file as follows:: 4641 4642 KERNEL_FIT_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" 4643 4644 See :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` for additional information. 4645 4646 :term:`KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME` 4647 The link name for the kernel image. This variable is set in the 4648 ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows:: 4649 4650 KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" 4651 4652 The value of 4653 the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same 4654 file, has the following value:: 4655 4656 KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" 4657 4658 See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional 4659 information. 4660 4661 :term:`KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE` 4662 Specifies the maximum size of the kernel image file in kilobytes. If 4663 :term:`KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE` is set, the size of the kernel image file is 4664 checked against the set value during the 4665 :ref:`ref-tasks-sizecheck` task. The task fails if 4666 the kernel image file is larger than the setting. 4667 4668 :term:`KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE` is useful for target devices that have a 4669 limited amount of space in which the kernel image must be stored. 4670 4671 By default, this variable is not set, which means the size of the 4672 kernel image is not checked. 4673 4674 :term:`KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME` 4675 The base name of the kernel image. This variable is set in the 4676 ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows:: 4677 4678 KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" 4679 4680 See :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` for additional information. 4681 4682 :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE` 4683 The type of kernel to build for a device, usually set by the machine 4684 configuration files and defaults to "zImage". This variable is used 4685 when building the kernel and is passed to ``make`` as the target to 4686 build. 4687 4688 To build additional kernel image types, use :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPES`. 4689 4690 :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPES` 4691 Lists additional types of kernel images to build for a device in addition 4692 to image type specified in :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE`. Usually set by the 4693 machine configuration files. 4694 4695 :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` 4696 Lists kernel modules that need to be auto-loaded during boot. 4697 4698 .. note:: 4699 4700 This variable replaces the deprecated :term:`module_autoload` 4701 variable. 4702 4703 You can use the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` variable anywhere that it 4704 can be recognized by the kernel recipe or by an out-of-tree kernel 4705 module recipe (e.g. a machine configuration file, a distribution 4706 configuration file, an append file for the recipe, or the recipe 4707 itself). 4708 4709 Specify it as follows:: 4710 4711 KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "module_name1 module_name2 module_name3" 4712 4713 Including :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` causes the OpenEmbedded build 4714 system to populate the ``/etc/modules-load.d/modname.conf`` file with 4715 the list of modules to be auto-loaded on boot. The modules appear 4716 one-per-line in the file. Here is an example of the most common use 4717 case:: 4718 4719 KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "module_name" 4720 4721 For information on how to populate the ``modname.conf`` file with 4722 ``modprobe.d`` syntax lines, see the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF` variable. 4723 4724 :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF` 4725 Provides a list of modules for which the OpenEmbedded build system 4726 expects to find ``module_conf_``\ modname values that specify 4727 configuration for each of the modules. For information on how to 4728 provide those module configurations, see the 4729 :term:`module_conf_* <module_conf>` variable. 4730 4731 :term:`KERNEL_PACKAGE_NAME` 4732 Specifies the base name of the kernel packages, such as "kernel" 4733 in the kernel packages such as "kernel-modules", "kernel-image" and 4734 "kernel-dbg". 4735 4736 The default value for this variable is set to "kernel" by the 4737 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel` class. 4738 4739 :term:`KERNEL_PATH` 4740 The location of the kernel sources. This variable is set to the value 4741 of the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` within the :ref:`ref-classes-module` 4742 class. For information on how this variable is used, see the 4743 ":ref:`kernel-dev/common:incorporating out-of-tree modules`" 4744 section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. 4745 4746 To help maximize compatibility with out-of-tree drivers used to build 4747 modules, the OpenEmbedded build system also recognizes and uses the 4748 :term:`KERNEL_SRC` variable, which is identical to 4749 the :term:`KERNEL_PATH` variable. Both variables are common variables 4750 used by external Makefiles to point to the kernel source directory. 4751 4752 :term:`KERNEL_SRC` 4753 The location of the kernel sources. This variable is set to the value 4754 of the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` within the :ref:`ref-classes-module` 4755 class. For information on how this variable is used, see the 4756 ":ref:`kernel-dev/common:incorporating out-of-tree modules`" 4757 section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. 4758 4759 To help maximize compatibility with out-of-tree drivers used to build 4760 modules, the OpenEmbedded build system also recognizes and uses the 4761 :term:`KERNEL_PATH` variable, which is identical 4762 to the :term:`KERNEL_SRC` variable. Both variables are common variables 4763 used by external Makefiles to point to the kernel source directory. 4764 4765 :term:`KERNEL_STRIP` 4766 Allows to specific which ``strip`` command to use to strip the kernel 4767 binary, typically either GNU binutils ``strip`` or ``llvm-strip``. 4768 4769 :term:`KERNEL_VERSION` 4770 Specifies the version of the kernel as extracted from ``version.h`` 4771 or ``utsrelease.h`` within the kernel sources. Effects of setting 4772 this variable do not take effect until the kernel has been 4773 configured. Consequently, attempting to refer to this variable in 4774 contexts prior to configuration will not work. 4775 4776 :term:`KERNELDEPMODDEPEND` 4777 Specifies whether the data referenced through 4778 :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` is needed or not. 4779 :term:`KERNELDEPMODDEPEND` does not control whether or not that data 4780 exists, but simply whether or not it is used. If you do not need to 4781 use the data, set the :term:`KERNELDEPMODDEPEND` variable in your 4782 :term:`Initramfs` recipe. Setting the variable there when the data is not 4783 needed avoids a potential dependency loop. 4784 4785 :term:`KFEATURE_DESCRIPTION` 4786 Provides a short description of a configuration fragment. You use 4787 this variable in the ``.scc`` file that describes a configuration 4788 fragment file. Here is the variable used in a file named ``smp.scc`` 4789 to describe SMP being enabled:: 4790 4791 define KFEATURE_DESCRIPTION "Enable SMP" 4792 4793 :term:`KMACHINE` 4794 The machine as known by the kernel. Sometimes the machine name used 4795 by the kernel does not match the machine name used by the 4796 OpenEmbedded build system. For example, the machine name that the 4797 OpenEmbedded build system understands as ``core2-32-intel-common`` 4798 goes by a different name in the Linux Yocto kernel. The kernel 4799 understands that machine as ``intel-core2-32``. For cases like these, 4800 the :term:`KMACHINE` variable maps the kernel machine name to the 4801 OpenEmbedded build system machine name. 4802 4803 These mappings between different names occur in the Yocto Linux 4804 Kernel's ``meta`` branch. As an example take a look in the 4805 ``common/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_3.19.bbappend`` file:: 4806 4807 LINUX_VERSION:core2-32-intel-common = "3.19.0" 4808 COMPATIBLE_MACHINE:core2-32-intel-common = "${MACHINE}" 4809 SRCREV_meta:core2-32-intel-common = "8897ef68b30e7426bc1d39895e71fb155d694974" 4810 SRCREV_machine:core2-32-intel-common = "43b9eced9ba8a57add36af07736344dcc383f711" 4811 KMACHINE:core2-32-intel-common = "intel-core2-32" 4812 KBRANCH:core2-32-intel-common = "standard/base" 4813 KERNEL_FEATURES:append:core2-32-intel-common = " ${KERNEL_FEATURES_INTEL_COMMON}" 4814 4815 The :term:`KMACHINE` statement says 4816 that the kernel understands the machine name as "intel-core2-32". 4817 However, the OpenEmbedded build system understands the machine as 4818 "core2-32-intel-common". 4819 4820 :term:`KTYPE` 4821 Defines the kernel type to be used in assembling the configuration. 4822 The linux-yocto recipes define "standard", "tiny", and "preempt-rt" 4823 kernel types. See the ":ref:`kernel-dev/advanced:kernel types`" 4824 section in the 4825 Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more information on 4826 kernel types. 4827 4828 You define the :term:`KTYPE` variable in the 4829 :ref:`kernel-dev/advanced:bsp descriptions`. The 4830 value you use must match the value used for the 4831 :term:`LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE` value used by the 4832 kernel recipe. 4833 4834 :term:`LABELS` 4835 Provides a list of targets for automatic configuration. 4836 4837 See the :ref:`ref-classes-grub-efi` class for more 4838 information on how this variable is used. 4839 4840 :term:`LAYERDEPENDS` 4841 Lists the layers, separated by spaces, on which this recipe depends. 4842 Optionally, you can specify a specific layer version for a dependency 4843 by adding it to the end of the layer name. Here is an example:: 4844 4845 LAYERDEPENDS_mylayer = "anotherlayer (=3)" 4846 4847 In this previous example, 4848 version 3 of "anotherlayer" is compared against 4849 :term:`LAYERVERSION`\ ``_anotherlayer``. 4850 4851 An error is produced if any dependency is missing or the version 4852 numbers (if specified) do not match exactly. This variable is used in 4853 the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be suffixed with the name of 4854 the specific layer (e.g. ``LAYERDEPENDS_mylayer``). 4855 4856 :term:`LAYERDIR` 4857 When used inside the ``layer.conf`` configuration file, this variable 4858 provides the path of the current layer. This variable is not 4859 available outside of ``layer.conf`` and references are expanded 4860 immediately when parsing of the file completes. 4861 4862 :term:`LAYERDIR_RE` 4863 See :term:`bitbake:LAYERDIR_RE` in the BitBake manual. 4864 4865 :term:`LAYERRECOMMENDS` 4866 Lists the layers, separated by spaces, recommended for use with this 4867 layer. 4868 4869 Optionally, you can specify a specific layer version for a 4870 recommendation by adding the version to the end of the layer name. 4871 Here is an example:: 4872 4873 LAYERRECOMMENDS_mylayer = "anotherlayer (=3)" 4874 4875 In this previous example, version 3 of "anotherlayer" is compared 4876 against ``LAYERVERSION_anotherlayer``. 4877 4878 This variable is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be 4879 suffixed with the name of the specific layer (e.g. 4880 ``LAYERRECOMMENDS_mylayer``). 4881 4882 :term:`LAYERSERIES_COMPAT` 4883 See :term:`bitbake:LAYERSERIES_COMPAT` in the BitBake manual. 4884 4885 :term:`LAYERVERSION` 4886 Optionally specifies the version of a layer as a single number. You 4887 can use this within :term:`LAYERDEPENDS` for 4888 another layer in order to depend on a specific version of the layer. 4889 This variable is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be 4890 suffixed with the name of the specific layer (e.g. 4891 ``LAYERVERSION_mylayer``). 4892 4893 :term:`LD` 4894 The minimal command and arguments used to run the linker. 4895 4896 :term:`LDFLAGS` 4897 Specifies the flags to pass to the linker. This variable is exported 4898 to an environment variable and thus made visible to the software 4899 being built during the compilation step. 4900 4901 Default initialization for :term:`LDFLAGS` varies depending on what is 4902 being built: 4903 4904 - :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` when building for the 4905 target 4906 4907 - :term:`BUILD_LDFLAGS` when building for the 4908 build host (i.e. ``-native``) 4909 4910 - :term:`BUILDSDK_LDFLAGS` when building for 4911 an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) 4912 4913 :term:`LEAD_SONAME` 4914 Specifies the lead (or primary) compiled library file (i.e. ``.so``) 4915 that the :ref:`ref-classes-debian` class applies its 4916 naming policy to given a recipe that packages multiple libraries. 4917 4918 This variable works in conjunction with the :ref:`ref-classes-debian` 4919 class. 4920 4921 :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` 4922 Checksums of the license text in the recipe source code. 4923 4924 This variable tracks changes in license text of the source code 4925 files. If the license text is changed, it will trigger a build 4926 failure, which gives the developer an opportunity to review any 4927 license change. 4928 4929 This variable must be defined for all recipes (unless 4930 :term:`LICENSE` is set to "CLOSED"). 4931 4932 For more information, see the ":ref:`dev-manual/licenses:tracking license changes`" 4933 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 4934 4935 :term:`LICENSE` 4936 The list of source licenses for the recipe. Follow these rules: 4937 4938 - Do not use spaces within individual license names. 4939 4940 - Separate license names using \| (pipe) when there is a choice 4941 between licenses. 4942 4943 - Separate license names using & (ampersand) when there are 4944 multiple licenses for different parts of the source. 4945 4946 - You can use spaces between license names. 4947 4948 - For standard licenses, use the names of the files in 4949 ``meta/files/common-licenses/`` or the 4950 :term:`SPDXLICENSEMAP` flag names defined in 4951 ``meta/conf/licenses.conf``. 4952 4953 Here are some examples:: 4954 4955 LICENSE = "LGPL-2.1-only | GPL-3.0-only" 4956 LICENSE = "MPL-1.0 & LGPL-2.1-only" 4957 LICENSE = "GPL-2.0-or-later" 4958 4959 The first example is from the 4960 recipes for Qt, which the user may choose to distribute under either 4961 the LGPL version 2.1 or GPL version 3. The second example is from 4962 Cairo where two licenses cover different parts of the source code. 4963 The final example is from ``sysstat``, which presents a single 4964 license. 4965 4966 You can also specify licenses on a per-package basis to handle 4967 situations where components of the output have different licenses. 4968 For example, a piece of software whose code is licensed under GPLv2 4969 but has accompanying documentation licensed under the GNU Free 4970 Documentation License 1.2 could be specified as follows:: 4971 4972 LICENSE = "GFDL-1.2 & GPL-2.0-only" 4973 LICENSE:${PN} = "GPL-2.0.only" 4974 LICENSE:${PN}-doc = "GFDL-1.2" 4975 4976 :term:`LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE` 4977 Setting :term:`LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE` to "1" causes the OpenEmbedded 4978 build system to create an extra package (i.e. 4979 ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-lic``) for each recipe and to add 4980 those packages to the 4981 :term:`RRECOMMENDS`\ ``:${PN}``. 4982 4983 The ``${PN}-lic`` package installs a directory in 4984 ``/usr/share/licenses`` named ``${PN}``, which is the recipe's base 4985 name, and installs files in that directory that contain license and 4986 copyright information (i.e. copies of the appropriate license files 4987 from ``meta/common-licenses`` that match the licenses specified in 4988 the :term:`LICENSE` variable of the recipe metadata 4989 and copies of files marked in 4990 :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` as containing 4991 license text). 4992 4993 For related information on providing license text, see the 4994 :term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` variable, the 4995 :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable, and the 4996 ":ref:`dev-manual/licenses:providing license text`" 4997 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 4998 4999 :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` 5000 Specifies additional flags for a recipe you must allow through 5001 :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` in 5002 order for the recipe to be built. When providing multiple flags, 5003 separate them with spaces. 5004 5005 This value is independent of :term:`LICENSE` and is 5006 typically used to mark recipes that might require additional licenses 5007 in order to be used in a commercial product. For more information, 5008 see the 5009 ":ref:`dev-manual/licenses:enabling commercially licensed recipes`" 5010 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 5011 5012 :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` 5013 Lists license flags that when specified in 5014 :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` within a recipe should not 5015 prevent that recipe from being built. For more information, see the 5016 ":ref:`dev-manual/licenses:enabling commercially licensed recipes`" 5017 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 5018 5019 :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_DETAILS` 5020 Adds details about a flag in :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS`. This way, 5021 if such a flag is not accepted through :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`, 5022 the error message will be more informative, containing the specified 5023 extra details. 5024 5025 For example, a recipe with an EULA may set:: 5026 5027 LICENSE_FLAGS = "FooBar-EULA" 5028 LICENSE_FLAGS_DETAILS[FooBar-EULA] = "For further details, see https://example.com/eula." 5029 5030 If ``Foobar-EULA`` isn't in :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`, the 5031 error message is more useful:: 5032 5033 Has a restricted license 'FooBar-EULA' which is not listed in your LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED. 5034 For further details, see https://example.com/eula. 5035 5036 :term:`LICENSE_PATH` 5037 Path to additional licenses used during the build. By default, the 5038 OpenEmbedded build system uses :term:`COMMON_LICENSE_DIR` to define the 5039 directory that holds common license text used during the build. The 5040 :term:`LICENSE_PATH` variable allows you to extend that location to other 5041 areas that have additional licenses:: 5042 5043 LICENSE_PATH += "path-to-additional-common-licenses" 5044 5045 :term:`LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE` 5046 Defines the kernel type to be used in assembling the configuration. 5047 The linux-yocto recipes define "standard", "tiny", and "preempt-rt" 5048 kernel types. See the ":ref:`kernel-dev/advanced:kernel types`" 5049 section in the 5050 Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more information on 5051 kernel types. 5052 5053 If you do not specify a :term:`LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE`, it defaults to 5054 "standard". Together with :term:`KMACHINE`, the 5055 :term:`LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE` variable defines the search arguments used by 5056 the kernel tools to find the appropriate description within the 5057 kernel :term:`Metadata` with which to build out the sources 5058 and configuration. 5059 5060 :term:`LINUX_VERSION` 5061 The Linux version from ``kernel.org`` on which the Linux kernel image 5062 being built using the OpenEmbedded build system is based. You define 5063 this variable in the kernel recipe. For example, the 5064 ``linux-yocto-3.4.bb`` kernel recipe found in 5065 ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux`` defines the variables as follows:: 5066 5067 LINUX_VERSION ?= "3.4.24" 5068 5069 The :term:`LINUX_VERSION` variable is used to define :term:`PV` 5070 for the recipe:: 5071 5072 PV = "${LINUX_VERSION}+git${SRCPV}" 5073 5074 :term:`LINUX_VERSION_EXTENSION` 5075 A string extension compiled into the version string of the Linux 5076 kernel built with the OpenEmbedded build system. You define this 5077 variable in the kernel recipe. For example, the linux-yocto kernel 5078 recipes all define the variable as follows:: 5079 5080 LINUX_VERSION_EXTENSION ?= "-yocto-${LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE}" 5081 5082 Defining this variable essentially sets the Linux kernel 5083 configuration item ``CONFIG_LOCALVERSION``, which is visible through 5084 the ``uname`` command. Here is an example that shows the extension 5085 assuming it was set as previously shown:: 5086 5087 $ uname -r 5088 3.7.0-rc8-custom 5089 5090 :term:`LOG_DIR` 5091 Specifies the directory to which the OpenEmbedded build system writes 5092 overall log files. The default directory is ``${TMPDIR}/log``. 5093 5094 For the directory containing logs specific to each task, see the 5095 :term:`T` variable. 5096 5097 :term:`MACHINE` 5098 Specifies the target device for which the image is built. You define 5099 :term:`MACHINE` in the ``local.conf`` file found in the 5100 :term:`Build Directory`. By default, :term:`MACHINE` is set to 5101 "qemux86", which is an x86-based architecture machine to be emulated 5102 using QEMU:: 5103 5104 MACHINE ?= "qemux86" 5105 5106 The variable corresponds to a machine configuration file of the same 5107 name, through which machine-specific configurations are set. Thus, 5108 when :term:`MACHINE` is set to "qemux86", the corresponding 5109 ``qemux86.conf`` machine configuration file can be found in 5110 the :term:`Source Directory` in 5111 ``meta/conf/machine``. 5112 5113 The list of machines supported by the Yocto Project as shipped 5114 include the following:: 5115 5116 MACHINE ?= "qemuarm" 5117 MACHINE ?= "qemuarm64" 5118 MACHINE ?= "qemumips" 5119 MACHINE ?= "qemumips64" 5120 MACHINE ?= "qemuppc" 5121 MACHINE ?= "qemux86" 5122 MACHINE ?= "qemux86-64" 5123 MACHINE ?= "genericx86" 5124 MACHINE ?= "genericx86-64" 5125 MACHINE ?= "beaglebone" 5126 5127 The last five are Yocto Project reference hardware 5128 boards, which are provided in the ``meta-yocto-bsp`` layer. 5129 5130 .. note:: 5131 5132 Adding additional Board Support Package (BSP) layers to your 5133 configuration adds new possible settings for :term:`MACHINE`. 5134 5135 :term:`MACHINE_ARCH` 5136 Specifies the name of the machine-specific architecture. This 5137 variable is set automatically from :term:`MACHINE` or 5138 :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH`. You should not hand-edit 5139 the :term:`MACHINE_ARCH` variable. 5140 5141 :term:`MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS` 5142 A list of required machine-specific packages to install as part of 5143 the image being built. The build process depends on these packages 5144 being present. Furthermore, because this is a "machine-essential" 5145 variable, the list of packages are essential for the machine to boot. 5146 The impact of this variable affects images based on 5147 ``packagegroup-core-boot``, including the ``core-image-minimal`` 5148 image. 5149 5150 This variable is similar to the 5151 :term:`MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS` variable with the exception 5152 that the image being built has a build dependency on the variable's 5153 list of packages. In other words, the image will not build if a file 5154 in this list is not found. 5155 5156 As an example, suppose the machine for which you are building 5157 requires ``example-init`` to be run during boot to initialize the 5158 hardware. In this case, you would use the following in the machine's 5159 ``.conf`` configuration file:: 5160 5161 MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS += "example-init" 5162 5163 :term:`MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS` 5164 A list of recommended machine-specific packages to install as part of 5165 the image being built. The build process does not depend on these 5166 packages being present. However, because this is a 5167 "machine-essential" variable, the list of packages are essential for 5168 the machine to boot. The impact of this variable affects images based 5169 on ``packagegroup-core-boot``, including the ``core-image-minimal`` 5170 image. 5171 5172 This variable is similar to the :term:`MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS` 5173 variable with the exception that the image being built does not have 5174 a build dependency on the variable's list of packages. In other 5175 words, the image will still build if a package in this list is not 5176 found. Typically, this variable is used to handle essential kernel 5177 modules, whose functionality may be selected to be built into the 5178 kernel rather than as a module, in which case a package will not be 5179 produced. 5180 5181 Consider an example where you have a custom kernel where a specific 5182 touchscreen driver is required for the machine to be usable. However, 5183 the driver can be built as a module or into the kernel depending on 5184 the kernel configuration. If the driver is built as a module, you 5185 want it to be installed. But, when the driver is built into the 5186 kernel, you still want the build to succeed. This variable sets up a 5187 "recommends" relationship so that in the latter case, the build will 5188 not fail due to the missing package. To accomplish this, assuming the 5189 package for the module was called ``kernel-module-ab123``, you would 5190 use the following in the machine's ``.conf`` configuration file:: 5191 5192 MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS += "kernel-module-ab123" 5193 5194 .. note:: 5195 5196 In this example, the ``kernel-module-ab123`` recipe needs to 5197 explicitly set its :term:`PACKAGES` variable to ensure that BitBake 5198 does not use the kernel recipe's :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` variable to 5199 satisfy the dependency. 5200 5201 Some examples of these machine essentials are flash, screen, 5202 keyboard, mouse, or touchscreen drivers (depending on the machine). 5203 5204 :term:`MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS` 5205 A list of machine-specific packages to install as part of the image 5206 being built that are not essential for the machine to boot. However, 5207 the build process for more fully-featured images depends on the 5208 packages being present. 5209 5210 This variable affects all images based on ``packagegroup-base``, 5211 which does not include the ``core-image-minimal`` or 5212 ``core-image-full-cmdline`` images. 5213 5214 The variable is similar to the :term:`MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS` variable 5215 with the exception that the image being built has a build dependency 5216 on the variable's list of packages. In other words, the image will 5217 not build if a file in this list is not found. 5218 5219 An example is a machine that has WiFi capability but is not essential 5220 for the machine to boot the image. However, if you are building a 5221 more fully-featured image, you want to enable the WiFi. The package 5222 containing the firmware for the WiFi hardware is always expected to 5223 exist, so it is acceptable for the build process to depend upon 5224 finding the package. In this case, assuming the package for the 5225 firmware was called ``wifidriver-firmware``, you would use the 5226 following in the ``.conf`` file for the machine:: 5227 5228 MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS += "wifidriver-firmware" 5229 5230 :term:`MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS` 5231 A list of machine-specific packages to install as part of the image 5232 being built that are not essential for booting the machine. The image 5233 being built has no build dependency on this list of packages. 5234 5235 This variable affects only images based on ``packagegroup-base``, 5236 which does not include the ``core-image-minimal`` or 5237 ``core-image-full-cmdline`` images. 5238 5239 This variable is similar to the :term:`MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS` variable 5240 with the exception that the image being built does not have a build 5241 dependency on the variable's list of packages. In other words, the 5242 image will build if a file in this list is not found. 5243 5244 An example is a machine that has WiFi capability but is not essential 5245 For the machine to boot the image. However, if you are building a 5246 more fully-featured image, you want to enable WiFi. In this case, the 5247 package containing the WiFi kernel module will not be produced if the 5248 WiFi driver is built into the kernel, in which case you still want 5249 the build to succeed instead of failing as a result of the package 5250 not being found. To accomplish this, assuming the package for the 5251 module was called ``kernel-module-examplewifi``, you would use the 5252 following in the ``.conf`` file for the machine:: 5253 5254 MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS += "kernel-module-examplewifi" 5255 5256 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` 5257 Specifies the list of hardware features the 5258 :term:`MACHINE` is capable of supporting. For related 5259 information on enabling features, see the 5260 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`, 5261 :term:`COMBINED_FEATURES`, and 5262 :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` variables. 5263 5264 For a list of hardware features supported by the Yocto Project as 5265 shipped, see the ":ref:`ref-features-machine`" section. 5266 5267 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL` 5268 A list of space-separated features to be added to 5269 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` if not also present in 5270 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`. 5271 5272 This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is not 5273 intended to be user-configurable. It is best to just reference the 5274 variable to see which machine features are being 5275 :ref:`backfilled <ref-features-backfill>` for all machine configurations. 5276 5277 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED` 5278 A list of space-separated features from :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL` 5279 that should not be :ref:`backfilled <ref-features-backfill>` (i.e. added 5280 to :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES`) during the build. 5281 5282 This corresponds to an opt-out mechanism. When new default machine 5283 features are introduced, machine definition maintainers can review 5284 (`consider`) them and decide to exclude them from the 5285 :ref:`backfilled <ref-features-backfill>` features. Therefore, the 5286 combination of :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL` and 5287 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED` makes it possible to 5288 add new default features without breaking existing machine definitions. 5289 5290 :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES` 5291 A colon-separated list of overrides that apply to the current 5292 machine. By default, this list includes the value of 5293 :term:`MACHINE`. 5294 5295 You can extend :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES` to add extra overrides that 5296 should apply to a machine. For example, all machines emulated in QEMU 5297 (e.g. ``qemuarm``, ``qemux86``, and so forth) include a file named 5298 ``meta/conf/machine/include/qemu.inc`` that prepends the following 5299 override to :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES`:: 5300 5301 MACHINEOVERRIDES =. "qemuall:" 5302 5303 This 5304 override allows variables to be overridden for all machines emulated 5305 in QEMU, like in the following example from the ``connman-conf`` 5306 recipe:: 5307 5308 SRC_URI:append:qemuall = " file://wired.config \ 5309 file://wired-setup \ 5310 " 5311 5312 The underlying mechanism behind 5313 :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES` is simply that it is included in the default 5314 value of :term:`OVERRIDES`. 5315 5316 :term:`MAINTAINER` 5317 The email address of the distribution maintainer. 5318 5319 :term:`MESON_BUILDTYPE` 5320 Value of the Meson ``--buildtype`` argument used by the 5321 :ref:`ref-classes-meson` class. It defaults to ``debug`` if 5322 :term:`DEBUG_BUILD` is set to "1", and ``plain`` otherwise. 5323 5324 See `Meson build options <https://mesonbuild.com/Builtin-options.html>`__ 5325 for the values you could set in a recipe. Values such as ``plain``, 5326 ``debug``, ``debugoptimized``, ``release`` and ``minsize`` allow 5327 you to specify the inclusion of debugging symbols and the compiler 5328 optimizations (none, performance or size). 5329 5330 :term:`MESON_TARGET` 5331 A variable for the :ref:`ref-classes-meson` class, allowing to choose 5332 a Meson target to build in :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`. Otherwise, the 5333 default targets are built. 5334 5335 :term:`METADATA_BRANCH` 5336 The branch currently checked out for the OpenEmbedded-Core layer (path 5337 determined by :term:`COREBASE`). 5338 5339 :term:`METADATA_REVISION` 5340 The revision currently checked out for the OpenEmbedded-Core layer (path 5341 determined by :term:`COREBASE`). 5342 5343 :term:`MIME_XDG_PACKAGES` 5344 The current implementation of the :ref:`ref-classes-mime-xdg` 5345 class cannot detect ``.desktop`` files installed through absolute 5346 symbolic links. Use this setting to make the class create post-install 5347 and post-remove scripts for these packages anyway, to invoke the 5348 ``update-destop-database`` command. 5349 5350 :term:`MIRRORS` 5351 Specifies additional paths from which the OpenEmbedded build system 5352 gets source code. When the build system searches for source code, it 5353 first tries the local download directory. If that location fails, the 5354 build system tries locations defined by 5355 :term:`PREMIRRORS`, the upstream source, and then 5356 locations specified by :term:`MIRRORS` in that order. 5357 5358 The default value for :term:`MIRRORS` is defined in the 5359 ``meta/classes-global/mirrors.bbclass`` file in the core metadata layer. 5360 5361 :term:`MLPREFIX` 5362 Specifies a prefix has been added to :term:`PN` to create a 5363 special version of a recipe or package (i.e. a Multilib version). The 5364 variable is used in places where the prefix needs to be added to or 5365 removed from a name (e.g. the :term:`BPN` variable). 5366 :term:`MLPREFIX` gets set when a prefix has been added to :term:`PN`. 5367 5368 .. note:: 5369 5370 The "ML" in :term:`MLPREFIX` stands for "MultiLib". This representation 5371 is historical and comes from a time when ":ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk`" 5372 was a suffix rather than a prefix on the recipe name. When 5373 ":ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk`" was turned into a prefix, it made sense 5374 to set :term:`MLPREFIX` for it as well. 5375 5376 To help understand when :term:`MLPREFIX` might be needed, consider when 5377 :term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` is used to provide a :ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk` 5378 version of a recipe in addition to the target version. If that recipe 5379 declares build-time dependencies on tasks in other recipes by using 5380 :term:`DEPENDS`, then a dependency on "foo" will automatically get 5381 rewritten to a dependency on "nativesdk-foo". However, dependencies like 5382 the following will not get rewritten automatically:: 5383 5384 do_foo[depends] += "recipe:do_foo" 5385 5386 If you want such a dependency to also get transformed, you can do the 5387 following:: 5388 5389 do_foo[depends] += "${MLPREFIX}recipe:do_foo" 5390 5391 :term:`module_autoload` 5392 This variable has been replaced by the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` 5393 variable. You should replace all occurrences of :term:`module_autoload` 5394 with additions to :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`, for example:: 5395 5396 module_autoload_rfcomm = "rfcomm" 5397 5398 should now be replaced with:: 5399 5400 KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "rfcomm" 5401 5402 See the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` variable for more information. 5403 5404 :term:`module_conf` 5405 Specifies `modprobe.d <https://linux.die.net/man/5/modprobe.d>`__ 5406 syntax lines for inclusion in the ``/etc/modprobe.d/modname.conf`` 5407 file. 5408 5409 You can use this variable anywhere that it can be recognized by the 5410 kernel recipe or out-of-tree kernel module recipe (e.g. a machine 5411 configuration file, a distribution configuration file, an append file 5412 for the recipe, or the recipe itself). If you use this variable, you 5413 must also be sure to list the module name in the 5414 :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF` 5415 variable. 5416 5417 Here is the general syntax:: 5418 5419 module_conf_module_name = "modprobe.d-syntax" 5420 5421 You must use the kernel module name override. 5422 5423 Run ``man modprobe.d`` in the shell to find out more information on 5424 the exact syntax you want to provide with :term:`module_conf`. 5425 5426 Including :term:`module_conf` causes the OpenEmbedded build system to 5427 populate the ``/etc/modprobe.d/modname.conf`` file with 5428 ``modprobe.d`` syntax lines. Here is an example that adds the options 5429 ``arg1`` and ``arg2`` to a module named ``mymodule``:: 5430 5431 module_conf_mymodule = "options mymodule arg1=val1 arg2=val2" 5432 5433 For information on how to specify kernel modules to auto-load on 5434 boot, see the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` variable. 5435 5436 :term:`MODULE_TARBALL_DEPLOY` 5437 Controls creation of the ``modules-*.tgz`` file. Set this variable to 5438 "0" to disable creation of this file, which contains all of the 5439 kernel modules resulting from a kernel build. 5440 5441 :term:`MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME` 5442 The link name of the kernel module tarball. This variable is set in 5443 the ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows:: 5444 5445 MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" 5446 5447 The value 5448 of the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the 5449 same file, has the following value:: 5450 5451 KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" 5452 5453 See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional information. 5454 5455 :term:`MODULE_TARBALL_NAME` 5456 The base name of the kernel module tarball. This variable is set in 5457 the ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows:: 5458 5459 MODULE_TARBALL_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" 5460 5461 See :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` for additional information. 5462 5463 :term:`MOUNT_BASE` 5464 On non-systemd systems (where ``udev-extraconf`` is being used), 5465 specifies the base directory for auto-mounting filesystems. The 5466 default value is "/run/media". 5467 5468 :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS` 5469 Uniquely identifies the type of the target system for which packages 5470 are being built. This variable allows output for different types of 5471 target systems to be put into different subdirectories of the same 5472 output directory. 5473 5474 The default value of this variable is:: 5475 5476 ${PACKAGE_ARCH}${TARGET_VENDOR}-${TARGET_OS} 5477 5478 Some classes (e.g. :ref:`ref-classes-cross-canadian`) modify the 5479 :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS` value. 5480 5481 See the :term:`STAMP` variable for an example. See the 5482 :term:`STAGING_DIR_TARGET` variable for more information. 5483 5484 :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` 5485 A string identifying the host distribution. Strings consist of the 5486 host distributor ID followed by the release, as reported by the 5487 ``lsb_release`` tool or as read from ``/etc/lsb-release``. For 5488 example, when running a build on Ubuntu 12.10, the value is 5489 "Ubuntu-12.10". If this information is unable to be determined, the 5490 value resolves to "Unknown". 5491 5492 This variable is used by default to isolate native shared state 5493 packages for different distributions (e.g. to avoid problems with 5494 ``glibc`` version incompatibilities). Additionally, the variable is 5495 checked against 5496 :term:`SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS` if that 5497 variable is set. 5498 5499 :term:`NM` 5500 The minimal command and arguments to run ``nm``. 5501 5502 :term:`NO_GENERIC_LICENSE` 5503 Avoids QA errors when you use a non-common, non-CLOSED license in a 5504 recipe. There are packages, such as the linux-firmware package, with many 5505 licenses that are not in any way common. Also, new licenses are added 5506 occasionally to avoid introducing a lot of common license files, 5507 which are only applicable to a specific package. 5508 :term:`NO_GENERIC_LICENSE` is used to allow copying a license that does 5509 not exist in common licenses. 5510 5511 The following example shows how to add :term:`NO_GENERIC_LICENSE` to a 5512 recipe:: 5513 5514 NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[license_name] = "license_file_in_fetched_source" 5515 5516 Here is an example that 5517 uses the ``LICENSE.Abilis.txt`` file as the license from the fetched 5518 source:: 5519 5520 NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[Firmware-Abilis] = "LICENSE.Abilis.txt" 5521 5522 :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` 5523 Prevents installation of all "recommended-only" packages. 5524 Recommended-only packages are packages installed only through the 5525 :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable). Setting the 5526 :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` variable to "1" turns this feature on:: 5527 5528 NO_RECOMMENDATIONS = "1" 5529 5530 You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you 5531 can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name 5532 override:: 5533 5534 NO_RECOMMENDATIONS:pn-target_image = "1" 5535 5536 It is important to realize that if you choose to not install packages 5537 using this variable and some other packages are dependent on them 5538 (i.e. listed in a recipe's :term:`RDEPENDS` 5539 variable), the OpenEmbedded build system ignores your request and 5540 will install the packages to avoid dependency errors. 5541 5542 .. note:: 5543 5544 Some recommended packages might be required for certain system 5545 functionality, such as kernel modules. It is up to you to add 5546 packages with the :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable. 5547 5548 This variable is only supported when using the IPK and RPM 5549 packaging backends. DEB is not supported. 5550 5551 See the :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` and 5552 the :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables for 5553 related information. 5554 5555 :term:`NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG` 5556 Disables auto package from splitting ``.debug`` files. If a recipe 5557 requires ``FILES:${PN}-dbg`` to be set manually, the 5558 :term:`NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG` can be defined allowing you to define the 5559 content of the debug package. For example:: 5560 5561 NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG = "1" 5562 FILES:${PN}-dev = "${includedir}/${QT_DIR_NAME}/Qt/*" 5563 FILES:${PN}-dbg = "/usr/src/debug/" 5564 FILES:${QT_BASE_NAME}-demos-doc = "${docdir}/${QT_DIR_NAME}/qch/qt.qch" 5565 5566 :term:`NON_MULTILIB_RECIPES` 5567 A list of recipes that should not be built for multilib. OE-Core's 5568 ``multilib.conf`` file defines a reasonable starting point for this 5569 list with:: 5570 5571 NON_MULTILIB_RECIPES = "grub grub-efi make-mod-scripts ovmf u-boot" 5572 5573 :term:`OBJCOPY` 5574 The minimal command and arguments to run ``objcopy``. 5575 5576 :term:`OBJDUMP` 5577 The minimal command and arguments to run ``objdump``. 5578 5579 :term:`OE_BINCONFIG_EXTRA_MANGLE` 5580 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-binconfig` class, 5581 this variable specifies additional arguments passed to the "sed" 5582 command. The sed command alters any paths in configuration scripts 5583 that have been set up during compilation. Inheriting this class 5584 results in all paths in these scripts being changed to point into the 5585 ``sysroots/`` directory so that all builds that use the script will 5586 use the correct directories for the cross compiling layout. 5587 5588 See the ``meta/classes-recipe/binconfig.bbclass`` in the 5589 :term:`Source Directory` for details on how this class 5590 applies these additional sed command arguments. 5591 5592 :term:`OECMAKE_GENERATOR` 5593 A variable for the :ref:`ref-classes-cmake` class, allowing to choose 5594 which back-end will be generated by CMake to build an application. 5595 5596 By default, this variable is set to ``Ninja``, which is faster than GNU 5597 make, but if building is broken with Ninja, a recipe can use this 5598 variable to use GNU make instead:: 5599 5600 OECMAKE_GENERATOR = "Unix Makefiles" 5601 5602 :term:`OE_IMPORTS` 5603 An internal variable used to tell the OpenEmbedded build system what 5604 Python modules to import for every Python function run by the system. 5605 5606 .. note:: 5607 5608 Do not set this variable. It is for internal use only. 5609 5610 :term:`OE_INIT_ENV_SCRIPT` 5611 The name of the build environment setup script for the purposes of 5612 setting up the environment within the extensible SDK. The default 5613 value is "oe-init-build-env". 5614 5615 If you use a custom script to set up your build environment, set the 5616 :term:`OE_INIT_ENV_SCRIPT` variable to its name. 5617 5618 :term:`OE_TERMINAL` 5619 Controls how the OpenEmbedded build system spawns interactive 5620 terminals on the host development system (e.g. using the BitBake 5621 command with the ``-c devshell`` command-line option). For more 5622 information, see the ":ref:`dev-manual/development-shell:using a development shell`" section in 5623 the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 5624 5625 You can use the following values for the :term:`OE_TERMINAL` variable: 5626 5627 - auto 5628 - gnome 5629 - xfce 5630 - rxvt 5631 - screen 5632 - konsole 5633 - none 5634 5635 :term:`OEROOT` 5636 The directory from which the top-level build environment setup script 5637 is sourced. The Yocto Project provides a top-level build environment 5638 setup script: :ref:`structure-core-script`. When you run this 5639 script, the :term:`OEROOT` variable resolves to the directory that 5640 contains the script. 5641 5642 For additional information on how this variable is used, see the 5643 initialization script. 5644 5645 :term:`OEQA_REPRODUCIBLE_TEST_PACKAGE` 5646 Set the package manager(s) for build reproducibility testing. 5647 See :yocto_git:`reproducible.py </poky/tree/meta/lib/oeqa/selftest/cases/reproducible.py>` 5648 and :doc:`/test-manual/reproducible-builds`. 5649 5650 :term:`OEQA_REPRODUCIBLE_TEST_TARGET` 5651 Set build target for build reproducibility testing. By default 5652 all available recipes are compiled with "bitbake world", see also :term:`EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD` 5653 and :doc:`/test-manual/reproducible-builds`. 5654 5655 :term:`OEQA_REPRODUCIBLE_TEST_SSTATE_TARGETS` 5656 Set build targets which can be rebuilt using :ref:`shared state <overview-manual/concepts:shared state cache>` 5657 when running build reproducibility tests. See :doc:`/test-manual/reproducible-builds`. 5658 5659 :term:`OLDEST_KERNEL` 5660 Declares the oldest version of the Linux kernel that the produced 5661 binaries must support. This variable is passed into the build of the 5662 Embedded GNU C Library (``glibc``). 5663 5664 The default for this variable comes from the 5665 ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. You can override this 5666 default by setting the variable in a custom distribution 5667 configuration file. 5668 5669 :term:`OVERLAYFS_ETC_DEVICE` 5670 When the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc` class is 5671 inherited, specifies the device to be mounted for the read/write 5672 layer of ``/etc``. There is no default, so you must set this if you 5673 wish to enable :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc`, for 5674 example, assuming ``/dev/mmcblk0p2`` was the desired device:: 5675 5676 OVERLAYFS_ETC_DEVICE = "/dev/mmcblk0p2" 5677 5678 :term:`OVERLAYFS_ETC_EXPOSE_LOWER` 5679 When the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc` class is 5680 inherited, if set to "1" then a read-only access to the original 5681 ``/etc`` content will be provided as a ``lower/`` subdirectory of 5682 :term:`OVERLAYFS_ETC_MOUNT_POINT`. The default value is "0". 5683 5684 :term:`OVERLAYFS_ETC_FSTYPE` 5685 When the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc` class is 5686 inherited, specifies the file system type for the read/write 5687 layer of ``/etc``. There is no default, so you must set this if you 5688 wish to enable :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc`, 5689 for example, assuming the file system is ext4:: 5690 5691 OVERLAYFS_ETC_FSTYPE = "ext4" 5692 5693 :term:`OVERLAYFS_ETC_MOUNT_OPTIONS` 5694 When the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc` class is 5695 inherited, specifies the mount options for the read-write layer. 5696 The default value is "defaults". 5697 5698 :term:`OVERLAYFS_ETC_MOUNT_POINT` 5699 When the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc` class is 5700 inherited, specifies the parent mount path for the filesystem layers. 5701 There is no default, so you must set this if you wish to enable 5702 :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc`, for example if the desired path is 5703 "/data":: 5704 5705 OVERLAYFS_ETC_MOUNT_POINT = "/data" 5706 5707 :term:`OVERLAYFS_ETC_USE_ORIG_INIT_NAME` 5708 When the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc` class is inherited, controls 5709 how the generated init will be named. For more information, see the 5710 :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs-etc` class documentation. The default value 5711 is "1". 5712 5713 :term:`OVERLAYFS_MOUNT_POINT` 5714 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs` class, 5715 specifies mount point(s) to be used. For example:: 5716 5717 OVERLAYFS_MOUNT_POINT[data] = "/data" 5718 5719 The assumes you have a ``data.mount`` systemd unit defined elsewhere in 5720 your BSP (e.g. in ``systemd-machine-units`` recipe) and it is installed 5721 into the image. For more information see :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs`. 5722 5723 .. note:: 5724 5725 Although the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs` class is 5726 inherited by individual recipes, :term:`OVERLAYFS_MOUNT_POINT` 5727 should be set in your machine configuration. 5728 5729 :term:`OVERLAYFS_QA_SKIP` 5730 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs` class, 5731 provides the ability to disable QA checks for particular overlayfs 5732 mounts. For example:: 5733 5734 OVERLAYFS_QA_SKIP[data] = "mount-configured" 5735 5736 .. note:: 5737 5738 Although the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs` class is 5739 inherited by individual recipes, :term:`OVERLAYFS_QA_SKIP` 5740 should be set in your machine configuration. 5741 5742 :term:`OVERLAYFS_WRITABLE_PATHS` 5743 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-overlayfs` class, 5744 specifies writable paths used at runtime for the recipe. For 5745 example:: 5746 5747 OVERLAYFS_WRITABLE_PATHS[data] = "/usr/share/my-custom-application" 5748 5749 :term:`OVERRIDES` 5750 A colon-separated list of overrides that currently apply. Overrides 5751 are a BitBake mechanism that allows variables to be selectively 5752 overridden at the end of parsing. The set of overrides in 5753 :term:`OVERRIDES` represents the "state" during building, which includes 5754 the current recipe being built, the machine for which it is being 5755 built, and so forth. 5756 5757 As an example, if the string "an-override" appears as an element in 5758 the colon-separated list in :term:`OVERRIDES`, then the following 5759 assignment will override ``FOO`` with the value "overridden" at the 5760 end of parsing:: 5761 5762 FOO:an-override = "overridden" 5763 5764 See the 5765 ":ref:`bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:conditional syntax (overrides)`" 5766 section in the BitBake User Manual for more information on the 5767 overrides mechanism. 5768 5769 The default value of :term:`OVERRIDES` includes the values of the 5770 :term:`CLASSOVERRIDE`, 5771 :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES`, and 5772 :term:`DISTROOVERRIDES` variables. Another 5773 important override included by default is ``pn-${PN}``. This override 5774 allows variables to be set for a single recipe within configuration 5775 (``.conf``) files. Here is an example:: 5776 5777 FOO:pn-myrecipe = "myrecipe-specific value" 5778 5779 .. note:: 5780 5781 An easy way to see what overrides apply is to search for :term:`OVERRIDES` 5782 in the output of the ``bitbake -e`` command. See the 5783 ":ref:`dev-manual/debugging:viewing variable values`" section in the Yocto 5784 Project Development Tasks Manual for more information. 5785 5786 :term:`P` 5787 The recipe name and version. :term:`P` is comprised of the following:: 5788 5789 ${PN}-${PV} 5790 5791 :term:`P4DIR` 5792 See :term:`bitbake:P4DIR` in the BitBake manual. 5793 5794 :term:`PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA` 5795 This variable defines additional metadata to add to packages. 5796 5797 You may find you need to inject additional metadata into packages. 5798 This variable allows you to do that by setting the injected data as 5799 the value. Multiple fields can be added by splitting the content with 5800 the literal separator "\n". 5801 5802 The suffixes '_IPK', '_DEB', or '_RPM' can be applied to the variable 5803 to do package type specific settings. It can also be made package 5804 specific by using the package name as a suffix. 5805 5806 You can find out more about applying this variable in the 5807 ":ref:`dev-manual/packages:adding custom metadata to packages`" 5808 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 5809 5810 :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` 5811 The architecture of the resulting package or packages. 5812 5813 By default, the value of this variable is set to 5814 :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` when building for the 5815 target, :term:`BUILD_ARCH` when building for the 5816 build host, and "${SDK_ARCH}-${SDKPKGSUFFIX}" when building for the 5817 SDK. 5818 5819 .. note:: 5820 5821 See :term:`SDK_ARCH` for more information. 5822 5823 However, if your recipe's output packages are built specific to the 5824 target machine rather than generally for the architecture of the 5825 machine, you should set :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` to the value of 5826 :term:`MACHINE_ARCH` in the recipe as follows:: 5827 5828 PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}" 5829 5830 :term:`PACKAGE_ARCHS` 5831 Specifies a list of architectures compatible with the target machine. 5832 This variable is set automatically and should not normally be 5833 hand-edited. Entries are separated using spaces and listed in order 5834 of priority. The default value for :term:`PACKAGE_ARCHS` is "all any 5835 noarch ${PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS} ${MACHINE_ARCH}". 5836 5837 :term:`PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN` 5838 Enables easily adding packages to :term:`PACKAGES` before ``${PN}`` so 5839 that those added packages can pick up files that would normally be 5840 included in the default package. 5841 5842 :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` 5843 This variable, which is set in the ``local.conf`` configuration file 5844 found in the ``conf`` folder of the 5845 :term:`Build Directory`, specifies the package manager the 5846 OpenEmbedded build system uses when packaging data. 5847 5848 You can provide one or more of the following arguments for the 5849 variable:: 5850 5851 PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_rpm package_deb package_ipk" 5852 5853 The build system uses only the first argument in the list as the 5854 package manager when creating your image or SDK. However, packages 5855 will be created using any additional packaging classes you specify. 5856 For example, if you use the following in your ``local.conf`` file:: 5857 5858 PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_ipk" 5859 5860 The OpenEmbedded build system uses 5861 the IPK package manager to create your image or SDK. 5862 5863 For information on packaging and build performance effects as a 5864 result of the package manager in use, see the 5865 ":ref:`ref-classes-package`" section. 5866 5867 :term:`PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE` 5868 Determines how to split up and package debug and source information 5869 when creating debugging packages to be used with the GNU Project 5870 Debugger (GDB). In general, based on the value of this variable, 5871 you can combine the source and debug info in a single package, 5872 you can break out the source into a separate package that can be 5873 installed independently, or you can choose to not have the source 5874 packaged at all. 5875 5876 The possible values of :term:`PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE` variable: 5877 5878 - "``.debug``": All debugging and source info is placed in a single 5879 ``*-dbg`` package; debug symbol files are placed next to the 5880 binary in a ``.debug`` directory so that, if a binary is installed 5881 into ``/bin``, the corresponding debug symbol file is installed 5882 in ``/bin/.debug``. Source files are installed in the same ``*-dbg`` 5883 package under ``/usr/src/debug``. 5884 5885 - "``debug-file-directory``": As above, all debugging and source info 5886 is placed in a single ``*-dbg`` package; debug symbol files are 5887 placed entirely under the directory ``/usr/lib/debug`` and separated 5888 by the path from where the binary is installed, so that if a binary 5889 is installed in ``/bin``, the corresponding debug symbols are installed 5890 in ``/usr/lib/debug/bin``, and so on. As above, source is installed 5891 in the same package under ``/usr/src/debug``. 5892 5893 - "``debug-with-srcpkg``": Debugging info is placed in the standard 5894 ``*-dbg`` package as with the ``.debug`` value, while source is 5895 placed in a separate ``*-src`` package, which can be installed 5896 independently. This is the default setting for this variable, 5897 as defined in Poky's ``bitbake.conf`` file. 5898 5899 - "``debug-without-src``": The same behavior as with the ``.debug`` 5900 setting, but no source is packaged at all. 5901 5902 .. note:: 5903 5904 Much of the above package splitting can be overridden via 5905 use of the :term:`INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT` variable. 5906 5907 You can find out more about debugging using GDB by reading the 5908 ":ref:`dev-manual/debugging:debugging with the gnu project debugger (gdb) remotely`" section 5909 in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 5910 5911 :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` 5912 Lists packages that should not be installed into an image. For 5913 example:: 5914 5915 PACKAGE_EXCLUDE = "package_name package_name package_name ..." 5916 5917 You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you 5918 can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name 5919 override:: 5920 5921 PACKAGE_EXCLUDE:pn-target_image = "package_name" 5922 5923 If you choose to not install a package using this variable and some 5924 other package is dependent on it (i.e. listed in a recipe's 5925 :term:`RDEPENDS` variable), the OpenEmbedded build 5926 system generates a fatal installation error. Because the build system 5927 halts the process with a fatal error, you can use the variable with 5928 an iterative development process to remove specific components from a 5929 system. 5930 5931 This variable is supported only when using the IPK and RPM 5932 packaging backends. DEB is not supported. 5933 5934 See the :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` and the 5935 :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` variables for 5936 related information. 5937 5938 :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_COMPLEMENTARY` 5939 Prevents specific packages from being installed when you are 5940 installing complementary packages. 5941 5942 You might find that you want to prevent installing certain packages 5943 when you are installing complementary packages. For example, if you 5944 are using :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` to install 5945 ``dev-pkgs``, you might not want to install all packages from a 5946 particular multilib. If you find yourself in this situation, you can 5947 use the :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_COMPLEMENTARY` variable to specify regular 5948 expressions to match the packages you want to exclude. 5949 5950 :term:`PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS` 5951 Specifies the list of architectures compatible with the device CPU. 5952 This variable is useful when you build for several different devices 5953 that use miscellaneous processors such as XScale and ARM926-EJS. 5954 5955 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` 5956 Optionally specifies the package architectures used as part of the 5957 package feed URIs during the build. When used, the 5958 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variable is appended to the final package feed 5959 URI, which is constructed using the 5960 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` and 5961 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS` 5962 variables. 5963 5964 .. note:: 5965 5966 You can use the :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` 5967 variable to allow specific package architectures. If you do 5968 not need to allow specific architectures, which is a common 5969 case, you can omit this variable. Omitting the variable results in 5970 all available architectures for the current machine being included 5971 into remote package feeds. 5972 5973 Consider the following example where the :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`, 5974 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`, and :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables are 5975 defined in your ``local.conf`` file:: 5976 5977 PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \ 5978 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" 5979 PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev" 5980 PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" 5981 5982 Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: 5983 5984 .. code-block:: none 5985 5986 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all 5987 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 5988 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all 5989 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 5990 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all 5991 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 5992 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all 5993 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 5994 5995 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS` 5996 Specifies the base path used when constructing package feed URIs. The 5997 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS` variable makes up the middle portion of a 5998 package feed URI used by the OpenEmbedded build system. The base path 5999 lies between the :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` 6000 and :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables. 6001 6002 Consider the following example where the :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`, 6003 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`, and :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables are 6004 defined in your ``local.conf`` file:: 6005 6006 PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \ 6007 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" 6008 PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev" 6009 PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" 6010 6011 Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: 6012 6013 .. code-block:: none 6014 6015 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all 6016 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 6017 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all 6018 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 6019 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all 6020 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 6021 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all 6022 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 6023 6024 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` 6025 Specifies the front portion of the package feed URI used by the 6026 OpenEmbedded build system. Each final package feed URI is comprised 6027 of :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`, 6028 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`, and 6029 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables. 6030 6031 Consider the following example where the :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`, 6032 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`, and :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables are 6033 defined in your ``local.conf`` file:: 6034 6035 PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \ 6036 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" 6037 PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev" 6038 PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" 6039 6040 Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: 6041 6042 .. code-block:: none 6043 6044 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all 6045 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 6046 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all 6047 https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 6048 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all 6049 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 6050 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all 6051 https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 6052 6053 :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` 6054 The final list of packages passed to the package manager for 6055 installation into the image. 6056 6057 Because the package manager controls actual installation of all 6058 packages, the list of packages passed using :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` is 6059 not the final list of packages that are actually installed. This 6060 variable is internal to the image construction code. Consequently, in 6061 general, you should use the 6062 :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable to specify 6063 packages for installation. The exception to this is when working with 6064 the :ref:`core-image-minimal-initramfs <ref-manual/images:images>` 6065 image. When working with an initial RAM filesystem (:term:`Initramfs`) image, 6066 use the :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` variable. For information on creating an 6067 :term:`Initramfs`, see the ":ref:`dev-manual/building:building an initial ram filesystem (Initramfs) image`" section 6068 in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 6069 6070 :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL_ATTEMPTONLY` 6071 Specifies a list of packages the OpenEmbedded build system attempts 6072 to install when creating an image. If a listed package fails to 6073 install, the build system does not generate an error. This variable 6074 is generally not user-defined. 6075 6076 :term:`PACKAGE_PREPROCESS_FUNCS` 6077 Specifies a list of functions run to pre-process the 6078 :term:`PKGD` directory prior to splitting the files out 6079 to individual packages. 6080 6081 :term:`PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS` 6082 Specifies a list of dependencies for post-installation and 6083 pre-installation scripts on native/cross tools. If your 6084 post-installation or pre-installation script can execute at root filesystem 6085 creation time rather than on the target but depends on a native tool 6086 in order to execute, you need to list the tools in 6087 :term:`PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS`. 6088 6089 For information on running post-installation scripts, see the 6090 ":ref:`dev-manual/new-recipe:post-installation scripts`" 6091 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 6092 6093 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` 6094 This variable provides a means of enabling or disabling features of a 6095 recipe on a per-recipe basis. :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` blocks are defined in 6096 recipes when you specify features and then arguments that define 6097 feature behaviors. Here is the basic block structure (broken over 6098 multiple lines for readability):: 6099 6100 PACKAGECONFIG ??= "f1 f2 f3 ..." 6101 PACKAGECONFIG[f1] = "\ 6102 --with-f1, \ 6103 --without-f1, \ 6104 build-deps-for-f1, \ 6105 runtime-deps-for-f1, \ 6106 runtime-recommends-for-f1, \ 6107 packageconfig-conflicts-for-f1" 6108 PACKAGECONFIG[f2] = "\ 6109 ... and so on and so on ... 6110 6111 The :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` variable itself specifies a space-separated 6112 list of the features to enable. Following the features, you can 6113 determine the behavior of each feature by providing up to six 6114 order-dependent arguments, which are separated by commas. You can 6115 omit any argument you like but must retain the separating commas. The 6116 order is important and specifies the following: 6117 6118 #. Extra arguments that should be added to :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` 6119 if the feature is enabled. 6120 6121 #. Extra arguments that should be added to :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` 6122 if the feature is disabled. 6123 6124 #. Additional build dependencies (:term:`DEPENDS`) 6125 that should be added if the feature is enabled. 6126 6127 #. Additional runtime dependencies (:term:`RDEPENDS`) 6128 that should be added if the feature is enabled. 6129 6130 #. Additional runtime recommendations 6131 (:term:`RRECOMMENDS`) that should be added if 6132 the feature is enabled. 6133 6134 #. Any conflicting (that is, mutually exclusive) :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` 6135 settings for this feature. 6136 6137 Consider the following :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` block taken from the 6138 ``librsvg`` recipe. In this example the feature is ``gtk``, which has 6139 three arguments that determine the feature's behavior:: 6140 6141 PACKAGECONFIG[gtk] = "--with-gtk3,--without-gtk3,gtk+3" 6142 6143 The 6144 ``--with-gtk3`` and ``gtk+3`` arguments apply only if the feature is 6145 enabled. In this case, ``--with-gtk3`` is added to the configure 6146 script argument list and ``gtk+3`` is added to :term:`DEPENDS`. On the 6147 other hand, if the feature is disabled say through a ``.bbappend`` 6148 file in another layer, then the second argument ``--without-gtk3`` is 6149 added to the configure script instead. 6150 6151 The basic :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` structure previously described holds true 6152 regardless of whether you are creating a block or changing a block. 6153 When creating a block, use the structure inside your recipe. 6154 6155 If you want to change an existing :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` block, you can do 6156 so one of two ways: 6157 6158 - *Append file:* Create an append file named 6159 ``recipename.bbappend`` in your layer and override the value of 6160 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG`. You can either completely override the 6161 variable:: 6162 6163 PACKAGECONFIG = "f4 f5" 6164 6165 Or, you can just append the variable:: 6166 6167 PACKAGECONFIG:append = " f4" 6168 6169 - *Configuration file:* This method is identical to changing the 6170 block through an append file except you edit your ``local.conf`` 6171 or ``mydistro.conf`` file. As with append files previously 6172 described, you can either completely override the variable:: 6173 6174 PACKAGECONFIG:pn-recipename = "f4 f5" 6175 6176 Or, you can just amend the variable:: 6177 6178 PACKAGECONFIG:append:pn-recipename = " f4" 6179 6180 Consider the following example of a :ref:`ref-classes-cmake` recipe with a systemd service 6181 in which :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` is used to transform the systemd service 6182 into a feature that can be easily enabled or disabled via :term:`PACKAGECONFIG`:: 6183 6184 example.c 6185 example.service 6186 CMakeLists.txt 6187 6188 The ``CMakeLists.txt`` file contains:: 6189 6190 if(WITH_SYSTEMD) 6191 install(FILES ${PROJECT_SOURCE_DIR}/example.service DESTINATION /etc/systemd/systemd) 6192 endif(WITH_SYSTEMD) 6193 6194 In order to enable the installation of ``example.service`` we need to 6195 ensure that ``-DWITH_SYSTEMD=ON`` is passed to the ``cmake`` command 6196 execution. Recipes that have ``CMakeLists.txt`` generally inherit the 6197 :ref:`ref-classes-cmake` class, that runs ``cmake`` with 6198 :term:`EXTRA_OECMAKE`, which :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` will be 6199 appended to. Now, knowing that :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` is 6200 automatically filled with either the first or second element of 6201 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` flag value, the recipe would be like:: 6202 6203 inherit cmake 6204 PACKAGECONFIG = "systemd" 6205 PACKAGECONFIG[systemd] = "-DWITH_SYSTEMD=ON,-DWITH_SYSTEMD=OFF" 6206 6207 A side note to this recipe is to check if ``systemd`` is in fact the used :term:`INIT_MANAGER` 6208 or not:: 6209 6210 PACKAGECONFIG = "${@'systemd' if d.getVar('INIT_MANAGER') == 'systemd' else ''}" 6211 6212 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` 6213 A space-separated list of configuration options generated from the 6214 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` setting. 6215 6216 Classes such as :ref:`ref-classes-autotools` and :ref:`ref-classes-cmake` 6217 use :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` to pass :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` options 6218 to ``configure`` and ``cmake``, respectively. If you are using 6219 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` but not a class that handles the 6220 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task, then you need to use 6221 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` appropriately. 6222 6223 :term:`PACKAGEGROUP_DISABLE_COMPLEMENTARY` 6224 For recipes inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-packagegroup` class, setting 6225 :term:`PACKAGEGROUP_DISABLE_COMPLEMENTARY` to "1" specifies that the 6226 normal complementary packages (i.e. ``-dev``, ``-dbg``, and so forth) 6227 should not be automatically created by the ``packagegroup`` recipe, 6228 which is the default behavior. 6229 6230 :term:`PACKAGES` 6231 The list of packages the recipe creates. The default value is the 6232 following:: 6233 6234 ${PN}-src ${PN}-dbg ${PN}-staticdev ${PN}-dev ${PN}-doc ${PN}-locale ${PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN} ${PN} 6235 6236 During packaging, the :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task 6237 goes through :term:`PACKAGES` and uses the :term:`FILES` 6238 variable corresponding to each package to assign files to the 6239 package. If a file matches the :term:`FILES` variable for more than one 6240 package in :term:`PACKAGES`, it will be assigned to the earliest 6241 (leftmost) package. 6242 6243 Packages in the variable's list that are empty (i.e. where none of 6244 the patterns in ``FILES:``\ pkg match any files installed by the 6245 :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task) are not generated, 6246 unless generation is forced through the 6247 :term:`ALLOW_EMPTY` variable. 6248 6249 :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` 6250 A promise that your recipe satisfies runtime dependencies for 6251 optional modules that are found in other recipes. 6252 :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` does not actually satisfy the dependencies, it 6253 only states that they should be satisfied. For example, if a hard, 6254 runtime dependency (:term:`RDEPENDS`) of another 6255 package is satisfied at build time through the :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` 6256 variable, but a package with the module name is never actually 6257 produced, then the other package will be broken. Thus, if you attempt 6258 to include that package in an image, you will get a dependency 6259 failure from the packaging system during the 6260 :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task. 6261 6262 Typically, if there is a chance that such a situation can occur and 6263 the package that is not created is valid without the dependency being 6264 satisfied, then you should use :term:`RRECOMMENDS` 6265 (a soft runtime dependency) instead of :term:`RDEPENDS`. 6266 6267 For an example of how to use the :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` variable when 6268 you are splitting packages, see the 6269 ":ref:`dev-manual/packages:handling optional module packaging`" 6270 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 6271 6272 :term:`PACKAGESPLITFUNCS` 6273 Specifies a list of functions run to perform additional splitting of 6274 files into individual packages. Recipes can either prepend to this 6275 variable or prepend to the ``populate_packages`` function in order to 6276 perform additional package splitting. In either case, the function 6277 should set :term:`PACKAGES`, 6278 :term:`FILES`, :term:`RDEPENDS` and 6279 other packaging variables appropriately in order to perform the 6280 desired splitting. 6281 6282 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` 6283 6284 Extra options passed to the build tool command (``make``, 6285 ``ninja`` or more specific build engines, like the Go language one) 6286 during the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task, to specify parallel compilation 6287 on the local build host. This variable is usually in the form "-j x", 6288 where x represents the maximum number of parallel threads such engines 6289 can run. 6290 6291 .. note:: 6292 6293 For software compiled by ``make``, in order for :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` 6294 to be effective, ``make`` must be called with 6295 ``${``\ :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE`\ ``}``. An easy 6296 way to ensure this is to use the ``oe_runmake`` function. 6297 6298 By default, the OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this 6299 variable to be equal to the number of cores the build system uses. 6300 6301 .. note:: 6302 6303 If the software being built experiences dependency issues during 6304 the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task that result in race conditions, you can clear 6305 the :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable within the recipe as a workaround. For 6306 information on addressing race conditions, see the 6307 ":ref:`dev-manual/debugging:debugging parallel make races`" 6308 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 6309 6310 For single socket systems (i.e. one CPU), you should not have to 6311 override this variable to gain optimal parallelism during builds. 6312 However, if you have very large systems that employ multiple physical 6313 CPUs, you might want to make sure the :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable is 6314 not set higher than "-j 20". 6315 6316 For more information on speeding up builds, see the 6317 ":ref:`dev-manual/speeding-up-build:speeding up a build`" 6318 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 6319 6320 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST` 6321 Extra options passed to the build tool install command 6322 (``make install``, ``ninja install`` or more specific ones) 6323 during the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task in order to specify 6324 parallel installation. This variable defaults to the value of 6325 :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`. 6326 6327 .. note:: 6328 6329 For software compiled by ``make``, in order for :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST` 6330 to be effective, ``make`` must be called with 6331 ``${``\ :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE`\ ``}``. An easy 6332 way to ensure this is to use the ``oe_runmake`` function. 6333 6334 If the software being built experiences dependency issues during 6335 the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task that result in race conditions, you can 6336 clear the :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST` variable within the recipe as a 6337 workaround. For information on addressing race conditions, see the 6338 ":ref:`dev-manual/debugging:debugging parallel make races`" 6339 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 6340 6341 :term:`PATCHRESOLVE` 6342 Determines the action to take when a patch fails. You can set this 6343 variable to one of two values: "noop" and "user". 6344 6345 The default value of "noop" causes the build to simply fail when the 6346 OpenEmbedded build system cannot successfully apply a patch. Setting 6347 the value to "user" causes the build system to launch a shell and 6348 places you in the right location so that you can manually resolve the 6349 conflicts. 6350 6351 Set this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. 6352 6353 :term:`PATCHTOOL` 6354 Specifies the utility used to apply patches for a recipe during the 6355 :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task. You can specify one of 6356 three utilities: "patch", "quilt", or "git". The default utility used 6357 is "quilt" except for the quilt-native recipe itself. Because the 6358 quilt tool is not available at the time quilt-native is being 6359 patched, it uses "patch". 6360 6361 If you wish to use an alternative patching tool, set the variable in 6362 the recipe using one of the following:: 6363 6364 PATCHTOOL = "patch" 6365 PATCHTOOL = "quilt" 6366 PATCHTOOL = "git" 6367 6368 :term:`PE` 6369 The epoch of the recipe. By default, this variable is unset. The 6370 variable is used to make upgrades possible when the versioning scheme 6371 changes in some backwards incompatible way. 6372 6373 :term:`PE` is the default value of the :term:`PKGE` variable. 6374 6375 :term:`PEP517_WHEEL_PATH` 6376 When used by recipes that inherit the :ref:`ref-classes-python_pep517` 6377 class, denotes the path to ``dist/`` (short for distribution) where the 6378 binary archive ``wheel`` is built. 6379 6380 :term:`PERSISTENT_DIR` 6381 See :term:`bitbake:PERSISTENT_DIR` in the BitBake manual. 6382 6383 :term:`PF` 6384 Specifies the recipe or package name and includes all version and 6385 revision numbers (i.e. ``glibc-2.13-r20+svnr15508/`` and 6386 ``bash-4.2-r1/``). This variable is comprised of the following: 6387 ${:term:`PN`}-${:term:`EXTENDPE`}${:term:`PV`}-${:term:`PR`} 6388 6389 :term:`PIXBUF_PACKAGES` 6390 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-pixbufcache` 6391 class, this variable identifies packages that contain the pixbuf 6392 loaders used with ``gdk-pixbuf``. By default, the 6393 :ref:`ref-classes-pixbufcache` class assumes that 6394 the loaders are in the recipe's main package (i.e. 6395 ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). Use this variable if the 6396 loaders you need are in a package other than that main package. 6397 6398 :term:`PKG` 6399 The name of the resulting package created by the OpenEmbedded build 6400 system. 6401 6402 .. note:: 6403 6404 When using the :term:`PKG` variable, you must use a package name override. 6405 6406 For example, when the :ref:`ref-classes-debian` class renames the output 6407 package, it does so by setting ``PKG:packagename``. 6408 6409 :term:`PKG_CONFIG_PATH` 6410 The path to ``pkg-config`` files for the current build context. 6411 ``pkg-config`` reads this variable from the environment. 6412 6413 :term:`PKGD` 6414 Points to the destination directory for files to be packaged before 6415 they are split into individual packages. This directory defaults to 6416 the following:: 6417 6418 ${WORKDIR}/package 6419 6420 Do not change this default. 6421 6422 :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` 6423 Points to a shared, global-state directory that holds data generated 6424 during the packaging process. During the packaging process, the 6425 :ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task packages data 6426 for each recipe and installs it into this temporary, shared area. 6427 This directory defaults to the following, which you should not 6428 change:: 6429 6430 ${STAGING_DIR_HOST}/pkgdata 6431 6432 For examples of how this data is used, see the 6433 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`" 6434 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the 6435 ":ref:`dev-manual/debugging:viewing package information with \`\`oe-pkgdata-util\`\``" 6436 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For more 6437 information on the shared, global-state directory, see 6438 :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`. 6439 6440 :term:`PKGDEST` 6441 Points to the parent directory for files to be packaged after they 6442 have been split into individual packages. This directory defaults to 6443 the following:: 6444 6445 ${WORKDIR}/packages-split 6446 6447 Under this directory, the build system creates directories for each 6448 package specified in :term:`PACKAGES`. Do not change 6449 this default. 6450 6451 :term:`PKGDESTWORK` 6452 Points to a temporary work area where the 6453 :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task saves package metadata. 6454 The :term:`PKGDESTWORK` location defaults to the following:: 6455 6456 ${WORKDIR}/pkgdata 6457 6458 Do not change this default. 6459 6460 The :ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task copies the 6461 package metadata from :term:`PKGDESTWORK` to 6462 :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` to make it available globally. 6463 6464 :term:`PKGE` 6465 The epoch of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, :term:`PKGE` 6466 is set to :term:`PE`. 6467 6468 :term:`PKGR` 6469 The revision of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, 6470 :term:`PKGR` is set to :term:`PR`. 6471 6472 :term:`PKGV` 6473 The version of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, 6474 :term:`PKGV` is set to :term:`PV`. 6475 6476 :term:`PN` 6477 This variable can have two separate functions depending on the 6478 context: a recipe name or a resulting package name. 6479 6480 :term:`PN` refers to a recipe name in the context of a file used by the 6481 OpenEmbedded build system as input to create a package. The name is 6482 normally extracted from the recipe file name. For example, if the 6483 recipe is named ``expat_2.0.1.bb``, then the default value of :term:`PN` 6484 will be "expat". 6485 6486 The variable refers to a package name in the context of a file 6487 created or produced by the OpenEmbedded build system. 6488 6489 If applicable, the :term:`PN` variable also contains any special suffix 6490 or prefix. For example, using ``bash`` to build packages for the 6491 native machine, :term:`PN` is ``bash-native``. Using ``bash`` to build 6492 packages for the target and for Multilib, :term:`PN` would be ``bash`` 6493 and ``lib64-bash``, respectively. 6494 6495 :term:`POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND` 6496 Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build 6497 system has created the host part of the SDK. You can specify 6498 functions separated by spaces:: 6499 6500 POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND += "function" 6501 6502 If you need to pass the SDK path to a command within a function, you 6503 can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by 6504 the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the 6505 :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. 6506 6507 :term:`POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND` 6508 Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build 6509 system has created the target part of the SDK. You can specify 6510 functions separated by spaces:: 6511 6512 POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND += "function" 6513 6514 If you need to pass the SDK path to a command within a function, you 6515 can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by 6516 the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the 6517 :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. 6518 6519 :term:`PR` 6520 The revision of the recipe. The default value for this variable is 6521 "r0". Subsequent revisions of the recipe conventionally have the 6522 values "r1", "r2", and so forth. When :term:`PV` increases, 6523 :term:`PR` is conventionally reset to "r0". 6524 6525 .. note:: 6526 6527 The OpenEmbedded build system does not need the aid of :term:`PR` 6528 to know when to rebuild a recipe. The build system uses the task 6529 :ref:`input checksums <overview-manual/concepts:checksums (signatures)>` along with the 6530 :ref:`stamp <structure-build-tmp-stamps>` and 6531 :ref:`overview-manual/concepts:shared state cache` 6532 mechanisms. 6533 6534 The :term:`PR` variable primarily becomes significant when a package 6535 manager dynamically installs packages on an already built image. In 6536 this case, :term:`PR`, which is the default value of 6537 :term:`PKGR`, helps the package manager distinguish which 6538 package is the most recent one in cases where many packages have the 6539 same :term:`PV` (i.e. :term:`PKGV`). A component having many packages with 6540 the same :term:`PV` usually means that the packages all install the same 6541 upstream version, but with later (:term:`PR`) version packages including 6542 packaging fixes. 6543 6544 .. note:: 6545 6546 :term:`PR` does not need to be increased for changes that do not change the 6547 package contents or metadata. 6548 6549 Because manually managing :term:`PR` can be cumbersome and error-prone, 6550 an automated solution exists. See the 6551 ":ref:`dev-manual/packages:working with a pr service`" section 6552 in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more information. 6553 6554 :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` 6555 If multiple recipes provide the same item, this variable determines 6556 which recipe is preferred and thus provides the item (i.e. the 6557 preferred provider). You should always suffix this variable with the 6558 name of the provided item. And, you should define the variable using 6559 the preferred recipe's name (:term:`PN`). Here is a common 6560 example:: 6561 6562 PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel ?= "linux-yocto" 6563 6564 In the previous example, multiple recipes are providing "virtual/kernel". 6565 The :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` variable is set with the name (:term:`PN`) of 6566 the recipe you prefer to provide "virtual/kernel". 6567 6568 Here are more examples:: 6569 6570 PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/xserver = "xserver-xf86" 6571 PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/libgl ?= "mesa" 6572 6573 For more 6574 information, see the ":ref:`dev-manual/new-recipe:using virtual providers`" 6575 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 6576 6577 .. note:: 6578 6579 If you use a ``virtual/\*`` item with :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER`, then any 6580 recipe that :term:`PROVIDES` that item but is not selected (defined) 6581 by :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` is prevented from building, which is usually 6582 desirable since this mechanism is designed to select between mutually 6583 exclusive alternative providers. 6584 6585 :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDERS` 6586 See :term:`bitbake:PREFERRED_PROVIDERS` in the BitBake manual. 6587 6588 :term:`PREFERRED_VERSION` 6589 If there are multiple versions of a recipe available, this variable 6590 determines which version should be given preference. You must always 6591 suffix the variable with the :term:`PN` you want to select (`python` in 6592 the first example below), and you should specify the :term:`PV` 6593 accordingly (`3.4.0` in the example). 6594 6595 The :term:`PREFERRED_VERSION` variable supports limited wildcard use 6596 through the "``%``" character. You can use the character to match any 6597 number of characters, which can be useful when specifying versions 6598 that contain long revision numbers that potentially change. Here are 6599 two examples:: 6600 6601 PREFERRED_VERSION_python = "3.4.0" 6602 PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto = "5.0%" 6603 6604 .. note:: 6605 6606 The use of the "%" character is limited in that it only works at the end of the 6607 string. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other 6608 location of the string. 6609 6610 The specified version is matched against :term:`PV`, which 6611 does not necessarily match the version part of the recipe's filename. 6612 For example, consider two recipes ``foo_1.2.bb`` and ``foo_git.bb`` 6613 where ``foo_git.bb`` contains the following assignment:: 6614 6615 PV = "1.1+git${SRCPV}" 6616 6617 In this case, the correct way to select 6618 ``foo_git.bb`` is by using an assignment such as the following:: 6619 6620 PREFERRED_VERSION_foo = "1.1+git%" 6621 6622 Compare that previous example 6623 against the following incorrect example, which does not work:: 6624 6625 PREFERRED_VERSION_foo = "git" 6626 6627 Sometimes the :term:`PREFERRED_VERSION` variable can be set by 6628 configuration files in a way that is hard to change. You can use 6629 :term:`OVERRIDES` to set a machine-specific 6630 override. Here is an example:: 6631 6632 PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto:qemux86 = "5.0%" 6633 6634 Although not recommended, worst case, you can also use the 6635 "forcevariable" override, which is the strongest override possible. 6636 Here is an example:: 6637 6638 PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto:forcevariable = "5.0%" 6639 6640 .. note:: 6641 6642 The ``:forcevariable`` override is not handled specially. This override 6643 only works because the default value of :term:`OVERRIDES` includes "forcevariable". 6644 6645 If a recipe with the specified version is not available, a warning 6646 message will be shown. See :term:`REQUIRED_VERSION` if you want this 6647 to be an error instead. 6648 6649 :term:`PREMIRRORS` 6650 Specifies additional paths from which the OpenEmbedded build system 6651 gets source code. When the build system searches for source code, it 6652 first tries the local download directory. If that location fails, the 6653 build system tries locations defined by :term:`PREMIRRORS`, the upstream 6654 source, and then locations specified by 6655 :term:`MIRRORS` in that order. 6656 6657 The default value for :term:`PREMIRRORS` is defined in the 6658 ``meta/classes-global/mirrors.bbclass`` file in the core metadata layer. 6659 6660 Typically, you could add a specific server for the build system to 6661 attempt before any others by adding something like the following to 6662 the ``local.conf`` configuration file in the 6663 :term:`Build Directory`:: 6664 6665 PREMIRRORS:prepend = "\ 6666 git://.*/.* &YOCTO_DL_URL;/mirror/sources/ \ 6667 ftp://.*/.* &YOCTO_DL_URL;/mirror/sources/ \ 6668 http://.*/.* &YOCTO_DL_URL;/mirror/sources/ \ 6669 https://.*/.* &YOCTO_DL_URL;/mirror/sources/" 6670 6671 These changes cause the 6672 build system to intercept Git, FTP, HTTP, and HTTPS requests and 6673 direct them to the ``http://`` sources mirror. You can use 6674 ``file://`` URLs to point to local directories or network shares as 6675 well. 6676 6677 :term:`PRIORITY` 6678 Indicates the importance of a package. 6679 6680 :term:`PRIORITY` is considered to be part of the distribution policy 6681 because the importance of any given recipe depends on the purpose for 6682 which the distribution is being produced. Thus, :term:`PRIORITY` is not 6683 normally set within recipes. 6684 6685 You can set :term:`PRIORITY` to "required", "standard", "extra", and 6686 "optional", which is the default. 6687 6688 :term:`PRIVATE_LIBS` 6689 Specifies libraries installed within a recipe that should be ignored 6690 by the OpenEmbedded build system's shared library resolver. This 6691 variable is typically used when software being built by a recipe has 6692 its own private versions of a library normally provided by another 6693 recipe. In this case, you would not want the package containing the 6694 private libraries to be set as a dependency on other unrelated 6695 packages that should instead depend on the package providing the 6696 standard version of the library. 6697 6698 Libraries specified in this variable should be specified by their 6699 file name. For example, from the Firefox recipe in meta-browser:: 6700 6701 PRIVATE_LIBS = "libmozjs.so \ 6702 libxpcom.so \ 6703 libnspr4.so \ 6704 libxul.so \ 6705 libmozalloc.so \ 6706 libplc4.so \ 6707 libplds4.so" 6708 6709 For more information, see the 6710 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`" 6711 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 6712 6713 :term:`PROVIDES` 6714 A list of aliases by which a particular recipe can be known. By 6715 default, a recipe's own :term:`PN` is implicitly already in its 6716 :term:`PROVIDES` list and therefore does not need to mention that it 6717 provides itself. If a recipe uses :term:`PROVIDES`, the additional 6718 aliases are synonyms for the recipe and can be useful for satisfying 6719 dependencies of other recipes during the build as specified by 6720 :term:`DEPENDS`. 6721 6722 Consider the following example :term:`PROVIDES` statement from the recipe 6723 file ``eudev_3.2.9.bb``:: 6724 6725 PROVIDES += "udev" 6726 6727 The :term:`PROVIDES` statement 6728 results in the "eudev" recipe also being available as simply "udev". 6729 6730 .. note:: 6731 6732 A recipe's own recipe name (:term:`PN`) is always implicitly prepended 6733 to :term:`PROVIDES`, so while using "+=" in the above example may not be 6734 strictly necessary it is recommended to avoid confusion. 6735 6736 In addition to providing recipes under alternate names, the 6737 :term:`PROVIDES` mechanism is also used to implement virtual targets. A 6738 virtual target is a name that corresponds to some particular 6739 functionality (e.g. a Linux kernel). Recipes that provide the 6740 functionality in question list the virtual target in :term:`PROVIDES`. 6741 Recipes that depend on the functionality in question can include the 6742 virtual target in :term:`DEPENDS` to leave the choice of provider open. 6743 6744 Conventionally, virtual targets have names on the form 6745 "virtual/function" (e.g. "virtual/kernel"). The slash is simply part 6746 of the name and has no syntactical significance. 6747 6748 The :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` variable is 6749 used to select which particular recipe provides a virtual target. 6750 6751 .. note:: 6752 6753 A corresponding mechanism for virtual runtime dependencies (packages) 6754 exists. However, the mechanism does not depend on any special 6755 functionality beyond ordinary variable assignments. For example, 6756 :term:`VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager <VIRTUAL-RUNTIME>` refers to the 6757 package of the component that manages the ``/dev`` directory. 6758 6759 Setting the "preferred provider" for runtime dependencies is as 6760 simple as using the following assignment in a configuration file:: 6761 6762 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = "udev" 6763 6764 6765 :term:`PRSERV_HOST` 6766 The network based :term:`PR` service host and port. 6767 6768 The ``conf/templates/default/local.conf.sample.extended`` configuration 6769 file in the :term:`Source Directory` shows how the :term:`PRSERV_HOST` 6770 variable is set:: 6771 6772 PRSERV_HOST = "localhost:0" 6773 6774 You must 6775 set the variable if you want to automatically start a local :ref:`PR 6776 service <dev-manual/packages:working with a pr service>`. You can 6777 set :term:`PRSERV_HOST` to other values to use a remote PR service. 6778 6779 6780 :term:`PSEUDO_IGNORE_PATHS` 6781 A comma-separated (without spaces) list of path prefixes that should be ignored 6782 by pseudo when monitoring and recording file operations, in order to avoid 6783 problems with files being written to outside of the pseudo context and 6784 reduce pseudo's overhead. A path is ignored if it matches any prefix in the list 6785 and can include partial directory (or file) names. 6786 6787 6788 :term:`PTEST_ENABLED` 6789 Specifies whether or not :ref:`Package 6790 Test <dev-manual/packages:testing packages with ptest>` (ptest) 6791 functionality is enabled when building a recipe. You should not set 6792 this variable directly. Enabling and disabling building Package Tests 6793 at build time should be done by adding "ptest" to (or removing it 6794 from) :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`. 6795 6796 :term:`PV` 6797 The version of the recipe. The version is normally extracted from the 6798 recipe filename. For example, if the recipe is named 6799 ``expat_2.0.1.bb``, then the default value of :term:`PV` will be "2.0.1". 6800 :term:`PV` is generally not overridden within a recipe unless it is 6801 building an unstable (i.e. development) version from a source code 6802 repository (e.g. Git or Subversion). 6803 6804 :term:`PV` is the default value of the :term:`PKGV` variable. 6805 6806 :term:`PYPI_PACKAGE` 6807 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-pypi` class, specifies the 6808 `PyPI <https://pypi.org/>`__ package name to be built. The default value 6809 is set based upon :term:`BPN` (stripping any "python-" or "python3-" 6810 prefix off if present), however for some packages it will need to be set 6811 explicitly if that will not match the package name (e.g. where the 6812 package name has a prefix, underscores, uppercase letters etc.) 6813 6814 :term:`PYTHON_ABI` 6815 When used by recipes that inherit the :ref:`ref-classes-setuptools3` 6816 class, denotes the Application Binary Interface (ABI) currently in use 6817 for Python. By default, the ABI is "m". You do not have to set this 6818 variable as the OpenEmbedded build system sets it for you. 6819 6820 The OpenEmbedded build system uses the ABI to construct directory 6821 names used when installing the Python headers and libraries in 6822 sysroot (e.g. ``.../python3.3m/...``). 6823 6824 :term:`QA_EMPTY_DIRS` 6825 Specifies a list of directories that are expected to be empty when 6826 packaging; if ``empty-dirs`` appears in :term:`ERROR_QA` or 6827 :term:`WARN_QA` these will be checked and an error or warning 6828 (respectively) will be produced. 6829 6830 The default :term:`QA_EMPTY_DIRS` value is set in 6831 :ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`. 6832 6833 :term:`QA_EMPTY_DIRS_RECOMMENDATION` 6834 Specifies a recommendation for why a directory must be empty, 6835 which will be included in the error message if a specific directory 6836 is found to contain files. Must be overridden with the directory 6837 path to match on. 6838 6839 If no recommendation is specified for a directory, then the default 6840 "but it is expected to be empty" will be used. 6841 6842 An example message shows if files were present in '/dev':: 6843 6844 QA_EMPTY_DIRS_RECOMMENDATION:/dev = "but all devices must be created at runtime" 6845 6846 :term:`RANLIB` 6847 The minimal command and arguments to run ``ranlib``. 6848 6849 :term:`RCONFLICTS` 6850 The list of packages that conflict with packages. Note that packages 6851 will not be installed if conflicting packages are not first removed. 6852 6853 Like all package-controlling variables, you must always use them in 6854 conjunction with a package name override. Here is an example:: 6855 6856 RCONFLICTS:${PN} = "another_conflicting_package_name" 6857 6858 BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports 6859 specifying versioned dependencies. Although the syntax varies 6860 depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences 6861 from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the 6862 :term:`RCONFLICTS` variable:: 6863 6864 RCONFLICTS:${PN} = "package (operator version)" 6865 6866 For ``operator``, you can specify the following: 6867 6868 - = 6869 - < 6870 - > 6871 - <= 6872 - >= 6873 6874 For example, the following sets up a dependency on version 1.2 or 6875 greater of the package ``foo``:: 6876 6877 RCONFLICTS:${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" 6878 6879 :term:`RDEPENDS` 6880 Lists runtime dependencies of a package. These dependencies are other 6881 packages that must be installed in order for the package to function 6882 correctly. As an example, the following assignment declares that the 6883 package ``foo`` needs the packages ``bar`` and ``baz`` to be 6884 installed:: 6885 6886 RDEPENDS:foo = "bar baz" 6887 6888 The most common types of package 6889 runtime dependencies are automatically detected and added. Therefore, 6890 most recipes do not need to set :term:`RDEPENDS`. For more information, 6891 see the 6892 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`" 6893 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 6894 6895 The practical effect of the above :term:`RDEPENDS` assignment is that 6896 ``bar`` and ``baz`` will be declared as dependencies inside the 6897 package ``foo`` when it is written out by one of the 6898 :ref:`do_package_write_* <ref-tasks-package_write_deb>` tasks. 6899 Exactly how this is done depends on which package format is used, 6900 which is determined by 6901 :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`. When the 6902 corresponding package manager installs the package, it will know to 6903 also install the packages on which it depends. 6904 6905 To ensure that the packages ``bar`` and ``baz`` get built, the 6906 previous :term:`RDEPENDS` assignment also causes a task dependency to be 6907 added. This dependency is from the recipe's 6908 :ref:`ref-tasks-build` (not to be confused with 6909 :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`) task to the 6910 :ref:`do_package_write_* <ref-tasks-package_write_deb>` task of the recipes that build ``bar`` and 6911 ``baz``. 6912 6913 The names of the packages you list within :term:`RDEPENDS` must be the 6914 names of other packages --- they cannot be recipe names. Although 6915 package names and recipe names usually match, the important point 6916 here is that you are providing package names within the :term:`RDEPENDS` 6917 variable. For an example of the default list of packages created from 6918 a recipe, see the :term:`PACKAGES` variable. 6919 6920 Because the :term:`RDEPENDS` variable applies to packages being built, 6921 you should always use the variable in a form with an attached package 6922 name (remember that a single recipe can build multiple packages). For 6923 example, suppose you are building a development package that depends 6924 on the ``perl`` package. In this case, you would use the following 6925 :term:`RDEPENDS` statement:: 6926 6927 RDEPENDS:${PN}-dev += "perl" 6928 6929 In the example, 6930 the development package depends on the ``perl`` package. Thus, the 6931 :term:`RDEPENDS` variable has the ``${PN}-dev`` package name as part of 6932 the variable. 6933 6934 .. note:: 6935 6936 ``RDEPENDS:${PN}-dev`` includes ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}`` 6937 by default. This default is set in the BitBake configuration file 6938 (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``). Be careful not to accidentally remove 6939 ``${PN}`` when modifying ``RDEPENDS:${PN}-dev``. Use the "+=" operator 6940 rather than the "=" operator. 6941 6942 The package names you use with :term:`RDEPENDS` must appear as they would 6943 in the :term:`PACKAGES` variable. The :term:`PKG` variable 6944 allows a different name to be used for the final package (e.g. the 6945 :ref:`ref-classes-debian` class uses this to rename 6946 packages), but this final package name cannot be used with 6947 :term:`RDEPENDS`, which makes sense as :term:`RDEPENDS` is meant to be 6948 independent of the package format used. 6949 6950 BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports 6951 specifying versioned dependencies. Although the syntax varies 6952 depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences 6953 from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the 6954 :term:`RDEPENDS` variable:: 6955 6956 RDEPENDS:${PN} = "package (operator version)" 6957 6958 For ``operator``, you can specify the following: 6959 6960 - = 6961 - < 6962 - > 6963 - <= 6964 - >= 6965 6966 For version, provide the version number. 6967 6968 .. note:: 6969 6970 You can use :term:`EXTENDPKGV` to provide a full package version 6971 specification. 6972 6973 For example, the following sets up a dependency on version 1.2 or 6974 greater of the package ``foo``:: 6975 6976 RDEPENDS:${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" 6977 6978 For information on build-time dependencies, see the :term:`DEPENDS` 6979 variable. You can also see the 6980 ":ref:`bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks`" and 6981 ":ref:`bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies`" sections in the 6982 BitBake User Manual for additional information on tasks and dependencies. 6983 6984 :term:`RECIPE_MAINTAINER` 6985 This variable defines the name and e-mail address of the maintainer of a 6986 recipe. Such information can be used by human users submitted changes, 6987 and by automated tools to send notifications, for example about 6988 vulnerabilities or source updates. 6989 6990 The variable can be defined in a global distribution :oe_git:`maintainers.inc 6991 </openembedded-core/tree/meta/conf/distro/include/maintainers.inc>` file:: 6992 6993 meta/conf/distro/include/maintainers.inc:RECIPE_MAINTAINER:pn-sysvinit = "Ross Burton <ross.burton@arm.com>" 6994 6995 It can also be directly defined in a recipe, 6996 for example in the ``libgpiod`` one:: 6997 6998 RECIPE_MAINTAINER = "Bartosz Golaszewski <brgl@bgdev.pl>" 6999 7000 :term:`RECIPE_NO_UPDATE_REASON` 7001 If a recipe should not be replaced by a more recent upstream version, 7002 putting the reason why in this variable in a recipe allows 7003 ``devtool check-upgrade-status`` command to display it, as explained 7004 in the ":ref:`ref-manual/devtool-reference:checking on the upgrade status of a recipe`" 7005 section. 7006 7007 :term:`RECIPE_SYSROOT` 7008 This variable points to the directory that holds all files populated from 7009 recipes specified in :term:`DEPENDS`. As the name indicates, 7010 think of this variable as a custom root (``/``) for the recipe that will be 7011 used by the compiler in order to find headers and other files needed to complete 7012 its job. 7013 7014 This variable is related to :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST` or :term:`STAGING_DIR_TARGET` 7015 according to the type of the recipe and the build target. 7016 7017 To better understand this variable, consider the following examples: 7018 7019 - For ``#include <header.h>``, ``header.h`` should be in ``"${RECIPE_SYSROOT}/usr/include"`` 7020 7021 - For ``-lexample``, ``libexample.so`` should be in ``"${RECIPE_SYSROOT}/lib"`` 7022 or other library sysroot directories. 7023 7024 The default value is ``"${WORKDIR}/recipe-sysroot"``. 7025 Do not modify it. 7026 7027 :term:`RECIPE_SYSROOT_NATIVE` 7028 This is similar to :term:`RECIPE_SYSROOT` but the populated files are from 7029 ``-native`` recipes. This allows a recipe built for the target machine to 7030 use ``native`` tools. 7031 7032 This variable is related to :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`. 7033 7034 The default value is ``"${WORKDIR}/recipe-sysroot-native"``. 7035 Do not modify it. 7036 7037 :term:`REPODIR` 7038 See :term:`bitbake:REPODIR` in the BitBake manual. 7039 7040 :term:`REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES` 7041 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-features_check` 7042 class, this variable identifies distribution features that must exist 7043 in the current configuration in order for the OpenEmbedded build 7044 system to build the recipe. In other words, if the 7045 :term:`REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES` variable lists a feature that does not 7046 appear in :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` within the current configuration, then 7047 the recipe will be skipped, and if the build system attempts to build 7048 the recipe then an error will be triggered. 7049 7050 :term:`REQUIRED_VERSION` 7051 If there are multiple versions of a recipe available, this variable 7052 determines which version should be given preference. 7053 :term:`REQUIRED_VERSION` works in exactly the same manner as 7054 :term:`PREFERRED_VERSION`, except that if the specified version is not 7055 available then an error message is shown and the build fails 7056 immediately. 7057 7058 If both :term:`REQUIRED_VERSION` and :term:`PREFERRED_VERSION` are set 7059 for the same recipe, the :term:`REQUIRED_VERSION` value applies. 7060 7061 :term:`RM_WORK_EXCLUDE` 7062 With :ref:`ref-classes-rm-work` enabled, this variable 7063 specifies a list of recipes whose work directories should not be removed. 7064 See the ":ref:`ref-classes-rm-work`" section for more details. 7065 7066 :term:`ROOT_HOME` 7067 Defines the root home directory. By default, this directory is set as 7068 follows in the BitBake configuration file:: 7069 7070 ROOT_HOME ??= "/home/root" 7071 7072 .. note:: 7073 7074 This default value is likely used because some embedded solutions 7075 prefer to have a read-only root filesystem and prefer to keep 7076 writeable data in one place. 7077 7078 You can override the default by setting the variable in any layer or 7079 in the ``local.conf`` file. Because the default is set using a "weak" 7080 assignment (i.e. "??="), you can use either of the following forms to 7081 define your override:: 7082 7083 ROOT_HOME = "/root" 7084 ROOT_HOME ?= "/root" 7085 7086 These 7087 override examples use ``/root``, which is probably the most commonly 7088 used override. 7089 7090 :term:`ROOTFS` 7091 Indicates a filesystem image to include as the root filesystem. 7092 7093 The :term:`ROOTFS` variable is an optional variable used with the 7094 :ref:`ref-classes-image-live` class. 7095 7096 :term:`ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND` 7097 Specifies a list of functions to call after the OpenEmbedded build 7098 system has installed packages. You can specify functions separated by 7099 spaces:: 7100 7101 ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND += "function" 7102 7103 If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a 7104 function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the 7105 directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the 7106 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more 7107 information. 7108 7109 :term:`ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND` 7110 Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build 7111 system has created the root filesystem. You can specify functions 7112 separated by spaces:: 7113 7114 ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function" 7115 7116 If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a 7117 function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the 7118 directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the 7119 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more 7120 information. 7121 7122 :term:`ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND` 7123 Specifies a list of functions to call after the OpenEmbedded build 7124 system has removed unnecessary packages. When runtime package 7125 management is disabled in the image, several packages are removed 7126 including ``base-passwd``, ``shadow``, and ``update-alternatives``. 7127 You can specify functions separated by spaces:: 7128 7129 ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND += "function" 7130 7131 If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a 7132 function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the 7133 directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the 7134 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more 7135 information. 7136 7137 :term:`ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND` 7138 Specifies a list of functions to call before the OpenEmbedded build 7139 system has created the root filesystem. You can specify functions 7140 separated by spaces:: 7141 7142 ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND += "function" 7143 7144 If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a 7145 function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the 7146 directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the 7147 :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more 7148 information. 7149 7150 :term:`RPROVIDES` 7151 A list of package name aliases that a package also provides. These 7152 aliases are useful for satisfying runtime dependencies of other 7153 packages both during the build and on the target (as specified by 7154 :term:`RDEPENDS`). 7155 7156 .. note:: 7157 7158 A package's own name is implicitly already in its :term:`RPROVIDES` list. 7159 7160 As with all package-controlling variables, you must always use the 7161 variable in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an 7162 example:: 7163 7164 RPROVIDES:${PN} = "widget-abi-2" 7165 7166 :term:`RRECOMMENDS` 7167 A list of packages that extends the usability of a package being 7168 built. The package being built does not depend on this list of 7169 packages in order to successfully build, but rather uses them for 7170 extended usability. To specify runtime dependencies for packages, see 7171 the :term:`RDEPENDS` variable. 7172 7173 The package manager will automatically install the :term:`RRECOMMENDS` 7174 list of packages when installing the built package. However, you can 7175 prevent listed packages from being installed by using the 7176 :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`, 7177 :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`, and 7178 :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables. 7179 7180 Packages specified in :term:`RRECOMMENDS` need not actually be produced. 7181 However, there must be a recipe providing each package, either 7182 through the :term:`PACKAGES` or 7183 :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` variables or the 7184 :term:`RPROVIDES` variable, or an error will occur 7185 during the build. If such a recipe does exist and the package is not 7186 produced, the build continues without error. 7187 7188 Because the :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable applies to packages being built, 7189 you should always attach an override to the variable to specify the 7190 particular package whose usability is being extended. For example, 7191 suppose you are building a development package that is extended to 7192 support wireless functionality. In this case, you would use the 7193 following:: 7194 7195 RRECOMMENDS:${PN}-dev += "wireless_package_name" 7196 7197 In the 7198 example, the package name (``${PN}-dev``) must appear as it would in 7199 the :term:`PACKAGES` namespace before any renaming of the output package 7200 by classes such as :ref:`ref-classes-debian`. 7201 7202 BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports 7203 specifying versioned recommends. Although the syntax varies depending 7204 on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences from you. 7205 Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the 7206 :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable:: 7207 7208 RRECOMMENDS:${PN} = "package (operator version)" 7209 7210 For ``operator``, you can specify the following: 7211 7212 - = 7213 - < 7214 - > 7215 - <= 7216 - >= 7217 7218 For example, the following sets up a recommend on version 1.2 or 7219 greater of the package ``foo``:: 7220 7221 RRECOMMENDS:${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" 7222 7223 :term:`RREPLACES` 7224 A list of packages replaced by a package. The package manager uses 7225 this variable to determine which package should be installed to 7226 replace other package(s) during an upgrade. In order to also have the 7227 other package(s) removed at the same time, you must add the name of 7228 the other package to the :term:`RCONFLICTS` variable. 7229 7230 As with all package-controlling variables, you must use this variable 7231 in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an example:: 7232 7233 RREPLACES:${PN} = "other_package_being_replaced" 7234 7235 BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports 7236 specifying versioned replacements. Although the syntax varies 7237 depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences 7238 from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the 7239 :term:`RREPLACES` variable:: 7240 7241 RREPLACES:${PN} = "package (operator version)" 7242 7243 For ``operator``, you can specify the following: 7244 7245 - = 7246 - < 7247 - > 7248 - <= 7249 - >= 7250 7251 For example, the following sets up a replacement using version 1.2 7252 or greater of the package ``foo``:: 7253 7254 RREPLACES:${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" 7255 7256 :term:`RSUGGESTS` 7257 A list of additional packages that you can suggest for installation 7258 by the package manager at the time a package is installed. Not all 7259 package managers support this functionality. 7260 7261 As with all package-controlling variables, you must always use this 7262 variable in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an 7263 example:: 7264 7265 RSUGGESTS:${PN} = "useful_package another_package" 7266 7267 :term:`RUST_CHANNEL` 7268 Specifies which version of Rust to build - "stable", "beta" or "nightly". 7269 The default value is "stable". Set this at your own risk, as values other 7270 than "stable" are not guaranteed to work at a given time. 7271 7272 :term:`S` 7273 The location in the :term:`Build Directory` where 7274 unpacked recipe source code resides. By default, this directory is 7275 ``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/${``\ :term:`BPN`\ ``}-${``\ :term:`PV`\ ``}``, 7276 where ``${BPN}`` is the base recipe name and ``${PV}`` is the recipe 7277 version. If the source tarball extracts the code to a directory named 7278 anything other than ``${BPN}-${PV}``, or if the source code is 7279 fetched from an SCM such as Git or Subversion, then you must set 7280 :term:`S` in the recipe so that the OpenEmbedded build system knows where 7281 to find the unpacked source. 7282 7283 As an example, assume a :term:`Source Directory` 7284 top-level folder named ``poky`` and a default :term:`Build Directory` at 7285 ``poky/build``. In this case, the work directory the build system 7286 uses to keep the unpacked recipe for ``db`` is the following:: 7287 7288 poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/db/5.1.19-r3/db-5.1.19 7289 7290 The unpacked source code resides in the ``db-5.1.19`` folder. 7291 7292 This next example assumes a Git repository. By default, Git 7293 repositories are cloned to ``${WORKDIR}/git`` during 7294 :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`. Since this path is different 7295 from the default value of :term:`S`, you must set it specifically so the 7296 source can be located:: 7297 7298 SRC_URI = "git://path/to/repo.git;branch=main" 7299 S = "${WORKDIR}/git" 7300 7301 :term:`SANITY_REQUIRED_UTILITIES` 7302 Specifies a list of command-line utilities that should be checked for 7303 during the initial sanity checking process when running BitBake. If 7304 any of the utilities are not installed on the build host, then 7305 BitBake immediately exits with an error. 7306 7307 :term:`SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS` 7308 A list of the host distribution identifiers that the build system has 7309 been tested against. Identifiers consist of the host distributor ID 7310 followed by the release, as reported by the ``lsb_release`` tool or 7311 as read from ``/etc/lsb-release``. Separate the list items with 7312 explicit newline characters (``\n``). If :term:`SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS` is 7313 not empty and the current value of 7314 :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` does not appear in the 7315 list, then the build system reports a warning that indicates the 7316 current host distribution has not been tested as a build host. 7317 7318 :term:`SDK_ARCH` 7319 The target architecture for the SDK. Typically, you do not directly 7320 set this variable. Instead, use :term:`SDKMACHINE`. 7321 7322 :term:`SDK_ARCHIVE_TYPE` 7323 Specifies the type of archive to create for the SDK. Valid values: 7324 7325 - ``tar.xz`` (default) 7326 - ``zip`` 7327 7328 Only one archive type can be specified. 7329 7330 :term:`SDK_BUILDINFO_FILE` 7331 When using the :ref:`ref-classes-image-buildinfo` class, 7332 specifies the file in the SDK to write the build information into. The 7333 default value is "``/buildinfo``". 7334 7335 :term:`SDK_CUSTOM_TEMPLATECONF` 7336 When building the extensible SDK, if :term:`SDK_CUSTOM_TEMPLATECONF` is set to 7337 "1" and a ``conf/templateconf.cfg`` file exists in the :term:`Build Directory` 7338 (:term:`TOPDIR`) then this will be copied into the SDK. 7339 7340 :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` 7341 The directory set up and used by the 7342 :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk>` class to which the 7343 SDK is deployed. The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk>` 7344 class defines :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` as follows:: 7345 7346 SDK_DEPLOY = "${TMPDIR}/deploy/sdk" 7347 7348 :term:`SDK_DIR` 7349 The parent directory used by the OpenEmbedded build system when 7350 creating SDK output. The 7351 :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class defines 7352 the variable as follows:: 7353 7354 SDK_DIR = "${WORKDIR}/sdk" 7355 7356 .. note:: 7357 7358 The :term:`SDK_DIR` directory is a temporary directory as it is part of 7359 :term:`WORKDIR`. The final output directory is :term:`SDK_DEPLOY`. 7360 7361 :term:`SDK_EXT_TYPE` 7362 Controls whether or not shared state artifacts are copied into the 7363 extensible SDK. The default value of "full" copies all of the 7364 required shared state artifacts into the extensible SDK. The value 7365 "minimal" leaves these artifacts out of the SDK. 7366 7367 .. note:: 7368 7369 If you set the variable to "minimal", you need to ensure 7370 :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` is set in the SDK's configuration to enable the 7371 artifacts to be fetched as needed. 7372 7373 :term:`SDK_HOST_MANIFEST` 7374 The manifest file for the host part of the SDK. This file lists all 7375 the installed packages that make up the host part of the SDK. The 7376 file contains package information on a line-per-package basis as 7377 follows:: 7378 7379 packagename packagearch version 7380 7381 The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class 7382 defines the manifest file as follows:: 7383 7384 SDK_HOST_MANIFEST = "${SDK_DEPLOY}/${TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME}.host.manifest" 7385 7386 The location is derived using the :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` and 7387 :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variables. 7388 7389 :term:`SDK_INCLUDE_PKGDATA` 7390 When set to "1", specifies to include the packagedata for all recipes 7391 in the "world" target in the extensible SDK. Including this data 7392 allows the ``devtool search`` command to find these recipes in search 7393 results, as well as allows the ``devtool add`` command to map 7394 dependencies more effectively. 7395 7396 .. note:: 7397 7398 Enabling the :term:`SDK_INCLUDE_PKGDATA` 7399 variable significantly increases build time because all of world 7400 needs to be built. Enabling the variable also slightly increases 7401 the size of the extensible SDK. 7402 7403 :term:`SDK_INCLUDE_TOOLCHAIN` 7404 When set to "1", specifies to include the toolchain in the extensible 7405 SDK. Including the toolchain is useful particularly when 7406 :term:`SDK_EXT_TYPE` is set to "minimal" to keep 7407 the SDK reasonably small but you still want to provide a usable 7408 toolchain. For example, suppose you want to use the toolchain from an 7409 IDE or from other tools and you do not want to perform additional 7410 steps to install the toolchain. 7411 7412 The :term:`SDK_INCLUDE_TOOLCHAIN` variable defaults to "0" if 7413 :term:`SDK_EXT_TYPE` is set to "minimal", and defaults to "1" if 7414 :term:`SDK_EXT_TYPE` is set to "full". 7415 7416 :term:`SDK_NAME` 7417 The base name for SDK output files. The default value (as set in 7418 ``meta-poky/conf/distro/poky.conf``) is derived from the 7419 :term:`DISTRO`, 7420 :term:`TCLIBC`, 7421 :term:`SDKMACHINE`, 7422 :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME`, 7423 :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH`, and 7424 :term:`MACHINE` variables:: 7425 7426 SDK_NAME = "${DISTRO}-${TCLIBC}-${SDKMACHINE}-${IMAGE_BASENAME}-${TUNE_PKGARCH}-${MACHINE}" 7427 7428 :term:`SDK_OS` 7429 Specifies the operating system for which the SDK will be built. The 7430 default value is the value of :term:`BUILD_OS`. 7431 7432 :term:`SDK_OUTPUT` 7433 The location used by the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK 7434 output. The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` 7435 class defines the variable as follows:: 7436 7437 SDK_DIR = "${WORKDIR}/sdk" 7438 SDK_OUTPUT = "${SDK_DIR}/image" 7439 SDK_DEPLOY = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/sdk" 7440 7441 .. note:: 7442 7443 The :term:`SDK_OUTPUT` directory is a temporary directory as it is part of 7444 :term:`WORKDIR` by way of :term:`SDK_DIR`. The final output directory is 7445 :term:`SDK_DEPLOY`. 7446 7447 :term:`SDK_PACKAGE_ARCHS` 7448 Specifies a list of architectures compatible with the SDK machine. 7449 This variable is set automatically and should not normally be 7450 hand-edited. Entries are separated using spaces and listed in order 7451 of priority. The default value for :term:`SDK_PACKAGE_ARCHS` is "all any 7452 noarch ${SDK_ARCH}-${SDKPKGSUFFIX}". 7453 7454 :term:`SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND` 7455 Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build 7456 system creates the SDK. You can specify functions separated by 7457 spaces: 7458 7459 SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function" 7460 7461 If you need to pass an SDK path to a command within a function, you 7462 can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by 7463 the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the 7464 :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. 7465 7466 :term:`SDK_PREFIX` 7467 The toolchain binary prefix used for 7468 :ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk` recipes. The 7469 OpenEmbedded build system uses the :term:`SDK_PREFIX` value to set the 7470 :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` when building 7471 ``nativesdk`` recipes. The default value is "${SDK_SYS}-". 7472 7473 :term:`SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS` 7474 A list of shared state tasks added to the extensible SDK. By default, 7475 the following tasks are added: 7476 7477 - :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_lic` 7478 - :ref:`ref-tasks-package_qa` 7479 - :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` 7480 - :ref:`ref-tasks-deploy` 7481 7482 Despite the default value of "" for the 7483 :term:`SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS` variable, the above four tasks are always added 7484 to the SDK. To specify tasks beyond these four, you need to use the 7485 :term:`SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS` variable (e.g. you are defining additional 7486 tasks that are needed in order to build 7487 :term:`SDK_TARGETS`). 7488 7489 :term:`SDK_SYS` 7490 Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating 7491 system, for which the SDK will be built. 7492 7493 The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based 7494 on :term:`SDK_ARCH`, 7495 :term:`SDK_VENDOR`, and 7496 :term:`SDK_OS`. You do not need to set the :term:`SDK_SYS` 7497 variable yourself. 7498 7499 :term:`SDK_TARGET_MANIFEST` 7500 The manifest file for the target part of the SDK. This file lists all 7501 the installed packages that make up the target part of the SDK. The 7502 file contains package information on a line-per-package basis as 7503 follows:: 7504 7505 packagename packagearch version 7506 7507 The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class 7508 defines the manifest file as follows:: 7509 7510 SDK_TARGET_MANIFEST = "${SDK_DEPLOY}/${TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME}.target.manifest" 7511 7512 The location is derived using the :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` and 7513 :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variables. 7514 7515 :term:`SDK_TARGETS` 7516 A list of targets to install from shared state as part of the 7517 standard or extensible SDK installation. The default value is "${PN}" 7518 (i.e. the image from which the SDK is built). 7519 7520 The :term:`SDK_TARGETS` variable is an internal variable and typically 7521 would not be changed. 7522 7523 :term:`SDK_TITLE` 7524 The title to be printed when running the SDK installer. By default, 7525 this title is based on the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` or 7526 :term:`DISTRO` variable and is set in the 7527 :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class as 7528 follows:: 7529 7530 SDK_TITLE ??= "${@d.getVar('DISTRO_NAME') or d.getVar('DISTRO')} SDK" 7531 7532 For the default distribution "poky", 7533 :term:`SDK_TITLE` is set to "Poky (Yocto Project Reference Distro)". 7534 7535 For information on how to change this default title, see the 7536 ":ref:`sdk-manual/appendix-customizing:changing the extensible sdk installer title`" 7537 section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the 7538 Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. 7539 7540 :term:`SDK_TOOLCHAIN_LANGS` 7541 Specifies programming languages to support in the SDK, as a 7542 space-separated list. Currently supported items are ``rust`` and ``go``. 7543 7544 :term:`SDK_UPDATE_URL` 7545 An optional URL for an update server for the extensible SDK. If set, 7546 the value is used as the default update server when running 7547 ``devtool sdk-update`` within the extensible SDK. 7548 7549 :term:`SDK_VENDOR` 7550 Specifies the name of the SDK vendor. 7551 7552 :term:`SDK_VERSION` 7553 Specifies the version of the SDK. The Poky distribution configuration file 7554 (``/meta-poky/conf/distro/poky.conf``) sets the default 7555 :term:`SDK_VERSION` as follows:: 7556 7557 SDK_VERSION = "${@d.getVar('DISTRO_VERSION').replace('snapshot-${METADATA_REVISION}', 'snapshot')}" 7558 7559 For additional information, see the 7560 :term:`DISTRO_VERSION` and 7561 :term:`METADATA_REVISION` variables. 7562 7563 :term:`SDK_ZIP_OPTIONS` 7564 Specifies extra options to pass to the ``zip`` command when zipping the SDK 7565 (i.e. when :term:`SDK_ARCHIVE_TYPE` is set to "zip"). The default value is 7566 "-y". 7567 7568 :term:`SDKEXTPATH` 7569 The default installation directory for the Extensible SDK. By 7570 default, this directory is based on the :term:`DISTRO` 7571 variable and is set in the 7572 :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class as 7573 follows:: 7574 7575 SDKEXTPATH ??= "~/${@d.getVar('DISTRO')}_sdk" 7576 7577 For the 7578 default distribution "poky", the :term:`SDKEXTPATH` is set to "poky_sdk". 7579 7580 For information on how to change this default directory, see the 7581 ":ref:`sdk-manual/appendix-customizing:changing the default sdk installation directory`" 7582 section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the 7583 Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. 7584 7585 :term:`SDKIMAGE_FEATURES` 7586 Equivalent to :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. However, this variable applies to 7587 the SDK generated from an image using the following command:: 7588 7589 $ bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename 7590 7591 :term:`SDKMACHINE` 7592 The machine for which the SDK is built. In other words, the SDK is built 7593 such that it runs on the target you specify with the :term:`SDKMACHINE` 7594 value. The value points to a corresponding ``.conf`` file under 7595 ``conf/machine-sdk/`` in the enabled layers, for example ``aarch64``, 7596 ``i586``, ``i686``, ``ppc64``, ``ppc64le``, and ``x86_64`` are 7597 :oe_git:`available in OpenEmbedded-Core </openembedded-core/tree/meta/conf/machine-sdk>`. 7598 7599 The variable defaults to :term:`BUILD_ARCH` so that SDKs are built for the 7600 architecture of the build machine. 7601 7602 .. note:: 7603 7604 You cannot set the :term:`SDKMACHINE` 7605 variable in your distribution configuration file. If you do, the 7606 configuration will not take effect. 7607 7608 :term:`SDKPATH` 7609 Defines the path used to collect the SDK components and build the 7610 installer. 7611 7612 :term:`SDKPATHINSTALL` 7613 Defines the path offered to the user for installation of the SDK that 7614 is generated by the OpenEmbedded build system. The path appears as 7615 the default location for installing the SDK when you run the SDK's 7616 installation script. You can override the offered path when you run 7617 the script. 7618 7619 :term:`SDKTARGETSYSROOT` 7620 The full path to the sysroot used for cross-compilation within an SDK 7621 as it will be when installed into the default 7622 :term:`SDKPATHINSTALL`. 7623 7624 :term:`SECTION` 7625 The section in which packages should be categorized. Package 7626 management utilities can make use of this variable. 7627 7628 :term:`SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION` 7629 Specifies the optimization flags passed to the C compiler when 7630 building for the target. The flags are passed through the default 7631 value of the :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` variable. 7632 7633 The :term:`SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION` variable takes the value of 7634 :term:`FULL_OPTIMIZATION` unless :term:`DEBUG_BUILD` = "1", in which 7635 case the value of :term:`DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION` is used. 7636 7637 :term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES` 7638 Defines a serial console (TTY) to enable using 7639 :wikipedia:`getty <Getty_(Unix)>`. Provide a value that specifies the 7640 baud rate followed by the TTY device name separated by a semicolon. 7641 Use spaces to separate multiple devices:: 7642 7643 SERIAL_CONSOLES = "115200;ttyS0 115200;ttyS1" 7644 7645 :term:`SETUPTOOLS_BUILD_ARGS` 7646 When used by recipes that inherit the :ref:`ref-classes-setuptools3` 7647 class, this variable can be used to specify additional arguments to be 7648 passed to ``setup.py build`` in the ``setuptools3_do_compile()`` task. 7649 7650 :term:`SETUPTOOLS_INSTALL_ARGS` 7651 When used by recipes that inherit the :ref:`ref-classes-setuptools3` 7652 class, this variable can be used to specify additional arguments to be 7653 passed to ``setup.py install`` in the ``setuptools3_do_install()`` task. 7654 7655 :term:`SETUPTOOLS_SETUP_PATH` 7656 When used by recipes that inherit the :ref:`ref-classes-setuptools3` 7657 class, this variable should be used to specify the directory in which 7658 the ``setup.py`` file is located if it is not at the root of the source 7659 tree (as specified by :term:`S`). For example, in a recipe where the 7660 sources are fetched from a Git repository and ``setup.py`` is in a 7661 ``python/pythonmodule`` subdirectory, you would have this:: 7662 7663 S = "${WORKDIR}/git" 7664 SETUPTOOLS_SETUP_PATH = "${S}/python/pythonmodule" 7665 7666 :term:`SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS` 7667 A list of recipe dependencies that should not be used to determine 7668 signatures of tasks from one recipe when they depend on tasks from 7669 another recipe. For example:: 7670 7671 SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS += "intone->mplayer2" 7672 7673 In the previous example, ``intone`` depends on ``mplayer2``. 7674 7675 You can use the special token ``"*"`` on the left-hand side of the 7676 dependency to match all recipes except the one on the right-hand 7677 side. Here is an example:: 7678 7679 SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS += "*->quilt-native" 7680 7681 In the previous example, all recipes except ``quilt-native`` ignore 7682 task signatures from the ``quilt-native`` recipe when determining 7683 their task signatures. 7684 7685 Use of this variable is one mechanism to remove dependencies that 7686 affect task signatures and thus force rebuilds when a recipe changes. 7687 7688 .. note:: 7689 7690 If you add an inappropriate dependency for a recipe relationship, 7691 the software might break during runtime if the interface of the 7692 second recipe was changed after the first recipe had been built. 7693 7694 :term:`SIGGEN_EXCLUDERECIPES_ABISAFE` 7695 A list of recipes that are completely stable and will never change. 7696 The ABI for the recipes in the list are presented by output from the 7697 tasks run to build the recipe. Use of this variable is one way to 7698 remove dependencies from one recipe on another that affect task 7699 signatures and thus force rebuilds when the recipe changes. 7700 7701 .. note:: 7702 7703 If you add an inappropriate variable to this list, the software 7704 might break at runtime if the interface of the recipe was changed 7705 after the other had been built. 7706 7707 :term:`SITEINFO_BITS` 7708 Specifies the number of bits for the target system CPU. The value 7709 should be either "32" or "64". 7710 7711 :term:`SITEINFO_ENDIANNESS` 7712 Specifies the endian byte order of the target system. The value 7713 should be either "le" for little-endian or "be" for big-endian. 7714 7715 :term:`SKIP_FILEDEPS` 7716 Enables removal of all files from the "Provides" section of an RPM 7717 package. Removal of these files is required for packages containing 7718 prebuilt binaries and libraries such as ``libstdc++`` and ``glibc``. 7719 7720 To enable file removal, set the variable to "1" in your 7721 ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file in your: 7722 :term:`Build Directory`:: 7723 7724 SKIP_FILEDEPS = "1" 7725 7726 :term:`SKIP_RECIPE` 7727 Used to prevent the OpenEmbedded build system from building a given 7728 recipe. Specify the :term:`PN` value as a variable flag (``varflag``) 7729 and provide a reason, which will be reported when attempting to 7730 build the recipe. 7731 7732 To prevent a recipe from being built, use the :term:`SKIP_RECIPE` 7733 variable in your ``local.conf`` file or distribution configuration. 7734 Here is an example which prevents ``myrecipe`` from being built:: 7735 7736 SKIP_RECIPE[myrecipe] = "Not supported by our organization." 7737 7738 :term:`SOC_FAMILY` 7739 A colon-separated list grouping together machines based upon the same 7740 family of SoC (System On Chip). You typically set this variable in a 7741 common ``.inc`` file that you include in the configuration files of all 7742 the machines. 7743 7744 .. note:: 7745 7746 You must include ``conf/machine/include/soc-family.inc`` for this 7747 variable to appear in :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES`. 7748 7749 :term:`SOLIBS` 7750 Defines the suffix for shared libraries used on the target platform. 7751 By default, this suffix is ".so.*" for all Linux-based systems and is 7752 defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. 7753 7754 You will see this variable referenced in the default values of 7755 ``FILES:${PN}``. 7756 7757 :term:`SOLIBSDEV` 7758 Defines the suffix for the development symbolic link (symlink) for 7759 shared libraries on the target platform. By default, this suffix is 7760 ".so" for Linux-based systems and is defined in the 7761 ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. 7762 7763 You will see this variable referenced in the default values of 7764 ``FILES:${PN}-dev``. 7765 7766 :term:`SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH` 7767 This defines a date expressed in number of seconds since 7768 the UNIX EPOCH (01 Jan 1970 00:00:00 UTC), which is used by 7769 multiple build systems to force a timestamp in built binaries. 7770 Many upstream projects already support this variable. 7771 7772 You will find more details in the `official specifications 7773 <https://reproducible-builds.org/specs/source-date-epoch/>`__. 7774 7775 A value for each recipe is computed from the sources by 7776 :oe_git:`meta/lib/oe/reproducible.py </openembedded-core/tree/meta/lib/oe/reproducible.py>`. 7777 7778 If a recipe wishes to override the default behavior, it should set its 7779 own :term:`SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH` value:: 7780 7781 SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH = "1613559011" 7782 7783 :term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH` 7784 When you are fetching files to create a mirror of sources (i.e. 7785 creating a source mirror), setting :term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH` to "1" in 7786 your ``local.conf`` configuration file ensures the source for all 7787 recipes are fetched regardless of whether or not a recipe is 7788 compatible with the configuration. A recipe is considered 7789 incompatible with the currently configured machine when either or 7790 both the :term:`COMPATIBLE_MACHINE` 7791 variable and :term:`COMPATIBLE_HOST` variables 7792 specify compatibility with a machine other than that of the current 7793 machine or host. 7794 7795 .. note:: 7796 7797 Do not set the :term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH` 7798 variable unless you are creating a source mirror. In other words, 7799 do not set the variable during a normal build. 7800 7801 :term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_URL` 7802 Defines your own :term:`PREMIRRORS` from which to 7803 first fetch source before attempting to fetch from the upstream 7804 specified in :term:`SRC_URI`. 7805 7806 To use this variable, you must globally inherit the 7807 :ref:`ref-classes-own-mirrors` class and then provide 7808 the URL to your mirrors. Here is the general syntax:: 7809 7810 INHERIT += "own-mirrors" 7811 SOURCE_MIRROR_URL = "http://example.com/my_source_mirror" 7812 7813 .. note:: 7814 7815 You can specify only a single URL in :term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_URL`. 7816 7817 :term:`SPDX_ARCHIVE_PACKAGED` 7818 This option allows to add to :term:`SPDX` output compressed archives 7819 of the files in the generated target packages. 7820 7821 Such archives are available in 7822 ``tmp/deploy/spdx/MACHINE/packages/packagename.tar.zst`` 7823 under the :term:`Build Directory`. 7824 7825 Enable this option as follows:: 7826 7827 SPDX_ARCHIVE_PACKAGED = "1" 7828 7829 According to our tests on release 4.1 "langdale", building 7830 ``core-image-minimal`` for the ``qemux86-64`` machine, enabling this 7831 option multiplied the size of the ``tmp/deploy/spdx`` directory by a 7832 factor of 13 (+1.6 GiB for this image), compared to just using the 7833 :ref:`ref-classes-create-spdx` class with no option. 7834 7835 Note that this option doesn't increase the size of :term:`SPDX` 7836 files in ``tmp/deploy/images/MACHINE``. 7837 7838 :term:`SPDX_ARCHIVE_SOURCES` 7839 This option allows to add to :term:`SPDX` output compressed archives 7840 of the sources for packages installed on the target. It currently 7841 only works when :term:`SPDX_INCLUDE_SOURCES` is set. 7842 7843 This is one way of fulfilling "source code access" license 7844 requirements. 7845 7846 Such source archives are available in 7847 ``tmp/deploy/spdx/MACHINE/recipes/recipe-packagename.tar.zst`` 7848 under the :term:`Build Directory`. 7849 7850 Enable this option as follows:: 7851 7852 SPDX_INCLUDE_SOURCES = "1" 7853 SPDX_ARCHIVE_SOURCES = "1" 7854 7855 According to our tests on release 4.1 "langdale", building 7856 ``core-image-minimal`` for the ``qemux86-64`` machine, enabling 7857 these options multiplied the size of the ``tmp/deploy/spdx`` 7858 directory by a factor of 11 (+1.4 GiB for this image), 7859 compared to just using the :ref:`ref-classes-create-spdx` 7860 class with no option. 7861 7862 Note that using this option only marginally increases the size 7863 of the :term:`SPDX` output in ``tmp/deploy/images/MACHINE/`` 7864 (+ 0.07\% with the tested image), compared to just enabling 7865 :term:`SPDX_INCLUDE_SOURCES`. 7866 7867 :term:`SPDX_CUSTOM_ANNOTATION_VARS` 7868 This option allows to associate `SPDX annotations 7869 <https://spdx.github.io/spdx-spec/v2.3/annotations/>`__ to a recipe, 7870 using the values of variables in the recipe:: 7871 7872 ANNOTATION1 = "First annotation for recipe" 7873 ANNOTATION2 = "Second annotation for recipe" 7874 SPDX_CUSTOM_ANNOTATION_VARS = "ANNOTATION1 ANNOTATION2" 7875 7876 This will add a new block to the recipe ``.sdpx.json`` output:: 7877 7878 "annotations": [ 7879 { 7880 "annotationDate": "2023-04-18T08:32:12Z", 7881 "annotationType": "OTHER", 7882 "annotator": "Tool: oe-spdx-creator - 1.0", 7883 "comment": "ANNOTATION1=First annotation for recipe" 7884 }, 7885 { 7886 "annotationDate": "2023-04-18T08:32:12Z", 7887 "annotationType": "OTHER", 7888 "annotator": "Tool: oe-spdx-creator - 1.0", 7889 "comment": "ANNOTATION2=Second annotation for recipe" 7890 } 7891 ], 7892 7893 :term:`SPDX_INCLUDE_SOURCES` 7894 This option allows to add a description of the source files used to build 7895 the host tools and the target packages, to the ``spdx.json`` files in 7896 ``tmp/deploy/spdx/MACHINE/recipes/`` under the :term:`Build Directory`. 7897 As a consequence, the ``spdx.json`` files under the ``by-namespace`` and 7898 ``packages`` subdirectories in ``tmp/deploy/spdx/MACHINE`` are also 7899 modified to include references to such source file descriptions. 7900 7901 Enable this option as follows:: 7902 7903 SPDX_INCLUDE_SOURCES = "1" 7904 7905 According to our tests on release 4.1 "langdale", building 7906 ``core-image-minimal`` for the ``qemux86-64`` machine, enabling 7907 this option multiplied the total size of the ``tmp/deploy/spdx`` 7908 directory by a factor of 3 (+291 MiB for this image), 7909 and the size of the ``IMAGE-MACHINE.spdx.tar.zst`` in 7910 ``tmp/deploy/images/MACHINE`` by a factor of 130 (+15 MiB for this 7911 image), compared to just using the :ref:`ref-classes-create-spdx` class 7912 with no option. 7913 7914 :term:`SPDX_PRETTY` 7915 This option makes the SPDX output more human-readable, using 7916 identation and newlines, instead of the default output in a 7917 single line:: 7918 7919 SPDX_PRETTY = "1" 7920 7921 The generated SPDX files are approximately 20% bigger, but 7922 this option is recommended if you want to inspect the SPDX 7923 output files with a text editor. 7924 7925 :term:`SPDXLICENSEMAP` 7926 Maps commonly used license names to their SPDX counterparts found in 7927 ``meta/files/common-licenses/``. For the default :term:`SPDXLICENSEMAP` 7928 mappings, see the ``meta/conf/licenses.conf`` file. 7929 7930 For additional information, see the :term:`LICENSE` 7931 variable. 7932 7933 :term:`SPECIAL_PKGSUFFIX` 7934 A list of prefixes for :term:`PN` used by the OpenEmbedded 7935 build system to create variants of recipes or packages. The list 7936 specifies the prefixes to strip off during certain circumstances such 7937 as the generation of the :term:`BPN` variable. 7938 7939 :term:`SPL_BINARY` 7940 The file type for the Secondary Program Loader (SPL). Some devices 7941 use an SPL from which to boot (e.g. the BeagleBone development 7942 board). For such cases, you can declare the file type of the SPL 7943 binary in the ``u-boot.inc`` include file, which is used in the 7944 U-Boot recipe. 7945 7946 The SPL file type is set to "null" by default in the ``u-boot.inc`` 7947 file as follows:: 7948 7949 # Some versions of u-boot build an SPL (Second Program Loader) image that 7950 # should be packaged along with the u-boot binary as well as placed in the 7951 # deploy directory. For those versions they can set the following variables 7952 # to allow packaging the SPL. 7953 SPL_BINARY ?= "" 7954 SPL_BINARYNAME ?= "${@os.path.basename(d.getVar("SPL_BINARY"))}" 7955 SPL_IMAGE ?= "${SPL_BINARYNAME}-${MACHINE}-${PV}-${PR}" 7956 SPL_SYMLINK ?= "${SPL_BINARYNAME}-${MACHINE}" 7957 7958 The :term:`SPL_BINARY` variable helps form 7959 various ``SPL_*`` variables used by the OpenEmbedded build system. 7960 7961 See the BeagleBone machine configuration example in the 7962 ":ref:`dev-manual/layers:adding a layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script`" 7963 section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package Developer's Guide 7964 for additional information. 7965 7966 :term:`SPL_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS` 7967 Options for the device tree compiler passed to ``mkimage -D`` feature 7968 while creating a FIT image with the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` 7969 class. If :term:`SPL_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS` is not set then the 7970 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class will not pass the ``-D`` option 7971 to ``mkimage``. 7972 7973 The default value is set to "" by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-config` 7974 class. 7975 7976 :term:`SPL_SIGN_ENABLE` 7977 Enable signing of the U-Boot FIT image. The default value is "0". 7978 This variable is used by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class. 7979 7980 :term:`SPL_SIGN_KEYDIR` 7981 Location of the directory containing the RSA key and certificate used for 7982 signing the U-Boot FIT image, used by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` 7983 class. 7984 7985 :term:`SPL_SIGN_KEYNAME` 7986 The name of keys used by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class 7987 for signing U-Boot FIT image stored in the :term:`SPL_SIGN_KEYDIR` 7988 directory. If we have for example a ``dev.key`` key and a ``dev.crt`` 7989 certificate stored in the :term:`SPL_SIGN_KEYDIR` directory, you will 7990 have to set :term:`SPL_SIGN_KEYNAME` to ``dev``. 7991 7992 :term:`SPLASH` 7993 This variable, used by the :ref:`ref-classes-image` class, allows 7994 to choose splashscreen applications. Set it to the names of packages 7995 for such applications to use. This variable is set by default to 7996 ``psplash``. 7997 7998 :term:`SPLASH_IMAGES` 7999 This variable, used by the ``psplash`` recipe, allows to customize 8000 the default splashscreen image. 8001 8002 Specified images in PNG format are converted to ``.h`` files by the recipe, 8003 and are included in the ``psplash`` binary, so you won't find them in 8004 the root filesystem. 8005 8006 To make such a change, it is recommended to customize the 8007 ``psplash`` recipe in a custom layer. Here is an example structure for 8008 an ``ACME`` board:: 8009 8010 meta-acme/recipes-core/psplash 8011 ├── files 8012 │ └── logo-acme.png 8013 └── psplash_%.bbappend 8014 8015 And here are the contents of the ``psplash_%.bbappend`` file in 8016 this example:: 8017 8018 SPLASH_IMAGES = "file://logo-acme.png;outsuffix=default" 8019 FILESEXTRAPATHS:prepend := "${THISDIR}/files:" 8020 8021 You could even add specific configuration options for ``psplash``, 8022 for example:: 8023 8024 EXTRA_OECONF += "--disable-startup-msg --enable-img-fullscreen" 8025 8026 For information on append files, see the 8027 ":ref:`dev-manual/layers:appending other layers metadata with your layer`" 8028 section. 8029 8030 :term:`SRCREV_FORMAT` 8031 See :term:`bitbake:SRCREV_FORMAT` in the BitBake manual. 8032 8033 :term:`SRC_URI` 8034 8035 See the BitBake manual for the initial description for this variable: 8036 :term:`bitbake:SRC_URI`. 8037 8038 The following features are added by OpenEmbedded and the Yocto Project. 8039 8040 There are standard and recipe-specific options. Here are standard ones: 8041 8042 - ``apply`` --- whether to apply the patch or not. The default 8043 action is to apply the patch. 8044 8045 - ``striplevel`` --- which striplevel to use when applying the 8046 patch. The default level is 1. 8047 8048 - ``patchdir`` --- specifies the directory in which the patch should 8049 be applied. The default is ``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``. 8050 8051 Here are options specific to recipes building code from a revision 8052 control system: 8053 8054 - ``mindate`` --- apply the patch only if 8055 :term:`SRCDATE` is equal to or greater than 8056 ``mindate``. 8057 8058 - ``maxdate`` --- apply the patch only if :term:`SRCDATE` is not later 8059 than ``maxdate``. 8060 8061 - ``minrev`` --- apply the patch only if :term:`SRCREV` is equal to or 8062 greater than ``minrev``. 8063 8064 - ``maxrev`` --- apply the patch only if :term:`SRCREV` is not later 8065 than ``maxrev``. 8066 8067 - ``rev`` --- apply the patch only if :term:`SRCREV` is equal to 8068 ``rev``. 8069 8070 - ``notrev`` --- apply the patch only if :term:`SRCREV` is not equal to 8071 ``rev``. 8072 8073 .. note:: 8074 8075 If you want the build system to pick up files specified through 8076 a :term:`SRC_URI` statement from your append file, you need to be 8077 sure to extend the :term:`FILESPATH` variable by also using the 8078 :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` variable from within your append file. 8079 8080 :term:`SRC_URI_OVERRIDES_PACKAGE_ARCH` 8081 By default, the OpenEmbedded build system automatically detects 8082 whether :term:`SRC_URI` contains files that are machine-specific. If so, 8083 the build system automatically changes :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH`. Setting this 8084 variable to "0" disables this behavior. 8085 8086 :term:`SRCDATE` 8087 The date of the source code used to build the package. This variable 8088 applies only if the source was fetched from a Source Code Manager 8089 (SCM). 8090 8091 :term:`SRCPV` 8092 Returns the version string of the current package. This string is 8093 used to help define the value of :term:`PV`. 8094 8095 The :term:`SRCPV` variable is defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` 8096 configuration file in the :term:`Source Directory` as 8097 follows:: 8098 8099 SRCPV = "${@bb.fetch2.get_srcrev(d)}" 8100 8101 Recipes that need to define :term:`PV` do so with the help of the 8102 :term:`SRCPV`. For example, the ``ofono`` recipe (``ofono_git.bb``) 8103 located in ``meta/recipes-connectivity`` in the Source Directory 8104 defines :term:`PV` as follows:: 8105 8106 PV = "0.12-git${SRCPV}" 8107 8108 :term:`SRCREV` 8109 The revision of the source code used to build the package. This 8110 variable applies to Subversion, Git, Mercurial, and Bazaar only. Note 8111 that if you want to build a fixed revision and you want to avoid 8112 performing a query on the remote repository every time BitBake parses 8113 your recipe, you should specify a :term:`SRCREV` that is a full revision 8114 identifier (e.g. the full SHA hash in git) and not just a tag. 8115 8116 .. note:: 8117 8118 For information on limitations when inheriting the latest revision 8119 of software using :term:`SRCREV`, see the :term:`AUTOREV` variable 8120 description and the 8121 ":ref:`dev-manual/packages:automatically incrementing a package version number`" 8122 section, which is in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 8123 8124 :term:`SRCTREECOVEREDTASKS` 8125 A list of tasks that are typically not relevant (and therefore skipped) 8126 when building using the :ref:`ref-classes-externalsrc` 8127 class. The default value as set in that class file is the set of tasks 8128 that are rarely needed when using external source:: 8129 8130 SRCTREECOVEREDTASKS ?= "do_patch do_unpack do_fetch" 8131 8132 The notable exception is when processing external kernel source as 8133 defined in the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-yocto` class file (formatted for 8134 aesthetics):: 8135 8136 SRCTREECOVEREDTASKS += "\ 8137 do_validate_branches \ 8138 do_kernel_configcheck \ 8139 do_kernel_checkout \ 8140 do_fetch \ 8141 do_unpack \ 8142 do_patch \ 8143 " 8144 8145 See the associated :term:`EXTERNALSRC` and :term:`EXTERNALSRC_BUILD` 8146 variables for more information. 8147 8148 :term:`SSTATE_DIR` 8149 The directory for the shared state cache. 8150 8151 :term:`SSTATE_EXCLUDEDEPS_SYSROOT` 8152 This variable allows to specify indirect dependencies to exclude 8153 from sysroots, for example to avoid the situations when a dependency on 8154 any ``-native`` recipe will pull in all dependencies of that recipe 8155 in the recipe sysroot. This behaviour might not always be wanted, 8156 for example when that ``-native`` recipe depends on build tools 8157 that are not relevant for the current recipe. 8158 8159 This way, irrelevant dependencies are ignored, which could have 8160 prevented the reuse of prebuilt artifacts stored in the Shared 8161 State Cache. 8162 8163 :term:`SSTATE_EXCLUDEDEPS_SYSROOT` is evaluated as two regular 8164 expressions of recipe and dependency to ignore. An example 8165 is the rule in :oe_git:`meta/conf/layer.conf </openembedded-core/tree/meta/conf/layer.conf>`:: 8166 8167 # Nothing needs to depend on libc-initial 8168 # base-passwd/shadow-sysroot don't need their dependencies 8169 SSTATE_EXCLUDEDEPS_SYSROOT += "\ 8170 .*->.*-initial.* \ 8171 .*(base-passwd|shadow-sysroot)->.* \ 8172 " 8173 8174 The ``->`` substring represents the dependency between 8175 the two regular expressions. 8176 8177 :term:`SSTATE_MIRROR_ALLOW_NETWORK` 8178 If set to "1", allows fetches from mirrors that are specified in 8179 :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` to work even when 8180 fetching from the network is disabled by setting :term:`BB_NO_NETWORK` to 8181 "1". Using the :term:`SSTATE_MIRROR_ALLOW_NETWORK` variable is useful if 8182 you have set :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` to point to an internal server for 8183 your shared state cache, but you want to disable any other fetching 8184 from the network. 8185 8186 :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` 8187 Configures the OpenEmbedded build system to search other mirror 8188 locations for prebuilt cache data objects before building out the 8189 data. This variable works like fetcher :term:`MIRRORS` 8190 and :term:`PREMIRRORS` and points to the cache 8191 locations to check for the shared state (sstate) objects. 8192 8193 You can specify a filesystem directory or a remote URL such as HTTP 8194 or FTP. The locations you specify need to contain the shared state 8195 cache (sstate-cache) results from previous builds. The sstate-cache 8196 you point to can also be from builds on other machines. 8197 8198 When pointing to sstate build artifacts on another machine that uses 8199 a different GCC version for native builds, you must configure 8200 :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` with a regular expression that maps local search 8201 paths to server paths. The paths need to take into account 8202 :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` set by the :ref:`ref-classes-uninative` class. 8203 For example, the following maps the local search path ``universal-4.9`` 8204 to the server-provided path server_url_sstate_path:: 8205 8206 SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= "file://universal-4.9/(.*) https://server_url_sstate_path/universal-4.8/\1" 8207 8208 If a mirror uses the same structure as 8209 :term:`SSTATE_DIR`, you need to add "PATH" at the 8210 end as shown in the examples below. The build system substitutes the 8211 correct path within the directory structure:: 8212 8213 SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= "\ 8214 file://.* https://someserver.tld/share/sstate/PATH;downloadfilename=PATH \ 8215 file://.* file:///some-local-dir/sstate/PATH" 8216 8217 The Yocto Project actually shares the cache data objects built by its 8218 autobuilder:: 8219 8220 SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= "file://.* http://cdn.jsdelivr.net/yocto/sstate/all/PATH;downloadfilename=PATH" 8221 8222 As such binary artifacts are built for the generic QEMU machines 8223 supported by the various Poky releases, they are less likely to be 8224 reusable in real projects building binaries optimized for a specific 8225 CPU family. 8226 8227 :term:`SSTATE_SCAN_FILES` 8228 Controls the list of files the OpenEmbedded build system scans for 8229 hardcoded installation paths. The variable uses a space-separated 8230 list of filenames (not paths) with standard wildcard characters 8231 allowed. 8232 8233 During a build, the OpenEmbedded build system creates a shared state 8234 (sstate) object during the first stage of preparing the sysroots. 8235 That object is scanned for hardcoded paths for original installation 8236 locations. The list of files that are scanned for paths is controlled 8237 by the :term:`SSTATE_SCAN_FILES` variable. Typically, recipes add files 8238 they want to be scanned to the value of :term:`SSTATE_SCAN_FILES` rather 8239 than the variable being comprehensively set. The 8240 :ref:`ref-classes-sstate` class specifies the default list of files. 8241 8242 For details on the process, see the :ref:`ref-classes-staging` class. 8243 8244 :term:`STAGING_BASE_LIBDIR_NATIVE` 8245 Specifies the path to the ``/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8246 directory for the build host. 8247 8248 :term:`STAGING_BASELIBDIR` 8249 Specifies the path to the ``/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8250 directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built 8251 (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). 8252 8253 :term:`STAGING_BINDIR` 8254 Specifies the path to the ``/usr/bin`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8255 directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built 8256 (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). 8257 8258 :term:`STAGING_BINDIR_CROSS` 8259 Specifies the path to the directory containing binary configuration 8260 scripts. These scripts provide configuration information for other 8261 software that wants to make use of libraries or include files 8262 provided by the software associated with the script. 8263 8264 .. note:: 8265 8266 This style of build configuration has been largely replaced by 8267 ``pkg-config``. Consequently, if ``pkg-config`` is supported by the 8268 library to which you are linking, it is recommended you use 8269 ``pkg-config`` instead of a provided configuration script. 8270 8271 :term:`STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE` 8272 Specifies the path to the ``/usr/bin`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8273 directory for the build host. 8274 8275 :term:`STAGING_DATADIR` 8276 Specifies the path to the ``/usr/share`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8277 directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built 8278 (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). 8279 8280 :term:`STAGING_DATADIR_NATIVE` 8281 Specifies the path to the ``/usr/share`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8282 directory for the build host. 8283 8284 :term:`STAGING_DIR` 8285 Helps construct the ``recipe-sysroots`` directory, which is used 8286 during packaging. 8287 8288 For information on how staging for recipe-specific sysroots occurs, 8289 see the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` 8290 task, the ":ref:`sdk-manual/extensible:sharing files between recipes`" 8291 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual, the 8292 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:configuration, compilation, and staging`" 8293 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, and the 8294 :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` variable. 8295 8296 .. note:: 8297 8298 Recipes should never write files directly under the :term:`STAGING_DIR` 8299 directory because the OpenEmbedded build system manages the 8300 directory automatically. Instead, files should be installed to 8301 ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}`` within your recipe's :ref:`ref-tasks-install` 8302 task and then the OpenEmbedded build system will stage a subset of 8303 those files into the sysroot. 8304 8305 :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST` 8306 Specifies the path to the sysroot directory for the system on which 8307 the component is built to run (the system that hosts the component). 8308 For most recipes, this sysroot is the one in which that recipe's 8309 :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task copies 8310 files. Exceptions include ``-native`` recipes, where the 8311 :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task instead uses 8312 :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`. Depending on 8313 the type of recipe and the build target, :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST` can 8314 have the following values: 8315 8316 - For recipes building for the target machine, the value is 8317 "${:term:`STAGING_DIR`}/${:term:`MACHINE`}". 8318 8319 - For native recipes building for the build host, the value is empty 8320 given the assumption that when building for the build host, the 8321 build host's own directories should be used. 8322 8323 .. note:: 8324 8325 ``-native`` recipes are not installed into host paths like such 8326 as ``/usr``. Rather, these recipes are installed into 8327 :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`. When compiling ``-native`` recipes, 8328 standard build environment variables such as 8329 :term:`CPPFLAGS` and 8330 :term:`CFLAGS` are set up so that both host paths 8331 and :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE` are searched for libraries and 8332 headers using, for example, GCC's ``-isystem`` option. 8333 8334 Thus, the emphasis is that the ``STAGING_DIR*`` variables 8335 should be viewed as input variables by tasks such as 8336 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure`, 8337 :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`, and 8338 :ref:`ref-tasks-install`. Having the real system 8339 root correspond to :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST` makes conceptual sense 8340 for ``-native`` recipes, as they make use of host headers and 8341 libraries. 8342 8343 Check :term:`RECIPE_SYSROOT` and :term:`RECIPE_SYSROOT_NATIVE`. 8344 8345 :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE` 8346 Specifies the path to the sysroot directory used when building 8347 components that run on the build host itself. 8348 8349 The default value is ``"${RECIPE_SYSROOT_NATIVE}"``, 8350 check :term:`RECIPE_SYSROOT_NATIVE`. 8351 8352 :term:`STAGING_DIR_TARGET` 8353 Specifies the path to the sysroot used for the system for which the 8354 component generates code. For components that do not generate code, 8355 which is the majority, :term:`STAGING_DIR_TARGET` is set to match 8356 :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`. 8357 8358 Some recipes build binaries that can run on the target system but those 8359 binaries in turn generate code for another different system (e.g. 8360 :ref:`ref-classes-cross-canadian` recipes). Using terminology from GNU, 8361 the primary system is referred to as the "HOST" and the secondary, or 8362 different, system is referred to as the "TARGET". Thus, the binaries 8363 run on the "HOST" system and generate binaries for the "TARGET" 8364 system. The :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST` variable points to the sysroot used 8365 for the "HOST" system, while :term:`STAGING_DIR_TARGET` points to the 8366 sysroot used for the "TARGET" system. 8367 8368 :term:`STAGING_ETCDIR_NATIVE` 8369 Specifies the path to the ``/etc`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8370 directory for the build host. 8371 8372 :term:`STAGING_EXECPREFIXDIR` 8373 Specifies the path to the ``/usr`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8374 directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built 8375 (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). 8376 8377 :term:`STAGING_INCDIR` 8378 Specifies the path to the ``/usr/include`` subdirectory of the 8379 sysroot directory for the target for which the current recipe being 8380 built (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). 8381 8382 :term:`STAGING_INCDIR_NATIVE` 8383 Specifies the path to the ``/usr/include`` subdirectory of the 8384 sysroot directory for the build host. 8385 8386 :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR` 8387 Points to the directory containing the kernel build artifacts. 8388 Recipes building software that needs to access kernel build artifacts 8389 (e.g. ``systemtap-uprobes``) can look in the directory specified with 8390 the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR` variable to find these artifacts 8391 after the kernel has been built. 8392 8393 :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` 8394 The directory with kernel headers that are required to build 8395 out-of-tree modules. 8396 8397 :term:`STAGING_LIBDIR` 8398 Specifies the path to the ``/usr/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8399 directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built 8400 (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). 8401 8402 :term:`STAGING_LIBDIR_NATIVE` 8403 Specifies the path to the ``/usr/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot 8404 directory for the build host. 8405 8406 :term:`STAMP` 8407 Specifies the base path used to create recipe stamp files. The path 8408 to an actual stamp file is constructed by evaluating this string and 8409 then appending additional information. Currently, the default 8410 assignment for :term:`STAMP` as set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` 8411 file is:: 8412 8413 STAMP = "${STAMPS_DIR}/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR}" 8414 8415 For information on how BitBake uses stamp files to determine if a 8416 task should be rerun, see the 8417 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:stamp files and the rerunning of tasks`" 8418 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. 8419 8420 See :term:`STAMPS_DIR`, 8421 :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`, 8422 :term:`PN`, :term:`EXTENDPE`, 8423 :term:`PV`, and :term:`PR` for related variable 8424 information. 8425 8426 :term:`STAMPCLEAN` 8427 See :term:`bitbake:STAMPCLEAN` in the BitBake manual. 8428 8429 :term:`STAMPS_DIR` 8430 Specifies the base directory in which the OpenEmbedded build system 8431 places stamps. The default directory is ``${TMPDIR}/stamps``. 8432 8433 :term:`STRIP` 8434 The minimal command and arguments to run ``strip``, which is used to 8435 strip symbols. 8436 8437 :term:`SUMMARY` 8438 The short (72 characters or less) summary of the binary package for 8439 packaging systems such as ``opkg``, ``rpm``, or ``dpkg``. By default, 8440 :term:`SUMMARY` is used to define the 8441 :term:`DESCRIPTION` variable if :term:`DESCRIPTION` is 8442 not set in the recipe. 8443 8444 :term:`SVNDIR` 8445 The directory in which files checked out of a Subversion system are 8446 stored. 8447 8448 :term:`SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE` 8449 Specifies the kernel boot default console. If you want to use a 8450 console other than the default, set this variable in your recipe as 8451 follows where "X" is the console number you want to use:: 8452 8453 SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE = "console=ttyX" 8454 8455 The :ref:`ref-classes-syslinux` class initially sets 8456 this variable to null but then checks for a value later. 8457 8458 :term:`SYSLINUX_OPTS` 8459 Lists additional options to add to the syslinux file. You need to set 8460 this variable in your recipe. If you want to list multiple options, 8461 separate the options with a semicolon character (``;``). 8462 8463 The :ref:`ref-classes-syslinux` class uses this variable 8464 to create a set of options. 8465 8466 :term:`SYSLINUX_SERIAL` 8467 Specifies the alternate serial port or turns it off. To turn off 8468 serial, set this variable to an empty string in your recipe. The 8469 variable's default value is set in the 8470 :ref:`ref-classes-syslinux` class as follows:: 8471 8472 SYSLINUX_SERIAL ?= "0 115200" 8473 8474 The class checks for and uses the variable as needed. 8475 8476 :term:`SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY` 8477 Specifies the alternate console=tty... kernel boot argument. The 8478 variable's default value is set in the :ref:`ref-classes-syslinux` 8479 class as follows:: 8480 8481 SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY ?= "console=ttyS0,115200" 8482 8483 The class checks for and uses the variable as needed. 8484 8485 :term:`SYSLINUX_SPLASH` 8486 An ``.LSS`` file used as the background for the VGA boot menu when 8487 you use the boot menu. You need to set this variable in your recipe. 8488 8489 The :ref:`ref-classes-syslinux` class checks for this 8490 variable and if found, the OpenEmbedded build system installs the 8491 splash screen. 8492 8493 :term:`SYSROOT_DESTDIR` 8494 Points to the temporary directory under the work directory (default 8495 "``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/sysroot-destdir``") 8496 where the files populated into the sysroot are assembled during the 8497 :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. 8498 8499 :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` 8500 Directories that are staged into the sysroot by the 8501 :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. By 8502 default, the following directories are staged:: 8503 8504 SYSROOT_DIRS = " \ 8505 ${includedir} \ 8506 ${libdir} \ 8507 ${base_libdir} \ 8508 ${nonarch_base_libdir} \ 8509 ${datadir} \ 8510 /sysroot-only \ 8511 " 8512 8513 :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS_IGNORE` 8514 Directories that are not staged into the sysroot by the 8515 :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. You 8516 can use this variable to exclude certain subdirectories of 8517 directories listed in :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` from 8518 staging. By default, the following directories are not staged:: 8519 8520 SYSROOT_DIRS_IGNORE = " \ 8521 ${mandir} \ 8522 ${docdir} \ 8523 ${infodir} \ 8524 ${datadir}/X11/locale \ 8525 ${datadir}/applications \ 8526 ${datadir}/bash-completion \ 8527 ${datadir}/fonts \ 8528 ${datadir}/gtk-doc/html \ 8529 ${datadir}/installed-tests \ 8530 ${datadir}/locale \ 8531 ${datadir}/pixmaps \ 8532 ${datadir}/terminfo \ 8533 ${libdir}/${BPN}/ptest \ 8534 " 8535 8536 Consider the following example in which you need to manipulate this variable. 8537 Assume you have a recipe ``A`` that provides a shared library ``.so.*`` that is 8538 installed into a custom folder other than "``${libdir}``" 8539 or "``${base_libdir}``", let's say "``/opt/lib``". 8540 8541 .. note:: 8542 8543 This is not a recommended way to deal with shared libraries, but this 8544 is just to show the usefulness of setting :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`. 8545 8546 When a recipe ``B`` :term:`DEPENDS` on ``A``, it means what is in 8547 :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` will be copied from :term:`D` of the recipe ``B`` 8548 into ``B``'s :term:`SYSROOT_DESTDIR` that is "``${WORKDIR}/sysroot-destdir``". 8549 8550 Now, since ``/opt/lib`` is not in :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`, it will never be copied to 8551 ``A``'s :term:`RECIPE_SYSROOT`, which is "``${WORKDIR}/recipe-sysroot``". So, 8552 the linking process will fail. 8553 8554 To fix this, you need to add ``/opt/lib`` to :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`:: 8555 8556 SYSROOT_DIRS:append = " /opt/lib" 8557 8558 .. note:: 8559 Even after setting ``/opt/lib`` to :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`, the linking process will still fail 8560 because the linker does not know that location, since :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` 8561 doesn't contain it (if your recipe is for the target). Therefore, so you should add:: 8562 8563 TARGET_LDFLAGS:append = " -L${RECIPE_SYSROOT}/opt/lib" 8564 8565 :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE` 8566 Extra directories staged into the sysroot by the 8567 :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task for 8568 ``-native`` recipes, in addition to those specified in 8569 :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`. By default, the following 8570 extra directories are staged:: 8571 8572 SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE = " \ 8573 ${bindir} \ 8574 ${sbindir} \ 8575 ${base_bindir} \ 8576 ${base_sbindir} \ 8577 ${libexecdir} \ 8578 ${sysconfdir} \ 8579 ${localstatedir} \ 8580 " 8581 8582 .. note:: 8583 8584 Programs built by ``-native`` recipes run directly from the sysroot 8585 (:term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`), which is why additional directories 8586 containing program executables and supporting files need to be staged. 8587 8588 :term:`SYSROOT_PREPROCESS_FUNCS` 8589 A list of functions to execute after files are staged into the 8590 sysroot. These functions are usually used to apply additional 8591 processing on the staged files, or to stage additional files. 8592 8593 :term:`SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE` 8594 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-systemd` class, 8595 this variable specifies whether the specified service in 8596 :term:`SYSTEMD_SERVICE` should start 8597 automatically or not. By default, the service is enabled to 8598 automatically start at boot time. The default setting is in the 8599 :ref:`ref-classes-systemd` class as follows:: 8600 8601 SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE ??= "enable" 8602 8603 You can disable the service by setting the variable to "disable". 8604 8605 :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG` 8606 When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to 8607 "systemd-boot", the :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG` variable specifies the 8608 configuration file that should be used. By default, the 8609 :ref:`ref-classes-systemd-boot` class sets the 8610 :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG` as follows:: 8611 8612 SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG ?= "${S}/loader.conf" 8613 8614 For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot 8615 documentation <https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. 8616 8617 :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES` 8618 When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to 8619 "systemd-boot", the :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES` variable specifies a 8620 list of entry files (``*.conf``) to install that contain one boot 8621 entry per file. By default, the :ref:`ref-classes-systemd-boot` class 8622 sets the :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES` as follows:: 8623 8624 SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES ?= "" 8625 8626 For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot 8627 documentation <https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. 8628 8629 :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT` 8630 When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to 8631 "systemd-boot", the :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT` variable specifies the 8632 boot menu timeout in seconds. By default, the 8633 :ref:`ref-classes-systemd-boot` class sets the 8634 :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT` as follows:: 8635 8636 SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT ?= "10" 8637 8638 For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot 8639 documentation <https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. 8640 8641 :term:`SYSTEMD_DEFAULT_TARGET` 8642 8643 This variable allows to set the default unit that systemd starts at bootup. 8644 Usually, this is either ``multi-user.target`` or ``graphical.target``. 8645 This works by creating a ``default.target`` symbolic link to the chosen systemd 8646 target file. 8647 8648 See `systemd's documentation 8649 <https://www.freedesktop.org/software/systemd/man/systemd.special.html>`__ 8650 for details. 8651 8652 For example, this variable is used in the :oe_git:`core-image-minimal-xfce.bb 8653 </meta-openembedded/tree/meta-xfce/recipes-core/images/core-image-minimal-xfce.bb>` 8654 recipe:: 8655 8656 SYSTEMD_DEFAULT_TARGET = "graphical.target" 8657 8658 :term:`SYSTEMD_PACKAGES` 8659 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-systemd` class, 8660 this variable locates the systemd unit files when they are not found 8661 in the main recipe's package. By default, the :term:`SYSTEMD_PACKAGES` 8662 variable is set such that the systemd unit files are assumed to 8663 reside in the recipes main package:: 8664 8665 SYSTEMD_PACKAGES ?= "${PN}" 8666 8667 If these unit files are not in this recipe's main package, you need 8668 to use :term:`SYSTEMD_PACKAGES` to list the package or packages in which 8669 the build system can find the systemd unit files. 8670 8671 :term:`SYSTEMD_SERVICE` 8672 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-systemd` class, 8673 this variable specifies the systemd service name for a package. 8674 8675 Multiple services can be specified, each one separated by a space. 8676 8677 When you specify this file in your recipe, use a package name 8678 override to indicate the package to which the value applies. Here is 8679 an example from the connman recipe:: 8680 8681 SYSTEMD_SERVICE:${PN} = "connman.service" 8682 8683 The package overrides that can be specified are directly related to the value of 8684 :term:`SYSTEMD_PACKAGES`. Overrides not included in :term:`SYSTEMD_PACKAGES` 8685 will be silently ignored. 8686 8687 :term:`SYSVINIT_ENABLED_GETTYS` 8688 When using :ref:`SysVinit <dev-manual/new-recipe:enabling system services>`, 8689 specifies a space-separated list of the virtual terminals that should 8690 run a :wikipedia:`getty <Getty_(Unix)>` (allowing login), assuming 8691 :term:`USE_VT` is not set to "0". 8692 8693 The default value for :term:`SYSVINIT_ENABLED_GETTYS` is "1" (i.e. only 8694 run a getty on the first virtual terminal). 8695 8696 :term:`T` 8697 This variable points to a directory were BitBake places temporary 8698 files, which consist mostly of task logs and scripts, when building a 8699 particular recipe. The variable is typically set as follows:: 8700 8701 T = "${WORKDIR}/temp" 8702 8703 The :term:`WORKDIR` is the directory into which 8704 BitBake unpacks and builds the recipe. The default ``bitbake.conf`` 8705 file sets this variable. 8706 8707 The :term:`T` variable is not to be confused with the 8708 :term:`TMPDIR` variable, which points to the root of 8709 the directory tree where BitBake places the output of an entire 8710 build. 8711 8712 :term:`TARGET_ARCH` 8713 The target machine's architecture. The OpenEmbedded build system 8714 supports many architectures. Here is an example list of architectures 8715 supported. This list is by no means complete as the architecture is 8716 configurable: 8717 8718 - arm 8719 - i586 8720 - x86_64 8721 - powerpc 8722 - powerpc64 8723 - mips 8724 - mipsel 8725 8726 For additional information on machine architectures, see the 8727 :term:`TUNE_ARCH` variable. 8728 8729 :term:`TARGET_AS_ARCH` 8730 Specifies architecture-specific assembler flags for the target 8731 system. :term:`TARGET_AS_ARCH` is initialized from 8732 :term:`TUNE_ASARGS` by default in the BitBake 8733 configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``):: 8734 8735 TARGET_AS_ARCH = "${TUNE_ASARGS}" 8736 8737 :term:`TARGET_CC_ARCH` 8738 Specifies architecture-specific C compiler flags for the target 8739 system. :term:`TARGET_CC_ARCH` is initialized from 8740 :term:`TUNE_CCARGS` by default. 8741 8742 .. note:: 8743 8744 It is a common workaround to append :term:`LDFLAGS` to 8745 :term:`TARGET_CC_ARCH` in recipes that build software for the target that 8746 would not otherwise respect the exported :term:`LDFLAGS` variable. 8747 8748 :term:`TARGET_CC_KERNEL_ARCH` 8749 This is a specific kernel compiler flag for a CPU or Application 8750 Binary Interface (ABI) tune. The flag is used rarely and only for 8751 cases where a userspace :term:`TUNE_CCARGS` is not 8752 compatible with the kernel compilation. The :term:`TARGET_CC_KERNEL_ARCH` 8753 variable allows the kernel (and associated modules) to use a 8754 different configuration. See the 8755 ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/feature-arm-thumb.inc`` file in the 8756 :term:`Source Directory` for an example. 8757 8758 :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` 8759 Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the 8760 target. When building in the target context, 8761 :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by 8762 default. 8763 8764 Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the :term:`CFLAGS` 8765 variable in the environment to the :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` value so that 8766 executables built using the SDK also have the flags applied. 8767 8768 :term:`TARGET_CPPFLAGS` 8769 Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the 8770 C and the C++ compilers) when building for the target. When building 8771 in the target context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` is set to the 8772 value of this variable by default. 8773 8774 Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the 8775 :term:`CPPFLAGS` variable in the environment to the :term:`TARGET_CPPFLAGS` 8776 value so that executables built using the SDK also have the flags 8777 applied. 8778 8779 :term:`TARGET_CXXFLAGS` 8780 Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the 8781 target. When building in the target context, 8782 :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable 8783 by default. 8784 8785 Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the 8786 :term:`CXXFLAGS` variable in the environment to the :term:`TARGET_CXXFLAGS` 8787 value so that executables built using the SDK also have the flags 8788 applied. 8789 8790 :term:`TARGET_FPU` 8791 Specifies the method for handling FPU code. For FPU-less targets, 8792 which include most ARM CPUs, the variable must be set to "soft". If 8793 not, the kernel emulation gets used, which results in a performance 8794 penalty. 8795 8796 :term:`TARGET_LD_ARCH` 8797 Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the target system. 8798 :term:`TARGET_LD_ARCH` is initialized from 8799 :term:`TUNE_LDARGS` by default in the BitBake 8800 configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``):: 8801 8802 TARGET_LD_ARCH = "${TUNE_LDARGS}" 8803 8804 :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` 8805 Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the 8806 target. When building in the target context, 8807 :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable 8808 by default. 8809 8810 Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the 8811 :term:`LDFLAGS` variable in the environment to the 8812 :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` value so that executables built using the SDK also 8813 have the flags applied. 8814 8815 :term:`TARGET_OS` 8816 Specifies the target's operating system. The variable can be set to 8817 "linux" for glibc-based systems (GNU C Library) and to "linux-musl" 8818 for musl libc. For ARM/EABI targets, the possible values are 8819 "linux-gnueabi" and "linux-musleabi". 8820 8821 :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` 8822 Specifies the prefix used for the toolchain binary target tools. 8823 8824 Depending on the type of recipe and the build target, 8825 :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` is set as follows: 8826 8827 - For recipes building for the target machine, the value is 8828 "${:term:`TARGET_SYS`}-". 8829 8830 - For native recipes, the build system sets the variable to the 8831 value of :term:`BUILD_PREFIX`. 8832 8833 - For native SDK recipes (:ref:`ref-classes-nativesdk`), 8834 the build system sets the variable to the value of :term:`SDK_PREFIX`. 8835 8836 :term:`TARGET_SYS` 8837 Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating 8838 system, for which the build is occurring in the context of the 8839 current recipe. 8840 8841 The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based 8842 on :term:`TARGET_ARCH`, 8843 :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`, and 8844 :term:`TARGET_OS` variables. 8845 8846 .. note:: 8847 8848 You do not need to set the :term:`TARGET_SYS` variable yourself. 8849 8850 Consider these two examples: 8851 8852 - Given a native recipe on a 32-bit, x86 machine running Linux, the 8853 value is "i686-linux". 8854 8855 - Given a recipe being built for a little-endian, MIPS target 8856 running Linux, the value might be "mipsel-linux". 8857 8858 :term:`TARGET_VENDOR` 8859 Specifies the name of the target vendor. 8860 8861 :term:`TCLIBC` 8862 Specifies the GNU standard C library (``libc``) variant to use during 8863 the build process. 8864 8865 You can select "glibc", "musl", "newlib", or "baremetal". 8866 8867 :term:`TCLIBCAPPEND` 8868 Specifies a suffix to be appended onto the :term:`TMPDIR` value. The 8869 suffix identifies the ``libc`` variant for building. When you are 8870 building for multiple variants with the same :term:`Build Directory`, 8871 this mechanism ensures that output for different ``libc`` variants is 8872 kept separate to avoid potential conflicts. 8873 8874 In the ``defaultsetup.conf`` file, the default value of 8875 :term:`TCLIBCAPPEND` is "-${TCLIBC}". However, distros such as poky, 8876 which normally only support one ``libc`` variant, set 8877 :term:`TCLIBCAPPEND` to "" in their distro configuration file resulting 8878 in no suffix being applied. 8879 8880 :term:`TCMODE` 8881 Specifies the toolchain selector. :term:`TCMODE` controls the 8882 characteristics of the generated packages and images by telling the 8883 OpenEmbedded build system which toolchain profile to use. By default, 8884 the OpenEmbedded build system builds its own internal toolchain. The 8885 variable's default value is "default", which uses that internal 8886 toolchain. 8887 8888 .. note:: 8889 8890 If :term:`TCMODE` is set to a value other than "default", then it is your 8891 responsibility to ensure that the toolchain is compatible with the 8892 default toolchain. Using older or newer versions of these 8893 components might cause build problems. See 8894 :doc:`Release Information </migration-guides/index>` for your 8895 version of the Yocto Project, to find the specific components with 8896 which the toolchain must be compatible. 8897 8898 The :term:`TCMODE` variable is similar to :term:`TCLIBC`, 8899 which controls the variant of the GNU standard C library (``libc``) 8900 used during the build process: ``glibc`` or ``musl``. 8901 8902 With additional layers, it is possible to use a pre-compiled external 8903 toolchain. One example is the Sourcery G++ Toolchain. The support for 8904 this toolchain resides in the separate Mentor Graphics 8905 ``meta-sourcery`` layer at 8906 https://github.com/MentorEmbedded/meta-sourcery/. 8907 8908 The layer's ``README`` file contains information on how to use the 8909 Sourcery G++ Toolchain as an external toolchain. You will have to 8910 add the layer to your ``bblayers.conf`` file and then set the 8911 :term:`EXTERNAL_TOOLCHAIN` variable in your ``local.conf`` file to 8912 the location of the toolchain. 8913 8914 The fundamentals used for this example apply to any external 8915 toolchain. You can use ``meta-sourcery`` as a template for adding 8916 support for other external toolchains. 8917 8918 In addition to toolchain configuration, you will also need a 8919 corresponding toolchain recipe file. This recipe file needs to package 8920 up any pre-built objects in the toolchain such as ``libgcc``, 8921 ``libstdcc++``, any locales, and ``libc``. 8922 8923 :term:`TC_CXX_RUNTIME` 8924 Specifies the C/C++ STL and runtime variant to use during 8925 the build process. Default value is 'gnu' 8926 8927 You can select "gnu", "llvm", or "android". 8928 8929 :term:`TEMPLATECONF` 8930 Specifies the directory used by the build system to find templates 8931 from which to build the ``bblayers.conf`` and ``local.conf`` files. 8932 Use this variable if you wish to customize such files, and the default 8933 BitBake targets shown when sourcing the ``oe-init-build-env`` script. 8934 8935 For details, see the 8936 :ref:`dev-manual/custom-template-configuration-directory:creating a custom template configuration directory` 8937 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks manual. 8938 8939 .. note:: 8940 8941 You must set this variable in the external environment in order 8942 for it to work. 8943 8944 :term:`TEST_EXPORT_DIR` 8945 The location the OpenEmbedded build system uses to export tests when 8946 the :term:`TEST_EXPORT_ONLY` variable is set 8947 to "1". 8948 8949 The :term:`TEST_EXPORT_DIR` variable defaults to 8950 ``"${TMPDIR}/testimage/${PN}"``. 8951 8952 :term:`TEST_EXPORT_ONLY` 8953 Specifies to export the tests only. Set this variable to "1" if you 8954 do not want to run the tests but you want them to be exported in a 8955 manner that you to run them outside of the build system. 8956 8957 :term:`TEST_LOG_DIR` 8958 Holds the SSH log and the boot log for QEMU machines. The 8959 :term:`TEST_LOG_DIR` variable defaults to ``"${WORKDIR}/testimage"``. 8960 8961 .. note:: 8962 8963 Actual test results reside in the task log (``log.do_testimage``), 8964 which is in the ``${WORKDIR}/temp/`` directory. 8965 8966 :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD` 8967 For automated hardware testing, specifies the command to use to 8968 control the power of the target machine under test. Typically, this 8969 command would point to a script that performs the appropriate action 8970 (e.g. interacting with a web-enabled power strip). The specified 8971 command should expect to receive as the last argument "off", "on" or 8972 "cycle" specifying to power off, on, or cycle (power off and then 8973 power on) the device, respectively. 8974 8975 :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS` 8976 For automated hardware testing, specifies additional arguments to 8977 pass through to the command specified in 8978 :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD`. Setting 8979 :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS` is optional. You can use it if you 8980 wish, for example, to separate the machine-specific and 8981 non-machine-specific parts of the arguments. 8982 8983 :term:`TEST_QEMUBOOT_TIMEOUT` 8984 The time in seconds allowed for an image to boot before automated 8985 runtime tests begin to run against an image. The default timeout 8986 period to allow the boot process to reach the login prompt is 500 8987 seconds. You can specify a different value in the ``local.conf`` 8988 file. 8989 8990 For more information on testing images, see the 8991 ":ref:`dev-manual/runtime-testing:performing automated runtime testing`" 8992 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 8993 8994 :term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD` 8995 For automated hardware testing, specifies the command to use to 8996 connect to the serial console of the target machine under test. This 8997 command simply needs to connect to the serial console and forward 8998 that connection to standard input and output as any normal terminal 8999 program does. 9000 9001 For example, to use the Picocom terminal program on serial device 9002 ``/dev/ttyUSB0`` at 115200bps, you would set the variable as follows:: 9003 9004 TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD = "picocom /dev/ttyUSB0 -b 115200" 9005 9006 :term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS` 9007 For automated hardware testing, specifies additional arguments to 9008 pass through to the command specified in 9009 :term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD`. Setting 9010 :term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS` is optional. You can use it if you 9011 wish, for example, to separate the machine-specific and 9012 non-machine-specific parts of the command. 9013 9014 :term:`TEST_SERVER_IP` 9015 The IP address of the build machine (host machine). This IP address 9016 is usually automatically detected. However, if detection fails, this 9017 variable needs to be set to the IP address of the build machine (i.e. 9018 where the build is taking place). 9019 9020 .. note:: 9021 9022 The :term:`TEST_SERVER_IP` variable is only used for a small number of 9023 tests such as the "dnf" test suite, which needs to download packages 9024 from ``WORKDIR/oe-rootfs-repo``. 9025 9026 :term:`TEST_SUITES` 9027 An ordered list of tests (modules) to run against an image when 9028 performing automated runtime testing. 9029 9030 The OpenEmbedded build system provides a core set of tests that can 9031 be used against images. 9032 9033 .. note:: 9034 9035 Currently, there is only support for running these tests under 9036 QEMU. 9037 9038 Tests include ``ping``, ``ssh``, ``df`` among others. You can add 9039 your own tests to the list of tests by appending :term:`TEST_SUITES` as 9040 follows:: 9041 9042 TEST_SUITES:append = " mytest" 9043 9044 Alternatively, you can 9045 provide the "auto" option to have all applicable tests run against 9046 the image:: 9047 9048 TEST_SUITES:append = " auto" 9049 9050 Using this option causes the 9051 build system to automatically run tests that are applicable to the 9052 image. Tests that are not applicable are skipped. 9053 9054 The order in which tests are run is important. Tests that depend on 9055 another test must appear later in the list than the test on which 9056 they depend. For example, if you append the list of tests with two 9057 tests (``test_A`` and ``test_B``) where ``test_B`` is dependent on 9058 ``test_A``, then you must order the tests as follows:: 9059 9060 TEST_SUITES = "test_A test_B" 9061 9062 For more information on testing images, see the 9063 ":ref:`dev-manual/runtime-testing:performing automated runtime testing`" 9064 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 9065 9066 :term:`TEST_TARGET` 9067 Specifies the target controller to use when running tests against a 9068 test image. The default controller to use is "qemu":: 9069 9070 TEST_TARGET = "qemu" 9071 9072 A target controller is a class that defines how an image gets 9073 deployed on a target and how a target is started. A layer can extend 9074 the controllers by adding a module in the layer's 9075 ``/lib/oeqa/controllers`` directory and by inheriting the 9076 ``BaseTarget`` class, which is an abstract class that cannot be used 9077 as a value of :term:`TEST_TARGET`. 9078 9079 You can provide the following arguments with :term:`TEST_TARGET`: 9080 9081 - *"qemu":* Boots a QEMU image and runs the tests. See the 9082 ":ref:`dev-manual/runtime-testing:enabling runtime tests on qemu`" section 9083 in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more 9084 information. 9085 9086 - *"simpleremote":* Runs the tests on target hardware that is 9087 already up and running. The hardware can be on the network or it 9088 can be a device running an image on QEMU. You must also set 9089 :term:`TEST_TARGET_IP` when you use 9090 "simpleremote". 9091 9092 .. note:: 9093 9094 This argument is defined in 9095 ``meta/lib/oeqa/controllers/simpleremote.py``. 9096 9097 For information on running tests on hardware, see the 9098 ":ref:`dev-manual/runtime-testing:enabling runtime tests on hardware`" 9099 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. 9100 9101 :term:`TEST_TARGET_IP` 9102 The IP address of your hardware under test. The :term:`TEST_TARGET_IP` 9103 variable has no effect when :term:`TEST_TARGET` is 9104 set to "qemu". 9105 9106 When you specify the IP address, you can also include a port. Here is 9107 an example:: 9108 9109 TEST_TARGET_IP = "192.168.1.4:2201" 9110 9111 Specifying a port is 9112 useful when SSH is started on a non-standard port or in cases when 9113 your hardware under test is behind a firewall or network that is not 9114 directly accessible from your host and you need to do port address 9115 translation. 9116 9117 :term:`TESTIMAGE_AUTO` 9118 Automatically runs the series of automated tests for images when an 9119 image is successfully built. Setting :term:`TESTIMAGE_AUTO` to "1" causes 9120 any image that successfully builds to automatically boot under QEMU. 9121 Using the variable also adds in dependencies so that any SDK for 9122 which testing is requested is automatically built first. 9123 9124 These tests are written in Python making use of the ``unittest`` 9125 module, and the majority of them run commands on the target system 9126 over ``ssh``. You can set this variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` 9127 file in the :term:`Build Directory` to have the 9128 OpenEmbedded build system automatically run these tests after an 9129 image successfully builds: 9130 9131 TESTIMAGE_AUTO = "1" 9132 9133 For more information 9134 on enabling, running, and writing these tests, see the 9135 ":ref:`dev-manual/runtime-testing:performing automated runtime testing`" 9136 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual and the 9137 ":ref:`ref-classes-testimage`" section. 9138 9139 :term:`THISDIR` 9140 The directory in which the file BitBake is currently parsing is 9141 located. Do not manually set this variable. 9142 9143 :term:`TIME` 9144 The time the build was started. Times appear using the hour, minute, 9145 and second (HMS) format (e.g. "140159" for one minute and fifty-nine 9146 seconds past 1400 hours). 9147 9148 :term:`TMPDIR` 9149 This variable is the base directory the OpenEmbedded build system 9150 uses for all build output and intermediate files (other than the 9151 shared state cache). By default, the :term:`TMPDIR` variable points to 9152 ``tmp`` within the :term:`Build Directory`. 9153 9154 If you want to establish this directory in a location other than the 9155 default, you can uncomment and edit the following statement in the 9156 ``conf/local.conf`` file in the :term:`Source Directory`:: 9157 9158 #TMPDIR = "${TOPDIR}/tmp" 9159 9160 An example use for this scenario is to set :term:`TMPDIR` to a local disk, 9161 which does not use NFS, while having the :term:`Build Directory` use NFS. 9162 9163 The filesystem used by :term:`TMPDIR` must have standard filesystem 9164 semantics (i.e. mixed-case files are unique, POSIX file locking, and 9165 persistent inodes). Due to various issues with NFS and bugs in some 9166 implementations, NFS does not meet this minimum requirement. 9167 Consequently, :term:`TMPDIR` cannot be on NFS. 9168 9169 :term:`TOOLCHAIN_HOST_TASK` 9170 This variable lists packages the OpenEmbedded build system uses when 9171 building an SDK, which contains a cross-development environment. The 9172 packages specified by this variable are part of the toolchain set 9173 that runs on the :term:`SDKMACHINE`, and each 9174 package should usually have the prefix ``nativesdk-``. For example, 9175 consider the following command when building an SDK:: 9176 9177 $ bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename 9178 9179 In this case, a default list of packages is 9180 set in this variable, but you can add additional packages to the 9181 list. See the 9182 ":ref:`sdk-manual/appendix-customizing-standard:adding individual packages to the standard sdk`" section 9183 in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible 9184 Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual for more information. 9185 9186 For background information on cross-development toolchains in the 9187 Yocto Project development environment, see the 9188 ":ref:`sdk-manual/intro:the cross-development toolchain`" 9189 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For 9190 information on setting up a cross-development environment, see the 9191 :doc:`/sdk-manual/index` manual. 9192 9193 Note that this variable applies to building an SDK, not an eSDK, 9194 in which case the :term:`TOOLCHAIN_HOST_TASK_ESDK` setting should be 9195 used instead. 9196 9197 :term:`TOOLCHAIN_HOST_TASK_ESDK` 9198 This variable allows to extend what is installed in the host 9199 portion of an eSDK. This is similar to :term:`TOOLCHAIN_HOST_TASK` 9200 applying to SDKs. 9201 9202 :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS` 9203 This variable holds extra options passed to the compiler and the linker 9204 for non ``-native`` recipes as they have to point to their custom 9205 ``sysroot`` folder pointed to by :term:`RECIPE_SYSROOT`:: 9206 9207 TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS = " --sysroot=${RECIPE_SYSROOT}" 9208 9209 Native recipes don't need this variable to be set, as they are 9210 built for the host machine with the native compiler. 9211 9212 :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` 9213 This variable defines the name used for the toolchain output. The 9214 :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class sets 9215 the :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variable as follows:: 9216 9217 TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME ?= "${SDK_NAME}-toolchain-${SDK_VERSION}" 9218 9219 See 9220 the :term:`SDK_NAME` and 9221 :term:`SDK_VERSION` variables for additional 9222 information. 9223 9224 :term:`TOOLCHAIN_TARGET_TASK` 9225 This variable lists packages the OpenEmbedded build system uses when 9226 it creates the target part of an SDK (i.e. the part built for the 9227 target hardware), which includes libraries and headers. Use this 9228 variable to add individual packages to the part of the SDK that runs 9229 on the target. See the 9230 ":ref:`sdk-manual/appendix-customizing-standard:adding individual packages to the standard sdk`" section 9231 in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible 9232 Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual for more information. 9233 9234 For background information on cross-development toolchains in the 9235 Yocto Project development environment, see the 9236 ":ref:`sdk-manual/intro:the cross-development toolchain`" 9237 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For 9238 information on setting up a cross-development environment, see the 9239 :doc:`/sdk-manual/index` manual. 9240 9241 :term:`TOPDIR` 9242 See :term:`bitbake:TOPDIR` in the BitBake manual. 9243 9244 :term:`TRANSLATED_TARGET_ARCH` 9245 A sanitized version of :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. This 9246 variable is used where the architecture is needed in a value where 9247 underscores are not allowed, for example within package filenames. In 9248 this case, dash characters replace any underscore characters used in 9249 :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. 9250 9251 Do not edit this variable. 9252 9253 :term:`TUNE_ARCH` 9254 The GNU canonical architecture for a specific architecture (i.e. 9255 ``arm``, ``armeb``, ``mips``, ``mips64``, and so forth). BitBake uses 9256 this value to setup configuration. 9257 9258 :term:`TUNE_ARCH` definitions are specific to a given architecture. The 9259 definitions can be a single static definition, or can be dynamically 9260 adjusted. You can see details for a given CPU family by looking at 9261 the architecture's ``README`` file. For example, the 9262 ``meta/conf/machine/include/mips/README`` file in the 9263 :term:`Source Directory` provides information for 9264 :term:`TUNE_ARCH` specific to the ``mips`` architecture. 9265 9266 :term:`TUNE_ARCH` is tied closely to 9267 :term:`TARGET_ARCH`, which defines the target 9268 machine's architecture. The BitBake configuration file 9269 (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``) sets :term:`TARGET_ARCH` as follows:: 9270 9271 TARGET_ARCH = "${TUNE_ARCH}" 9272 9273 The following list, which is by no means complete since architectures 9274 are configurable, shows supported machine architectures: 9275 9276 - arm 9277 - i586 9278 - x86_64 9279 - powerpc 9280 - powerpc64 9281 - mips 9282 - mipsel 9283 9284 :term:`TUNE_ASARGS` 9285 Specifies architecture-specific assembler flags for the target 9286 system. The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. 9287 :term:`TUNE_ASARGS` is set using the tune include files, which are 9288 typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced 9289 through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. For example, the 9290 ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/arch-x86.inc`` file defines the flags 9291 for the x86 architecture as follows:: 9292 9293 TUNE_ASARGS += "${@bb.utils.contains("TUNE_FEATURES", "mx32", "-x32", "", d)}" 9294 9295 .. note:: 9296 9297 Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, 9298 in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can 9299 supply its own set of flags). 9300 9301 :term:`TUNE_CCARGS` 9302 Specifies architecture-specific C compiler flags for the target 9303 system. The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. 9304 :term:`TUNE_CCARGS` is set using the tune include files, which are 9305 typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced 9306 through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. 9307 9308 .. note:: 9309 9310 Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, 9311 in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can 9312 supply its own set of flags). 9313 9314 :term:`TUNE_FEATURES` 9315 Features used to "tune" a compiler for optimal use given a specific 9316 processor. The features are defined within the tune files and allow 9317 arguments (i.e. ``TUNE_*ARGS``) to be dynamically generated based on 9318 the features. 9319 9320 The OpenEmbedded build system verifies the features to be sure they 9321 are not conflicting and that they are supported. 9322 9323 The BitBake configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``) defines 9324 :term:`TUNE_FEATURES` as follows:: 9325 9326 TUNE_FEATURES ??= "${TUNE_FEATURES:tune-${DEFAULTTUNE}}" 9327 9328 See the :term:`DEFAULTTUNE` variable for more information. 9329 9330 :term:`TUNE_LDARGS` 9331 Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the target system. 9332 The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. 9333 :term:`TUNE_LDARGS` is set using the tune include files, which are 9334 typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced 9335 through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. For example, the 9336 ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/arch-x86.inc`` file defines the flags 9337 for the x86 architecture as follows:: 9338 9339 TUNE_LDARGS += "${@bb.utils.contains("TUNE_FEATURES", "mx32", "-m elf32_x86_64", "", d)}" 9340 9341 .. note:: 9342 9343 Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, 9344 in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can 9345 supply its own set of flags). 9346 9347 :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` 9348 The package architecture understood by the packaging system to define 9349 the architecture, ABI, and tuning of output packages. The specific 9350 tune is defined using the "_tune" override as follows:: 9351 9352 TUNE_PKGARCH:tune-tune = "tune" 9353 9354 These tune-specific package architectures are defined in the machine 9355 include files. Here is an example of the "core2-32" tuning as used in 9356 the ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/tune-core2.inc`` file:: 9357 9358 TUNE_PKGARCH:tune-core2-32 = "core2-32" 9359 9360 :term:`TUNECONFLICTS[feature]` 9361 Specifies CPU or Application Binary Interface (ABI) tuning features 9362 that conflict with feature. 9363 9364 Known tuning conflicts are specified in the machine include files in 9365 the :term:`Source Directory`. Here is an example from 9366 the ``meta/conf/machine/include/mips/arch-mips.inc`` include file 9367 that lists the "o32" and "n64" features as conflicting with the "n32" 9368 feature:: 9369 9370 TUNECONFLICTS[n32] = "o32 n64" 9371 9372 :term:`TUNEVALID[feature]` 9373 Specifies a valid CPU or Application Binary Interface (ABI) tuning 9374 feature. The specified feature is stored as a flag. Valid features 9375 are specified in the machine include files (e.g. 9376 ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/arch-arm.inc``). Here is an example 9377 from that file:: 9378 9379 TUNEVALID[bigendian] = "Enable big-endian mode." 9380 9381 See the machine include files in the :term:`Source Directory` 9382 for these features. 9383 9384 :term:`UBOOT_BINARY` 9385 Specifies the name of the binary build by U-Boot. 9386 9387 :term:`UBOOT_CONFIG` 9388 Configures one or more U-Boot configurations to build. Each 9389 configuration can define the :term:`UBOOT_MACHINE` and optionally the 9390 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` and the :term:`UBOOT_BINARY`. 9391 9392 Here is an example from the ``meta-freescale`` layer. :: 9393 9394 UBOOT_CONFIG ??= "sdcard-ifc-secure-boot sdcard-ifc sdcard-qspi lpuart qspi secure-boot nor" 9395 UBOOT_CONFIG[nor] = "ls1021atwr_nor_defconfig" 9396 UBOOT_CONFIG[sdcard-ifc] = "ls1021atwr_sdcard_ifc_defconfig,,u-boot-with-spl-pbl.bin" 9397 UBOOT_CONFIG[sdcard-qspi] = "ls1021atwr_sdcard_qspi_defconfig,,u-boot-with-spl-pbl.bin" 9398 UBOOT_CONFIG[lpuart] = "ls1021atwr_nor_lpuart_defconfig" 9399 UBOOT_CONFIG[qspi] = "ls1021atwr_qspi_defconfig" 9400 UBOOT_CONFIG[secure-boot] = "ls1021atwr_nor_SECURE_BOOT_defconfig" 9401 UBOOT_CONFIG[sdcard-ifc-secure-boot] = "ls1021atwr_sdcard_ifc_SECURE_BOOT_defconfig,,u-boot-with-spl-pbl.bin" 9402 9403 In this example, all possible seven configurations are selected. Each 9404 configuration specifies "..._defconfig" as :term:`UBOOT_MACHINE`, and 9405 the "sd..." configurations define an individual name for 9406 :term:`UBOOT_BINARY`. No configuration defines a second parameter for 9407 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` to use for the U-Boot image. 9408 9409 For more information on how the :term:`UBOOT_CONFIG` is handled, see the 9410 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-config` class. 9411 9412 :term:`UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS` 9413 Specifies the load address for the dtb image used by U-Boot. During FIT 9414 image creation, the :term:`UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS` variable is used in 9415 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class to specify the load address to be 9416 used in creating the dtb sections of Image Tree Source for the FIT image. 9417 9418 :term:`UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS` 9419 Specifies the load address for the dtbo image used by U-Boot. During FIT 9420 image creation, the :term:`UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS` variable is used in 9421 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class to specify the load address to be 9422 used in creating the dtbo sections of Image Tree Source for the FIT image. 9423 9424 :term:`UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT` 9425 Specifies the entry point for the U-Boot image. During U-Boot image 9426 creation, the :term:`UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT` variable is passed as a 9427 command-line parameter to the ``uboot-mkimage`` utility. 9428 9429 To pass a 64 bit address for FIT image creation, you will need to set: 9430 - The :term:`FIT_ADDRESS_CELLS` variable for FIT image creation. 9431 - The :term:`UBOOT_FIT_ADDRESS_CELLS` variable for U-Boot FIT image creation. 9432 9433 This variable is used by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage`, 9434 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-uimage`, :ref:`ref-classes-kernel`, 9435 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-config` and :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` 9436 classes. 9437 9438 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_ADDRESS_CELLS` 9439 Specifies the value of the ``#address-cells`` value for the 9440 description of the U-Boot FIT image. 9441 9442 The default value is set to "1" by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` 9443 class, which corresponds to 32 bit addresses. 9444 9445 For platforms that need to set 64 bit addresses in 9446 :term:`UBOOT_LOADADDRESS` and :term:`UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT`, you need to 9447 set this value to "2", as two 32 bit values (cells) will be needed 9448 to represent such addresses. 9449 9450 Here is an example setting "0x400000000" as a load address:: 9451 9452 UBOOT_FIT_ADDRESS_CELLS = "2" 9453 UBOOT_LOADADDRESS= "0x04 0x00000000" 9454 9455 See `more details about #address-cells <https://elinux.org/Device_Tree_Usage#How_Addressing_Works>`__. 9456 9457 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_DESC` 9458 Specifies the description string encoded into a U-Boot fitImage. The default 9459 value is set by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class as follows:: 9460 9461 UBOOT_FIT_DESC ?= "U-Boot fitImage for ${DISTRO_NAME}/${PV}/${MACHINE}" 9462 9463 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_GENERATE_KEYS` 9464 Decides whether to generate the keys for signing the U-Boot fitImage if 9465 they don't already exist. The keys are created in :term:`SPL_SIGN_KEYDIR`. 9466 The default value is "0". 9467 9468 Enable this as follows:: 9469 9470 UBOOT_FIT_GENERATE_KEYS = "1" 9471 9472 This variable is used in the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class. 9473 9474 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_HASH_ALG` 9475 Specifies the hash algorithm used in creating the U-Boot FIT Image. 9476 It is set by default to ``sha256`` by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` 9477 class. 9478 9479 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_KEY_GENRSA_ARGS` 9480 Arguments to ``openssl genrsa`` for generating a RSA private key for 9481 signing the U-Boot FIT image. The default value of this variable 9482 is set to "-F4" by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class. 9483 9484 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_KEY_REQ_ARGS` 9485 Arguments to ``openssl req`` for generating a certificate for signing 9486 the U-Boot FIT image. The default value is "-batch -new" by the 9487 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class, "batch" for 9488 non interactive mode and "new" for generating new keys. 9489 9490 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_KEY_SIGN_PKCS` 9491 Format for the public key certificate used for signing the U-Boot FIT 9492 image. The default value is set to "x509" by the 9493 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class. 9494 9495 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_SIGN_ALG` 9496 Specifies the signature algorithm used in creating the U-Boot FIT Image. 9497 This variable is set by default to "rsa2048" by the 9498 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class. 9499 9500 :term:`UBOOT_FIT_SIGN_NUMBITS` 9501 Size of the private key used in signing the U-Boot FIT image, in number 9502 of bits. The default value for this variable is set to "2048" 9503 by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class. 9504 9505 :term:`UBOOT_FITIMAGE_ENABLE` 9506 This variable allows to generate a FIT image for U-Boot, which is one 9507 of the ways to implement a verified boot process. 9508 9509 Its default value is "0", so set it to "1" to enable this functionality:: 9510 9511 UBOOT_FITIMAGE_ENABLE = "1" 9512 9513 See the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class for details. 9514 9515 :term:`UBOOT_LOADADDRESS` 9516 Specifies the load address for the U-Boot image. During U-Boot image 9517 creation, the :term:`UBOOT_LOADADDRESS` variable is passed as a 9518 command-line parameter to the ``uboot-mkimage`` utility. 9519 9520 To pass a 64 bit address, you will also need to set: 9521 9522 - The :term:`FIT_ADDRESS_CELLS` variable for FIT image creation. 9523 - The :term:`UBOOT_FIT_ADDRESS_CELLS` variable for U-Boot FIT image creation. 9524 9525 This variable is used by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage`, 9526 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-uimage`, :ref:`ref-classes-kernel`, 9527 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-config` and :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` 9528 classes. 9529 9530 :term:`UBOOT_LOCALVERSION` 9531 Appends a string to the name of the local version of the U-Boot 9532 image. For example, assuming the version of the U-Boot image built 9533 was "2013.10", the full version string reported by U-Boot would be 9534 "2013.10-yocto" given the following statement:: 9535 9536 UBOOT_LOCALVERSION = "-yocto" 9537 9538 :term:`UBOOT_MACHINE` 9539 Specifies the value passed on the ``make`` command line when building 9540 a U-Boot image. The value indicates the target platform 9541 configuration. You typically set this variable from the machine 9542 configuration file (i.e. ``conf/machine/machine_name.conf``). 9543 9544 Please see the "Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type" 9545 section in the U-Boot README for valid values for this variable. 9546 9547 :term:`UBOOT_MAKE_TARGET` 9548 Specifies the target called in the ``Makefile``. The default target 9549 is "all". 9550 9551 :term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE` 9552 Specifies the name of the mkimage command as used by the 9553 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class to assemble 9554 the FIT image. This can be used to substitute an alternative command, wrapper 9555 script or function if desired. The default is "uboot-mkimage". 9556 9557 :term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS` 9558 Options for the device tree compiler passed to ``mkimage -D`` feature 9559 while creating a FIT image with the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` 9560 class. If :term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS` is not set then the 9561 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class will not pass the ``-D`` option 9562 to ``mkimage``. 9563 9564 This variable is also used by the :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` class. 9565 9566 :term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE_KERNEL_TYPE` 9567 Specifies the type argument for the kernel as passed to ``uboot-mkimage``. 9568 The default value is "kernel". 9569 9570 :term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE_SIGN` 9571 Specifies the name of the mkimage command as used by the 9572 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class to sign 9573 the FIT image after it has been assembled (if enabled). This can be used 9574 to substitute an alternative command, wrapper script or function if 9575 desired. The default is "${:term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE`}". 9576 9577 :term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE_SIGN_ARGS` 9578 Optionally specifies additional arguments for the 9579 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class to pass to the 9580 mkimage command when signing the FIT image. 9581 9582 :term:`UBOOT_RD_ENTRYPOINT` 9583 Specifies the entrypoint for the RAM disk image. During FIT image 9584 creation, the :term:`UBOOT_RD_ENTRYPOINT` variable is used in 9585 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class to specify the entrypoint to be 9586 used in creating the Image Tree Source for the FIT image. 9587 9588 :term:`UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS` 9589 Specifies the load address for the RAM disk image. During FIT image 9590 creation, the :term:`UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS` variable is used in 9591 :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class to specify the load address to 9592 be used in creating the Image Tree Source for the FIT image. 9593 9594 :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_ENABLE` 9595 Enable signing of FIT image. The default value is "0". 9596 9597 This variable is used by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage`, 9598 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-config` and :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` 9599 classes. 9600 9601 :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYDIR` 9602 Location of the directory containing the RSA key and certificate used for 9603 signing FIT image, used by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` and 9604 :ref:`ref-classes-uboot-sign` classes. 9605 9606 :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYNAME` 9607 The name of keys used by the :ref:`ref-classes-kernel-fitimage` class 9608 for signing U-Boot FIT image stored in the :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYDIR` 9609 directory. If we have for example a ``dev.key`` key and a ``dev.crt`` 9610 certificate stored in the :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYDIR` directory, you will 9611 have to set :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYNAME` to ``dev``. 9612 9613 :term:`UBOOT_SUFFIX` 9614 Points to the generated U-Boot extension. For example, ``u-boot.sb`` 9615 has a ``.sb`` extension. 9616 9617 The default U-Boot extension is ``.bin`` 9618 9619 :term:`UBOOT_TARGET` 9620 Specifies the target used for building U-Boot. The target is passed 9621 directly as part of the "make" command (e.g. SPL and AIS). If you do 9622 not specifically set this variable, the OpenEmbedded build process 9623 passes and uses "all" for the target during the U-Boot building 9624 process. 9625 9626 :term:`UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_OPT_IGNORE` 9627 Specifies a list of options that, if reported by the configure script 9628 as being invalid, should not generate a warning during the 9629 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task. Normally, invalid 9630 configure options are simply not passed to the configure script (e.g. 9631 should be removed from :term:`EXTRA_OECONF` or 9632 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`). 9633 However, there are common options that are passed to all 9634 configure scripts at a class level, but might not be valid for some 9635 configure scripts. Therefore warnings about these options are useless. 9636 For these cases, the options are added to :term:`UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_OPT_IGNORE`. 9637 9638 The configure arguments check that uses 9639 :term:`UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_OPT_IGNORE` is part of the 9640 :ref:`ref-classes-insane` class and is only enabled if the 9641 recipe inherits the :ref:`ref-classes-autotools` class. 9642 9643 :term:`UPDATERCPN` 9644 For recipes inheriting the 9645 :ref:`ref-classes-update-rc.d` class, :term:`UPDATERCPN` 9646 specifies the package that contains the initscript that is enabled. 9647 9648 The default value is "${PN}". Given that almost all recipes that 9649 install initscripts package them in the main package for the recipe, 9650 you rarely need to set this variable in individual recipes. 9651 9652 :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_COMMITS` 9653 You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream 9654 source code version is by calling ``devtool latest-version recipe``. If 9655 the recipe source code is provided from Git repositories, but 9656 releases are not identified by Git tags, set :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_COMMITS` 9657 to ``1`` in the recipe, and the OpenEmbedded build system 9658 will compare the latest commit with the one currently specified 9659 by the recipe (:term:`SRCREV`):: 9660 9661 UPSTREAM_CHECK_COMMITS = "1" 9662 9663 :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX` 9664 You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream 9665 source code version is by calling ``devtool latest-version recipe``. If 9666 the recipe source code is provided from Git repositories, the 9667 OpenEmbedded build system determines the latest upstream version by 9668 picking the latest tag from the list of all repository tags. 9669 9670 You can use the :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX` variable to provide a 9671 regular expression to filter only the relevant tags should the 9672 default filter not work correctly:: 9673 9674 UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX = "git_tag_regex" 9675 9676 :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX` 9677 Use the :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX` variable to specify a different 9678 regular expression instead of the default one when the package 9679 checking system is parsing the page found using 9680 :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI`:: 9681 9682 UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX = "package_regex" 9683 9684 :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI` 9685 You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream 9686 source code version is by calling ``devtool latest-version recipe``. If 9687 the source code is provided from tarballs, the latest version is 9688 determined by fetching the directory listing where the tarball is and 9689 attempting to find a later tarball. When this approach does not work, 9690 you can use :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI` to provide a different URI that 9691 contains the link to the latest tarball:: 9692 9693 UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI = "recipe_url" 9694 9695 :term:`UPSTREAM_VERSION_UNKNOWN` 9696 You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream 9697 source code version is by calling ``devtool latest-version recipe``. 9698 If no combination of the :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI`, :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX`, 9699 :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX` and :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_COMMITS` variables in 9700 the recipe allows to determine what the latest upstream version is, 9701 you can set :term:`UPSTREAM_VERSION_UNKNOWN` to ``1`` in the recipe 9702 to acknowledge that the check cannot be performed:: 9703 9704 UPSTREAM_VERSION_UNKNOWN = "1" 9705 9706 :term:`USE_DEVFS` 9707 Determines if ``devtmpfs`` is used for ``/dev`` population. The 9708 default value used for :term:`USE_DEVFS` is "1" when no value is 9709 specifically set. Typically, you would set :term:`USE_DEVFS` to "0" for a 9710 statically populated ``/dev`` directory. 9711 9712 See the ":ref:`dev-manual/device-manager:selecting a device manager`" section in 9713 the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for information on how to 9714 use this variable. 9715 9716 :term:`USE_VT` 9717 When using 9718 :ref:`SysVinit <dev-manual/new-recipe:enabling system services>`, 9719 determines whether or not to run a :wikipedia:`getty <Getty_(Unix)>` 9720 on any virtual terminals in order to enable logging in through those 9721 terminals. 9722 9723 The default value used for :term:`USE_VT` is "1" when no default value is 9724 specifically set. Typically, you would set :term:`USE_VT` to "0" in the 9725 machine configuration file for machines that do not have a graphical 9726 display attached and therefore do not need virtual terminal 9727 functionality. 9728 9729 :term:`USER_CLASSES` 9730 A list of classes to globally inherit. These classes are used by the 9731 OpenEmbedded build system to enable extra features. 9732 9733 Classes inherited using :term:`USER_CLASSES` must be located in the 9734 ``classes-global/`` or ``classes/`` subdirectories. 9735 9736 The default list is set in your ``local.conf`` file:: 9737 9738 USER_CLASSES ?= "buildstats" 9739 9740 For more information, see 9741 ``meta-poky/conf/templates/default/local.conf.sample`` in the 9742 :term:`Source Directory`. 9743 9744 :term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` 9745 If set to ``error``, forces the OpenEmbedded build system to produce 9746 an error if the user identification (``uid``) and group 9747 identification (``gid``) values are not defined in any of the files 9748 listed in :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` and 9749 :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES`. If set to 9750 ``warn``, a warning will be issued instead. 9751 9752 The default behavior for the build system is to dynamically apply 9753 ``uid`` and ``gid`` values. Consequently, the 9754 :term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` variable is by default not set. If you plan 9755 on using statically assigned ``gid`` and ``uid`` values, you should 9756 set the :term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` variable in your ``local.conf`` 9757 file as follows:: 9758 9759 USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC = "error" 9760 9761 Overriding the 9762 default behavior implies you are going to also take steps to set 9763 static ``uid`` and ``gid`` values through use of the 9764 :term:`USERADDEXTENSION`, 9765 :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES`, and 9766 :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` variables. 9767 9768 .. note:: 9769 9770 There is a difference in behavior between setting 9771 :term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` to ``error`` and setting it to ``warn``. 9772 When it is set to ``warn``, the build system will report a warning for 9773 every undefined ``uid`` and ``gid`` in any recipe. But when it is set 9774 to ``error``, it will only report errors for recipes that are actually 9775 built. 9776 This saves you from having to add static IDs for recipes that you 9777 know will never be built. 9778 9779 :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` 9780 Specifies a password file to use for obtaining static group 9781 identification (``gid``) values when the OpenEmbedded build system 9782 adds a group to the system during package installation. 9783 9784 When applying static group identification (``gid``) values, the 9785 OpenEmbedded build system looks in :term:`BBPATH` for a 9786 ``files/group`` file and then applies those ``uid`` values. Set the 9787 variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` file:: 9788 9789 9790 USERADD_GID_TABLES = "files/group" 9791 9792 .. note:: 9793 9794 Setting the :term:`USERADDEXTENSION` variable to "useradd-staticids" 9795 causes the build system to use static ``gid`` values. 9796 9797 :term:`USERADD_PACKAGES` 9798 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-useradd` class, 9799 this variable specifies the individual packages within the recipe 9800 that require users and/or groups to be added. 9801 9802 You must set this variable if the recipe inherits the class. For 9803 example, the following enables adding a user for the main package in 9804 a recipe:: 9805 9806 USERADD_PACKAGES = "${PN}" 9807 9808 .. note:: 9809 9810 It follows that if you are going to use the :term:`USERADD_PACKAGES` 9811 variable, you need to set one or more of the :term:`USERADD_PARAM`, 9812 :term:`GROUPADD_PARAM`, or :term:`GROUPMEMS_PARAM` variables. 9813 9814 :term:`USERADD_PARAM` 9815 When inheriting the :ref:`ref-classes-useradd` class, 9816 this variable specifies for a package what parameters should pass to 9817 the ``useradd`` command if you add a user to the system when the 9818 package is installed. 9819 9820 Here is an example from the ``dbus`` recipe:: 9821 9822 USERADD_PARAM:${PN} = "--system --home ${localstatedir}/lib/dbus \ 9823 --no-create-home --shell /bin/false \ 9824 --user-group messagebus" 9825 9826 For information on the 9827 standard Linux shell command ``useradd``, see 9828 https://linux.die.net/man/8/useradd. 9829 9830 :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` 9831 Specifies a password file to use for obtaining static user 9832 identification (``uid``) values when the OpenEmbedded build system 9833 adds a user to the system during package installation. 9834 9835 When applying static user identification (``uid``) values, the 9836 OpenEmbedded build system looks in :term:`BBPATH` for a 9837 ``files/passwd`` file and then applies those ``uid`` values. Set the 9838 variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` file:: 9839 9840 USERADD_UID_TABLES = "files/passwd" 9841 9842 .. note:: 9843 9844 Setting the :term:`USERADDEXTENSION` variable to "useradd-staticids" 9845 causes the build system to use static ``uid`` values. 9846 9847 :term:`USERADDEXTENSION` 9848 When set to "useradd-staticids", causes the OpenEmbedded build system 9849 to base all user and group additions on a static ``passwd`` and 9850 ``group`` files found in :term:`BBPATH`. 9851 9852 To use static user identification (``uid``) and group identification 9853 (``gid``) values, set the variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` 9854 file: USERADDEXTENSION = "useradd-staticids" 9855 9856 .. note:: 9857 9858 Setting this variable to use static ``uid`` and ``gid`` 9859 values causes the OpenEmbedded build system to employ the 9860 :ref:`ref-classes-useradd` class. 9861 9862 If you use static ``uid`` and ``gid`` information, you must also 9863 specify the ``files/passwd`` and ``files/group`` files by setting the 9864 :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` and 9865 :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` variables. 9866 Additionally, you should also set the 9867 :term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` variable. 9868 9869 :term:`VIRTUAL-RUNTIME` 9870 :term:`VIRTUAL-RUNTIME` is a commonly used prefix for defining virtual 9871 packages for runtime usage, typically for use in :term:`RDEPENDS` 9872 or in image definitions. 9873 9874 An example is ``VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_base-utils`` that makes it possible 9875 to either use BusyBox based utilities:: 9876 9877 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_base-utils = "busybox" 9878 9879 or their full featured implementations from GNU Coreutils 9880 and other projects:: 9881 9882 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_base-utils = "packagegroup-core-base-utils" 9883 9884 Here are two examples using this virtual runtime package. The 9885 first one is in :yocto_git:`initramfs-framework_1.0.bb 9886 </poky/tree/meta/recipes-core/initrdscripts/initramfs-framework_1.0.bb?h=scarthgap>`:: 9887 9888 RDEPENDS:${PN} += "${VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_base-utils}" 9889 9890 The second example is in the :yocto_git:`core-image-initramfs-boot 9891 </poky/tree/meta/recipes-core/images/core-image-initramfs-boot.bb?h=scarthgap>` 9892 image definition:: 9893 9894 PACKAGE_INSTALL = "${INITRAMFS_SCRIPTS} ${VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_base-utils} base-passwd" 9895 9896 :term:`VOLATILE_LOG_DIR` 9897 Specifies the persistence of the target's ``/var/log`` directory, 9898 which is used to house postinstall target log files. 9899 9900 By default, :term:`VOLATILE_LOG_DIR` is set to "yes", which means the 9901 file is not persistent. You can override this setting by setting the 9902 variable to "no" to make the log directory persistent. 9903 9904 :term:`VOLATILE_TMP_DIR` 9905 Specifies the persistence of the target's ``/tmp`` directory. 9906 9907 By default, :term:`VOLATILE_TMP_DIR` is set to "yes", in which case 9908 ``/tmp`` links to a directory which resides in RAM in a ``tmpfs`` 9909 filesystem. 9910 9911 If instead, you want the ``/tmp`` directory to be persistent, set the 9912 variable to "no" to make it a regular directory in the root filesystem. 9913 9914 This supports both sysvinit and systemd based systems. 9915 9916 :term:`WARN_QA` 9917 Specifies the quality assurance checks whose failures are reported as 9918 warnings by the OpenEmbedded build system. You set this variable in 9919 your distribution configuration file. For a list of the checks you 9920 can control with this variable, see the 9921 ":ref:`ref-classes-insane`" section. 9922 9923 :term:`WATCHDOG_TIMEOUT` 9924 Specifies the timeout in seconds used by the ``watchdog`` recipe and 9925 also by ``systemd`` during reboot. The default is 60 seconds. 9926 9927 :term:`WIRELESS_DAEMON` 9928 For ``connman`` and ``packagegroup-base``, specifies the wireless 9929 daemon to use. The default is "wpa-supplicant" (note that the value 9930 uses a dash and not an underscore). 9931 9932 :term:`WKS_FILE` 9933 Specifies the location of the Wic kickstart file that is used by the 9934 OpenEmbedded build system to create a partitioned image 9935 (``image.wic``). For information on how to create a partitioned 9936 image, see the 9937 ":ref:`dev-manual/wic:creating partitioned images using wic`" 9938 section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For details on 9939 the kickstart file format, see the ":doc:`/ref-manual/kickstart`" Chapter. 9940 9941 :term:`WKS_FILE_DEPENDS` 9942 When placed in the recipe that builds your image, this variable lists 9943 build-time dependencies. The :term:`WKS_FILE_DEPENDS` variable is only 9944 applicable when Wic images are active (i.e. when 9945 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` contains entries related 9946 to Wic). If your recipe does not create Wic images, the variable has 9947 no effect. 9948 9949 The :term:`WKS_FILE_DEPENDS` variable is similar to the 9950 :term:`DEPENDS` variable. When you use the variable in 9951 your recipe that builds the Wic image, dependencies you list in the 9952 :term:`WKS_FILE_DEPENDS` variable are added to the :term:`DEPENDS` variable. 9953 9954 With the :term:`WKS_FILE_DEPENDS` variable, you have the possibility to 9955 specify a list of additional dependencies (e.g. native tools, 9956 bootloaders, and so forth), that are required to build Wic images. 9957 Here is an example:: 9958 9959 WKS_FILE_DEPENDS = "some-native-tool" 9960 9961 In the 9962 previous example, some-native-tool would be replaced with an actual 9963 native tool on which the build would depend. 9964 9965 :term:`WKS_FILES` 9966 Specifies a list of candidate Wic kickstart files to be used by the 9967 OpenEmbedded build system to create a partitioned image. Only the 9968 first one that is found, from left to right, will be used. 9969 9970 This is only useful when there are multiple ``.wks`` files that can be 9971 used to produce an image. A typical case is when multiple layers are 9972 used for different hardware platforms, each supplying a different 9973 ``.wks`` file. In this case, you specify all possible ones through 9974 :term:`WKS_FILES`. 9975 9976 If only one ``.wks`` file is used, set :term:`WKS_FILE` instead. 9977 9978 :term:`WORKDIR` 9979 The pathname of the work directory in which the OpenEmbedded build 9980 system builds a recipe. This directory is located within the 9981 :term:`TMPDIR` directory structure and is specific to 9982 the recipe being built and the system for which it is being built. 9983 9984 The :term:`WORKDIR` directory is defined as follows:: 9985 9986 ${TMPDIR}/work/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR} 9987 9988 The actual directory depends on several things: 9989 9990 - :term:`TMPDIR`: The top-level build output directory 9991 - :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`: The target system identifier 9992 - :term:`PN`: The recipe name 9993 - :term:`EXTENDPE`: The epoch --- if :term:`PE` is not specified, which 9994 is usually the case for most recipes, then :term:`EXTENDPE` is blank. 9995 - :term:`PV`: The recipe version 9996 - :term:`PR`: The recipe revision 9997 9998 As an example, assume a Source Directory top-level folder name 9999 ``poky``, a default :term:`Build Directory` at ``poky/build``, and a 10000 ``qemux86-poky-linux`` machine target system. Furthermore, suppose 10001 your recipe is named ``foo_1.3.0-r0.bb``. In this case, the work 10002 directory the build system uses to build the package would be as 10003 follows:: 10004 10005 poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0 10006 10007 :term:`XSERVER` 10008 Specifies the packages that should be installed to provide an X 10009 server and drivers for the current machine, assuming your image 10010 directly includes ``packagegroup-core-x11-xserver`` or, perhaps 10011 indirectly, includes "x11-base" in 10012 :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. 10013 10014 The default value of :term:`XSERVER`, if not specified in the machine 10015 configuration, is "xserver-xorg xf86-video-fbdev xf86-input-evdev". 10016 10017 :term:`XZ_THREADS` 10018 Specifies the number of parallel threads that should be used when 10019 using xz compression. 10020 10021 By default this scales with core count, but is never set less than 2 10022 to ensure that multi-threaded mode is always used so that the output 10023 file contents are deterministic. Builds will work with a value of 1 10024 but the output will differ compared to the output from the compression 10025 generated when more than one thread is used. 10026 10027 On systems where many tasks run in parallel, setting a limit to this 10028 can be helpful in controlling system resource usage. 10029 10030 :term:`XZ_MEMLIMIT` 10031 Specifies the maximum memory the xz compression should use as a percentage 10032 of system memory. If unconstrained the xz compressor can use large amounts of 10033 memory and become problematic with parallelism elsewhere in the build. 10034 "50%" has been found to be a good value. 10035 10036 :term:`ZSTD_THREADS` 10037 Specifies the number of parallel threads that should be used when 10038 using ZStandard compression. 10039 10040 By default this scales with core count, but is never set less than 2 10041 to ensure that multi-threaded mode is always used so that the output 10042 file contents are deterministic. Builds will work with a value of 1 10043 but the output will differ compared to the output from the compression 10044 generated when more than one thread is used. 10045 10046 On systems where many tasks run in parallel, setting a limit to this 10047 can be helpful in controlling system resource usage. 10048